Annual Report for for Period Ending 12/31/2005
Table of Contents

LOGO


Table of Contents

THE BANK OF NEW YORK COMPANY, INC.

FINANCIAL REVIEW

TABLE OF CONTENTS

 

Selected Financial Data

   1

Management’s Discussion and Analysis of the Company’s Financial Condition and
Results of Operations

  

—Introduction

   2

—Overview

   2

—Financial Highlights

   4

—Consolidated Income Statement Review

   6

—Business Segment Review

   12

—Critical Accounting Policies

   27

—Consolidated Balance Sheet Review

   31

—Liquidity

   45

—Commitments and Obligations

   48

—Off-Balance Sheet Arrangements

   48

—Capital Resources

   49

—Capital Framework

   52

—Risk Management

   54

—Statistical Information

   61

—Unaudited Quarterly Data

   64

—Other 2004 Developments

   66

—Glossary

   68

Consolidated Financial Statements

  

—Consolidated Balance Sheets December 31, 2005 and 2004

   71

—Consolidated Statements of Income For The Years Ended December 31, 2005, 2004 and 2003

   72

—Consolidated Statement of Changes In Shareholders’ Equity
    For The Years Ended December 31, 2005, 2004 and 2003

   73

—Consolidated Statements of Cash Flows For the Years Ended
December 31, 2005, 2004 and 2003

   74

—Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements

   75

Form 10-K

  

—Cover

   115

—Cross Reference Index

   116

—Certain Regulatory Considerations

   117

—Submission of Matters to a Vote of Security Holders

   121

—Changes in and Disagreements with Accountants on Accounting and Financial Disclosure

   121

—Properties

   121

—Legal and Regulatory Proceedings

   121

—Executive Officers

   123

—Forward Looking Statements and Risk Factors That Could Affect Future Results

   124

—Website Information

   136

—Code of Ethics

   136

—Controls and Procedures

   137

—Auditor’s Attestation Report

   138

—Signatures

   139

—Exhibits and Financial Statement Schedules

   141


Table of Contents

S ELECTED FINANCIAL DATA

 

(Dollars in millions, except per share amounts)

   2005     2004     2003*     2002     2001**  

Revenue (tax equivalent basis)

   $ 8,341     $ 7,133     $ 6,361     $ 5,789     $ 7,241  

Net Interest Income

     1,909       1,645       1,609       1,665       1,681  

Noninterest Income

     4,956       4,650       3,996       3,133       3,561  

Provision for Credit Losses

     15       15       155       685       375  

Noninterest Expense

     4,483       4,122       3,698       2,751       2,819  

Net Income

     1,571       1,440       1,157       902       1,343  

Net Income Available to Common Shareholders

     1,571       1,440       1,157       902       1,343  

Return on Average Assets

     1.55 %     1.45 %     1.27 %     1.13 %     1.64 %

Return on Average Common Shareholders’ Equity

     16.59       16.37       15.12       13.96       21.58  

Common Dividend Payout Ratio

     41.00       42.22       48.83       60.78       39.21  

Efficiency Ratio

     65.7       66.0       66.0       55.4       55.2  

Per Common Share

          

Basic Earnings

   $ 2.05     $ 1.87     $ 1.54     $ 1.25     $ 1.84  

Diluted Earnings

     2.03       1.85       1.52       1.24       1.81  

Cash Dividends Paid

     0.82       0.79       0.76       0.76       0.72  

Market Value at Year-End

     31.85       33.42       33.12       23.96       40.80  

Averages

          

Securities

   $ 28,751     $ 25,046     $ 24,455     $ 22,970     $ 18,559  

Loans

     39,682       37,778       35,623       34,305       38,770  

Total Assets

     101,435       99,340       91,467       79,830       81,700  

Deposits

     62,215       61,056       58,615       53,795       56,278  

Long-Term Debt

     7,312       6,152       6,103       5,338       4,609  

Common Shareholders’ Equity

     9,473       8,797       7,654       6,465       6,224  

At Year-End

          

Allowance for Loan Losses as a Percent of Total Loans

     1.01 %     1.65 %     1.89 %     2.09 %     1.16 %

Allowance for Loan Losses as a Percent of Non-Margin Loans

     1.19       1.99       2.26       2.12       1.18  

Allowance for Credit Losses as a Percent of Total Loans

     1.39       2.06       2.28       2.65       1.72  

Allowance for Credit Losses as a Percent of Non-Margin Loans

     1.63       2.48       2.72       2.68       1.75  

Tier 1 Capital Ratio

     8.38       8.31       7.44       7.58       8.11  

Total Capital Ratio

     12.48       12.21       11.49       11.96       11.57  

Leverage Ratio

     6.60       6.41       5.82       6.48       6.70  

Common Equity to Assets Ratio

     9.67       9.83       9.12       8.60       7.80  

Total Equity to Assets Ratio

     9.67       9.83       9.12       8.60       7.80  

Common Shares Outstanding (In millions)

     771.129       778.121       775.192       725.971       729.500  

Employees

     23,451       23,363       22,901       19,437       19,181  

Assets Under Custody (In trillions)—Estimated

          

Total Assets Under Custody

   $ 10.9     $ 9.7     $ 8.3     $ 6.8     $ 6.9  

Equity Securities

     32 %     35 %     34 %     26 %     36 %

Fixed Income Securities

     68       65       66       74       64  

Cross-border Assets Under Custody

   $ 3.4     $ 2.7     $ 2.3     $ 1.9     $ 1.9  

Assets Under Management (In billions)—Estimated

          

Total Assets Under Management

   $ 155     $ 137     $ 112     $ 80     $ 72  

Asset Management Sector

     69 %     75 %     79 %     95 %     93 %

Equity Securities

       24%         27%         27%         27%         33%  

Fixed Income Securities

       14         16         17         24         18  

Alternative Investments

       10         11           8           8           7  

Liquid Assets

       21         21         27         36         35  

Foreign Exchange Overlay

     6       6       5       5       7  

Securities Lending Short-term Investment Funds

     25       19       16       —         —    

* The 2003 results reflect $96 million of merger and integration costs associated with the Pershing acquisition as well as a $78 million expense related to the settlement of a claim by General Motors Acceptance Corporation (“GMAC”) related to the 1999 sale of BNY Financial Corporation (“BNYFC”).
** The 2001 results reflect the estimated $242 million impact of the World Trade Center disaster, the related $175 million initial insurance recovery, and the $190 million special provision on the accelerated disposition of emerging telecommunications loans.

All amounts in the above notes are pre-tax.

 

1


Table of Contents

M ANAGEMENT’S DISCUSSION AND ANALYSIS OF THE COMPANY’S FINANCIAL CONDITION AND RESULTS OF OPERATIONS (“MD&A”)

INTRODUCTION

The Bank of New York Company, Inc.’s (the “Company”) actual results of future operations may differ from those estimated or anticipated in certain forward-looking statements contained herein for reasons which are discussed below and under the heading “Forward Looking Statements and Risk Factors That Could Affect Future Results.” When used in this report, the words “estimate,” “forecast,” “project,” “anticipate,” “expect,” “intend,” “believe,” “plan,” “goal,” “should,” “may,” “strategy,” “target,” and words of similar meaning are intended to identify forward looking statements in addition to statements specifically identified as forward looking statements.

OVERVIEW

The Company’s Businesses

The Bank of New York Company, Inc. (NYSE: BK) is a global leader in providing a comprehensive array of services that enable institutions and individuals to move and manage their financial assets in more than 100 markets worldwide. The Company has a long tradition of collaborating with clients to deliver innovative solutions through its core competencies: securities servicing, treasury management, investment management, and individual & regional banking services. The Company’s extensive global client base includes a broad range of leading financial institutions, corporations, government entities, endowments and foundations. Its principal subsidiary, The Bank of New York, founded in 1784, is the oldest bank in the United States and has consistently played a prominent role in the evolution of financial markets worldwide.

The Company’s strategy over the past decade has been to focus on highly scalable, fee-based securities servicing and fiduciary businesses, and it has achieved top three market share in most of its major product lines. The Company distinguishes itself competitively by offering the broadest array of products and services around the investment lifecycle. These include:

 

    advisory and asset management services to support the investment decision;

 

    extensive trade execution, clearance and settlement capabilities;

 

    custody, securities lending, accounting, and administrative services for investment portfolios;

 

    sophisticated risk and performance measurement tools for analyzing portfolios; and

 

    services for issuers of both equity and debt securities.

By providing integrated solutions for clients’ needs, the Company strives to be the preferred partner in helping its clients succeed in the world’s rapidly evolving financial markets.

The Company’s key objectives include:

 

    achieving positive operating leverage on an annual basis and

 

    sustaining top-line growth by expanding client relationships and winning new ones

To achieve its key objectives, the Company has grown both through internal reinvestment as well as execution of strategic acquisitions to expand product offerings and increase market share in its scale businesses. Internal reinvestment occurs through increased technology spending, staffing levels, marketing/branding initiatives, quality programs, and product development. The Company consistently invests in technology to improve the breadth and quality of its product offerings, and to increase economies of scale. The Company has acquired over 90 businesses over the past ten years, almost exclusively in its securities servicing and asset management areas. The acquisition of Pershing in 2003 for $2 billion was the largest of these acquisitions.

 

2


Table of Contents

As part of the transformation to a leading securities servicing provider, the Company has also de-emphasized or exited several of its slower growth traditional banking businesses over the past decade. The Company’s more significant actions include selling its credit card business in 1997 and its factoring business in 1999, and most recently, significantly reducing non-financial corporate credit exposures by 41% from December 31, 2001 to December 31, 2005. Capital generated by these actions has been reallocated to the Company’s higher-growth businesses.

The Company’s business model is well positioned to benefit from a number of long-term secular trends. These include:

 

    growth of worldwide financial assets,

 

    globalization of investment activity,

 

    structural market changes, and

 

    increased outsourcing.

These trends benefit the Company by driving higher levels of financial asset trading volume and other transactional activity, as well as higher asset price levels and growth in client assets, all factors by which the Company prices its services. In addition, international markets offer excellent growth opportunities.

Current Business Trends

In 2005 the operating environment was somewhat mixed relative to the Company’s assumptions at the beginning of the year. The equity markets showed lower price appreciation and volumes than assumed. The fixed income markets remained strong and cross-border investment and trading activity increased. Volatility in foreign exchange markets was in line with expectations. The Federal Reserve raised rates more than the Company anticipated at the start of 2005. Given the Company’s diversified business model, the Company achieved double-digit growth in many of its key business lines.

With respect to fee income growth, execution and clearing was lower than expected given the weaker equity markets, but the Company achieved solid growth in ADRs, corporate trust, and investor and broker-dealer services, which resulted in servicing fee growth of 10%.

Private client services and asset management, as well as foreign exchange and other trading, also had solid results. This offset weaker performance in the global payments business, corporate lending activities, and retail banking. Overall, core noninterest income growth for the year was 8%.

The Company has been positioned to benefit from rising interest rates, and with the Federal Reserve raising the federal funds rate from 2.25% at the start of the year to 4.25% at the end, core net interest income was up 11%. Strong liquidity generated from its core businesses, widening spreads on deposits, and sound asset positioning all contributed to this strong performance.

Expense control was effective as the Company’s staff count increased over 2005 by just 1% to 23,451, well below the pace of revenue growth. This reflects the Company’s continued progress on reengineering for labor efficiencies. The Company is also relocating staff to lower cost locations. Expense growth overall was up 9%, reflecting higher costs for pensions and options, construction of an out-of-region data center, and legal and regulatory costs. These factors should have a lesser impact on expense growth prospectively.

For 2006, the Company based its budget planning process on expectations of moderate economic growth and continued growth in the capital markets. The Company expects equity markets to strengthen slightly versus 2005 and rise 5-7%. U.S. non-program equity volumes are forecast to be up 4-6% with equity capital raising holding steady. Moderate growth in M&A volumes is expected. The Company assumes the federal funds rate

 

3


Table of Contents

will rise to 4.5% with only a slight steepening of the yield curve. GDP growth is expected to be slightly over 3%. The Company projects fixed income activity to be moderate, given the expectation of a leveling-off in short interest rates.

This presents an overall backdrop which is comparable to 2005, although with a somewhat different composition and a slightly less favorable environment for net interest income. In the aggregate, the Company expects to grow revenues faster than the markets by focusing on faster-growing market segments, gaining market share, and providing a high level of service to its existing clients.

Several other factors will have an impact on 2006 results, including:

 

    higher pension expense given relatively poor investment returns over the past four years and further changes in prospective assumptions partly offset by changes to the Company’s primary domestic plan;

 

    higher costs related to completing relocation projects;

 

    an anticipated lower level of securities gains; and

 

    potentially higher credit loss provisioning given the very favorable credit costs in 2005.

After considering the above, the Company is targeting positive operating leverage of 100+ basis points in 2006. The Company will seek to control overall expense growth through continued cost discipline and reengineering efforts, without sacrificing the investments necessary both to innovate and to enhance service quality. The Company continues to focus on key programs to attain greater straight-through processing of transactions, to reengineer labor costs, and to move activity to lower cost locations.

In January 2006, a significant customer ended its clearing relationship with Pershing following its acquisition by a major broker-dealer. Pershing currently is in discussions seeking compensation for the termination of the relationship.

FINANCIAL HIGHLIGHTS

2005

In 2005, the Company reported net income of $1,571 million and diluted earnings per share of $2.03 compared with net income of $1,440 million and diluted earnings per share of $1.85 in 2004, and net income of $1,157 million and diluted earnings per share of $1.52 in 2003. Reported EPS reflects a reduction of 3 cents in 2004 due to items detailed in “Other 2004 Developments”.

Additional 2005 highlights include:

 

    Positive operating leverage on a core basis for the third and fourth quarters versus 2004;

 

    Securities servicing fees up 10% from 2004;

 

    Net interest income up 16% versus 2004;

 

    Private client services and asset management fees up 9%;

 

    Foreign exchange and other trading revenues up 7% from 2004; and

 

    Active capital management, as the Company repurchased 5 million net shares.

The Company’s 2005 earnings reflect significant progress toward its key objectives. New business wins and revenues from new and innovative products drove double-digit revenue growth in many of the Company’s key business lines. In 2005, the Company focused on generating positive operating leverage and began to deliver on that objective as well. A number of outstanding regulatory issues were resolved. The Company launched its branding initiative in January 2005 and continued to expand it throughout the year. Finally, the Company’s earnings per share of $2.03 was in the midpoint of the guidance range the Company provided early in 2005.

During 2005, the Company formed strategic alliances to penetrate faster-growing markets in France, Germany, the Nordic and Baltic region, Japan, Australia, and India. The Company also continued to expand its market presence in high-growth areas such as hedge fund servicing and collateral management, while extending its capabilities in the rapidly growing area of alternative investments.

 

4


Table of Contents

The Company continued to improve its credit risk portfolio, and it funded further long-term investment spending for technology, business continuity, quality, and branding programs.

In 2005, the Company continued to invest in enhancing its service offerings, critical to sustaining top-line growth through all types of markets, while maintaining its commitment to expense discipline to ensure a competitive cost base. Service offerings enhancements were the result of both internal development and acquisitions.

The Company announced three strategic transactions:

 

    Lynch, Jones & Ryan, Inc.– a market leader in commission recapture, the acquisition complements the Company’s execution business. The acquisition brings in 1,400 pension fund clients, which offer cross-sell opportunities for the Company’s transition management services.

 

    Alcentra – an international asset management group focused on funds that invest in non-investment grade debt. The acquisition adds structured credit to the Company’s asset management offering and $6 billion to assets under management.

 

    Urdang Capital Management – a real estate investment firm that manages approximately $3.0 billion in direct investments and portfolios of REIT securities. Expected to close in the first quarter of 2006, the acquisition expands the Company’s alternative investment platform by adding real estate investment management.

The acquisitions of Alcentra and Urdang bring asset classes that are in demand by core customer segments such as pension funds, endowments and foundations, international investors, and private clients. Going forward, the Company plans to continue building out its asset management capabilities and to capitalize on the Company’s inherent distribution strengths, as well as favorable secular trends for growth in investable assets.

2004

In 2004, the Company reported net income of $1,440 million and diluted earnings per share of $1.85. In 2004, the Company recorded several gains and charges that in the aggregate reduced reported earnings by 3 cents per share. These items are detailed in “Other 2004 Developments”.

In 2004, the growth in earnings was paced by securities servicing growth of 18% (9% adjusted for full-year impact of Pershing) to $2,857 million, core net interest income growth of 6%, strong credit performance, and higher than expected securities gains. Performance was strong across nearly all the Company’s securities servicing businesses. Investor and issuer services increased by 11% and 12%, respectively. The growth in investor services was driven largely by new business wins and improvements year-over-year in asset values and volumes. Issuer services benefited from increased cross-border activity in depositary receipts and improving market share in global products within corporate trust. Broker-dealer services were up 17% primarily due to strong growth in collateral management.

The Company’s asset management business continued to perform well, responding to growing institutional investor interest in alternative investments. Private client services and asset management fees increased $64 million, or 17%, primarily due to exceptional growth at the Company’s fund of funds manager, Ivy Asset Management (“Ivy”). In addition, foreign exchange results continued to benefit from currency volatility and increased cross-border investing. Foreign exchange and other trading revenues remained at historically high levels, up 11% versus a year ago. The provision for credit losses declined to $15 million from $155 million in 2003.

This strength in revenue was partially offset by upward pressure on the Company’s expense base. Higher employee stock option and pension expenses, business continuity spending, costs associated with legal and regulatory matters, and costs associated with converting new business opportunities in investor services all contributed to higher expense levels.

 

5


Table of Contents

2003

In 2003, the Company reported net income was $1,157 million and diluted earnings per share of $1.52. Merger and integration costs associated with the Pershing acquisition of 8 cents per share and the settlement with General Motors Acceptance Corporation (“GMAC”) of 7 cents per share impacted earnings in 2003. In 2003, securities servicing fees were $2,412 million, a 27% increase compared with $1,896 million in 2002, reflecting the Pershing acquisition and growth in investor and broker-dealer services. Global payment services fees increased 6% for the full year, which is attributable to improved multi-currency funds transfer product capabilities and new business wins. For the year 2003, private client services and asset management fees were up 12% from the previous year, reflecting higher equity price levels as well as strong growth at Ivy. In addition, the year-over-year comparison also benefited from the full-year impact of several 2002 acquisitions. Foreign exchange and other trading revenues were up 40% over 2002, resulting from increased client-driven foreign exchange, interest rate hedging activity, and the Pershing acquisition. The provision for credit losses was $155 million. Although expenses increased significantly due to the Pershing acquisition, stock option expensing, a lower pension credit, technology investment, and business continuity, the Company was able to attain positive leverage in the second half of the year.

CONSOLIDATED INCOME STATEMENT REVIEW

Noninterest Income

 

                    Percent Inc/(Dec)  

(In millions)

   2005    2004    2003    2005 vs. 2004     2004 vs. 2003  

Noninterest Income

             

Servicing Fees

             

Securities

   $ 3,148    $ 2,857    $ 2,412    10 %   18 %

Global Payment Services

     294      319      314    (8 )   2  
                         
     3,442      3,176      2,726    8     17  

Private Client Services and Asset Management Fees

     490      448      384    9     17  

Service Charges and Fees

     382      384      375    (1 )   2  

Foreign Exchange and Other Trading Activities

     391      364      327    7     11  

Securities Gains/(Losses)

     68      78      35    (13 )   123  

Other

     183      200      149    (9 )   34  
                         

Total Noninterest Income

   $ 4,956    $ 4,650    $ 3,996    7     16  
                         

Noninterest income is provided by a wide range of securities servicing, global payment services, private client services and asset management, trading activities, and other fee-based services. Revenues from these activities were $4,956 million in 2005, compared with $4,650 million in 2004 and $3,996 million in 2003. As a percentage of revenues, total noninterest income was 72% in 2005, compared with 74% in 2004 and 71% in 2003. The growth in revenue in 2005 primarily reflects broadly stronger performance in securities servicing, private client services and asset management fees, and foreign exchange and other trading revenue.

The increase in 2004 primarily reflects strong performance across nearly all the Company’s securities servicing businesses and the full-year impact of the Pershing acquisition, as well as higher foreign exchange and other trading revenue, private client services and asset management fees, and securities gains. The 2004 increase also includes the $48 million pre-tax gain on the sale of a portion of the Company’s investment in Wing Hang Bank Limited and the $19 million gain on four sponsor fund investments recorded in 2004.

 

6


Table of Contents

The following table provides the breakdown of securities servicing fees for 2005, 2004, and 2003.

Securities Servicing Fees

 

                    Percent Inc/(Dec)  

(In millions)

   2005    2004    2003    2005 vs. 2004     2004 vs. 2003  

Execution and Clearing Services

   $ 1,222    $ 1,145    $ 885    7 %   29 %

Investor Services

     1,060      924      830    15     11  

Issuer Services

     639      583      522    10     12  

Broker-Dealer Services

     227      205      175    11     17  
                         

Securities Servicing Fees

   $ 3,148    $ 2,857    $ 2,412    10     18  
                         

Securities servicing fees were $3,148 million, $2,857 million, and $2,412 million, in 2005, 2004, and 2003, respectively. The 10% increase in securities servicing fees from 2004 primarily reflects solid growth across all businesses. In 2004, the 18% increase in securities servicing fees from 2003 reflects the full-year impact of the Pershing acquisition and good organic growth in investor and issuer services, which were up 11% and 12%. For additional details on Securities Servicing Fees, refer to the “Business Segment Review” section.

Global payment services fees, principally funds transfer, cash management, and trade services, were $294 million in 2005, $319 million in 2004, and $314 million in 2003. The decline in global payment services fees in 2005 reflects customers choosing to pay with higher compensatory balances, which benefits net interest income. On an invoiced services basis total revenue was up 5% over 2004. The small 2004 increase in global payment services fees from 2003 is attributable to customers starting to leave higher compensatory balances to cover the cost of services rather than pay fees as a result of the rising rate environment.

Private client services and asset management fees were $490 million in 2005, $448 million in 2004, and $384 million in 2003. The 9% increase over 2004 reflects strong growth in asset management fees as well as higher fees in private banking. Asset management was driven by another strong performance at Ivy and double-digit growth in fixed income asset management and separate account services. The 17% increase in fees in 2004 from 2003 reflects strong growth in Ivy, higher fees from fixed income asset management, and higher equity price levels.

Service charges and fees were $382 million in 2005, compared with $384 million in 2004 and $375 million in 2003. The decrease in 2005 from 2004 reflects lower retail checking account fees. The increase in 2004 from 2003 reflects higher syndication and advisory fees.

Foreign exchange and other trading revenues were a record $391 million in 2005, $364 million in 2004, and $327 million in 2003. Foreign exchange trading grew strongly in 2005 reflecting increased volume due to new business wins and greater business from existing clients. Other trading grew in 2005 reflecting higher interest rate and equity derivatives trading partially offset by a decline in trading revenue at Pershing. The 11% increase in 2004 from 2003 resulted from new business wins and an increased level of client activity, tied to cross-border investing and hedging against currency volatility. Pershing contributed $44 million to foreign exchange and other trading revenue in 2005, compared with $51 million in 2004 and $35 million in 2003.

Securities gains were $68 million in 2005, compared with a $78 million in 2004 and a $35 million in 2003. The securities gains in 2005 and 2004 were primarily attributable to the Company’s private equity portfolio. In 2004, the Company’s private equity portfolio generated $19 million of realized gains on four sponsor investments. Half of the 2003 gains arose from repositioning actions in the Company’s fixed income securities portfolio.

Other noninterest income is attributable to asset-related gains, equity investments, and other transactions. Asset-related gains include gains on lease residuals, as well as loan and real estate dispositions. Equity investment income primarily reflects the Company’s proportionate share of the income from its investment in

 

7


Table of Contents

Wing Hang Bank Limited, AIB/BNY Securities Services (Ireland) Limited, and RBSI Securities Services (Holdings) Limited. Other income primarily includes income or loss from insurance contracts, low income housing and other investments as well as various miscellaneous revenues. The breakdown among these three categories is shown below:

Other Noninterest Income

 

(In millions)

       2005              2004              2003    

Asset-Related Gains

   $ 97      $ 82      $ 36

Equity Investment Income

     44        43        34

Other

     42        75        79
                        

Total Other Noninterest Income

   $ 183      $ 200      $ 149
                        

Other noninterest income was $183 million in 2005, $200 million in 2004, and $149 million in 2003. In 2005, asset-related gains included a $17 million gain on the sale of the Company’s interest in Financial Models Companies, Inc. (“FMC”), a $12 million gain on the sale of certain Community Reinvestment Act (“CRA”) investments, a $12 million gain on sale of eight New York Stock Exchange seats, and a $10 million gain on the sale of a building. The increase in asset-related gains in 2004 from 2003 reflected a pre-tax gain of $48 million from the sale of a portion of the Company’s investment in Wing Hang Bank Limited. The higher level of asset-related gains in 2005 and 2004 has helped to offset higher legal and regulatory costs and the impact of the 2004 SFAS 13 lease income adjustment. The 2005 decline in other in the above table reflects fewer government grants and lower insurance-related income.

Net Interest Income

 

                             Percent Inc/(Dec)  
      2005     2004     2003     2005 vs. 2004     2004 vs. 2003  

(Dollars in millions)

   Reported     Reported     Core*     Reported     Reported     Reported  

Net Interest Income

   $ 1,909     $ 1,645     $ 1,711     $ 1,609     16 %   2 %

Tax Equivalent Adjustment

     29       30       30       35      
                                    

Net Interest Income on a
Tax Equivalent Basis

   $ 1,938     $ 1,675     $ 1,741     $ 1,644     16 %   2 %
                                    

Net Interest Rate Spread

     1.83 %     1.78 %     1.86 %     1.97 %    

Net Yield on Interest Earning Assets

     2.36       2.07       2.15       2.22      

* Excludes SFAS 13 adjustments

For 2005, net interest income on a tax equivalent basis amounted to $1,938 million compared with $1,675 million in 2004. In 2005, the increase in net interest income reflects the Company’s sound interest rate positioning for a rising rate environment, continued expansion of deposit spreads, and increased liquidity generated by servicing activities. The Company also benefited from customers greater use of compensating balances in a rising rate environment. On a reported basis, net interest income on a tax equivalent basis was up 16% while on a core basis it was up 11%.

Net interest income in 2004 was affected by three cumulative adjustments to the leasing portfolio, which were triggered under SFAS 13. See “Other 2004 Developments”.

Excluding the impact of the SFAS 13 leasing adjustments on the leveraged lease portfolio, net interest income on a tax equivalent basis was $1,741 million in 2004, up 6% from $1,644 million in 2003. This increase was attributable to the full-year impact of Pershing and the benefit of rising interest rates. Rising rates reduced compression on deposit product spreads, increased the value of free funds and caused the Company’s global payment services customers to leave additional compensatory balances rather than pay for services with fees.

 

8


Table of Contents

The increase in net interest income in 2005 and 2004 also reflects an increase in average earning assets. Average earning assets were $82.1 billion in 2005 compared with $81.1 billion in 2004 and $74.1 billion in 2003. The increase in 2004 from 2003 reflects the inclusion of Pershing for the full year 2004. Average loans were $39.7 billion in 2005 compared with $37.8 billion in 2004 and $35.6 billion in 2003. Average securities were $28.8 billion in 2005, up from $25.0 billion in 2004 and $24.5 billion in 2003.

The net interest rate spread was 1.83% in 2005 compared with 1.78% in 2004, while the net yield on interest-earning assets was 2.36% in 2005 and 2.07% in 2004. Excluding the leasing adjustments of $66 million in 2004, the net interest rate spread was 1.86% and the net yield was 2.15%. The Company estimates that if Pershing had been owned for the full-year of 2003, the spread and yield in 2003 would have been reduced to 1.89% and 2.13%, respectively.

In this report a number of amounts related to net interest income are presented on a “tax equivalent basis.” The Company believes that this presentation provides comparability of net interest income arising from both taxable and tax-exempt sources and is consistent with industry practice.

Provision for Credit Losses

The provision for credit losses was $15 million in 2005, compared with $15 million in 2004 and $155 million in 2003. Asset quality remained high in 2005. The 2004 provision includes a credit of $7 million for the reduction in exposure associated with the restructuring of aircraft leases. The lower provision in 2004 from 2003 reflects the Company’s improved asset quality and a stronger credit environment.

Noninterest Expense

 

                    Percent Inc/(Dec)  

(In millions)

   2005    2004    2003    2005 vs. 2004     2004 vs. 2003  

Salaries and Employee Benefits

   $ 2,549    $ 2,324    $ 2,002    10 %   16 %

Net Occupancy

     323      305      261    6     17  

Furniture and Equipment

     208      204      185    2     10  

Clearing

     187      176      154    6     14  

Sub-custodian Expenses

     96      87      74    10     18  

Software

     215      193      170    11     14  

Communications

     95      93      92    2     1  

Amortization of Intangibles

     40      34      25    18     36  

Pershing Merger and Acquisition Costs

     —        —        96    —       —    

Other

     770      706      639    9     10  
                         

Total Noninterest Expense

   $ 4,483    $ 4,122    $ 3,698    9 %   11 %
                         

Total noninterest expense was $4,483 million in 2005, $4,122 million in 2004, and $3,698 million in 2003. The 2005 increase in expenses primarily reflects increased staffing and clearing costs associated with new business and acquisitions, higher stock option and pension expense, expanded occupancy costs associated with business continuity, as well as higher technology and legal costs. The 2004 increase in expenses primarily reflects the full-year impact of the Pershing acquisition, higher stock option expense, a lower pension credit, the upfront expenses associated with the implementation of cost reduction initiatives, higher volume related sub-custodian and clearing expenses and higher technology and business continuity spending. In 2003, noninterest expense included merger and acquisition costs relating to Pershing of $96 million and the settlement with GMAC of $78 million.

Salaries and employee benefits were $2,549 million in 2005, compared with $2,324 million in 2004 and $2,002 million in 2003. In 2005, salaries rose 7% as tight headcount control and reengineering and relocation

 

9


Table of Contents

projects partially offset the impact of business wins, acquisitions and additional legal and compliance personnel. Benefit expense rose significantly in 2005 reflecting higher expenses for pensions, stock options, medical benefits, and incentive payments. In 2004, the increase in salaries and employee benefits reflects higher performance related incentives and benefits, higher stock option and defined contribution plan expense, a higher pension expense as well as higher variable expenses associated with revenue growth. The number of employees at December 31, 2005, was 23,451, up from 23,363 and 22,901 in 2004 and 2003, respectively. Severance expense was $17 million in 2005, $16 million in 2004 and $10 million in 2003.

Net occupancy and furniture and fixture expenses were $531 million in 2005, compared with $509 million in 2004 and $446 million in 2003. Net occupancy increased by $18 million, primarily reflecting the costs associated with the Company’s new out-of-region data center in the mid-south region of the U.S. and the growth center in Manchester, England, as well as higher energy costs.

Clearing expenses were $187 million in 2005, compared with $176 million in 2004 and $154 million in 2003. The increase in 2005 reflects higher expenses associated with acquisitions within the execution business. Sub-custodian expenses increased 10% in 2005 to $96 million, reflecting higher level of business activity.

Software expenses increased in 2005 and 2004, reflecting the Company’s continued investment in technology capabilities supporting its servicing activities as well as spending and development to support business growth.

Amortization of intangibles increased to $40 million in 2005 from $34 million in 2004 and $25 million in 2003. In 2005 and 2004, the Pershing acquisition added $20 million in intangibles amortization.

Other noninterest expense is attributable to vendor services, business development, legal expenses, settlements and claims, other, and the GMAC settlement. Vendor services include professional fees, computer services, market data, courier, and other services. Business development includes advertising, charitable contributions, travel, and entertainment expenses. The breakdown among these five categories is shown below:

Other Noninterest Expense

 

(In millions)

   2005    2004    2003

Vendor Services

   $ 336    $ 307    $ 259

Business Development

     124      108      84

Legal Fees, Settlements and Claims

     125      96      43

Other

     185      195      175

GMAC Settlement

     —        —        78
                    

Total Other Noninterest Expense

   $ 770    $ 706    $ 639
                    

Other expenses in 2005 were $770 million, compared with $706 million in 2004 and $639 million in 2003. Since the Company owned Pershing for 8 months in 2003, $67 million of the 2004 increase relates to the full- year impact of owning Pershing. The increase in vendor services in 2005 primarily reflects higher consulting and pricing services expenses. Growth in business development expenses over the period reflects higher travel and entertainment and advertising related to the Company’s branding initiatives. Legal fees, settlement and claims in 2005 included $24 million associated with the Russian Funds transfer matter and other regulatory matters, as well as an increase in legal fees. In 2004, noninterest expense included expenses associated with the RW Matter of $30 million.

In 2003, the Company and GMAC settled claims relating to the Company’s 1999 sale to GMAC of BNY Financial Corporation, the Company’s factoring and asset-based finance business. The settlement resolved all claims between the parties with a payment of $110 million by the Company to GMAC. After accounting for a

 

10


Table of Contents

previously established reserve for this matter, the net impact of the settlement was approximately $78 million, or 7 cents per fully diluted share. The Company sold BNY Financial Corporation to GMAC for $1.8 billion in cash in 1999.

The Company continues to increase its investment in technology focusing on key items such as delivering positive operating leverage, driving product innovation and enhancing the client experience. Software development has been an increasing component of technology expense in 2005, 2004, and 2003. The rate of infrastructure investment is slowing. Approximately 80% of the data center capacity is two years old or less. In the fourth quarter of 2005, the Company’s new data center in the mid-south region of the U.S. became operational. The new data center will improve the geographic diversification and resilience of the Company’s operations and will support the processing needs of the Company’s institutional and retail customers. In 2006, the Company expects to benefit from the new data center as redundant locations are beginning to be shut down. Print center consolidation was completed in 2005. Core investor services applications were recently developed and engineered with technologies that should be durable over time.

The Company has a number of programs to control expense growth. These programs include day-to-day profitability programs, reengineering processes, and moving jobs to lower cost environs. Day-to-day profitability programs focus on stringent control of headcount and discretionary expenses, as well as enhanced vendor management.

Reengineering focuses on business process reviews throughout the Company. Projects commenced in 2005 are expected to have a $40 million impact in 2006. In 2004, the Company reviewed 15 areas and developed action steps to lower expenses by $90 million, with a $40 million impact in 2004 and a $50 million incremental for 2005. These savings have lowered the Company’s growth rate of expenses by approximately 1% over the past two years. The savings are partly offset by consulting costs.

In January 2004, the Company began a three-year effort to move 1,500 jobs to lower cost areas. In 2005, the Company moved 516 positions out of higher-cost locations, up from 419 moves in 2004. In 2006, the Company anticipates further expansion of the job relocation program to 1,800 jobs given the success of the program to date. As a result, the Company will incur higher expense in 2006 for severance and lease termination, but will achieve net benefits in 2007 and 2008.

The Company adopted fair value accounting for stock compensation on January 1, 2003, using the prospective method. The Company’s grants of stock options typically vest over two to four years. The year 2005 was the third and final year the adoption of expensing stock options impacted year-over-year expense comparisons. The Company expects stock options expense to be somewhat less expensive in 2006 since the Company is issuing fewer options than it has in the past.

Income Taxes

The Company’s consolidated effective tax rates for 2005, 2004, and 2003 were 33.6%, 33.3%, and 34.0%, respectively. The increase in the effective tax rate in 2005 primarily reflects higher state and local taxes. The decline in the effective tax rate in 2004 from 2003 primarily reflects the increase in the tax reserve related to LILO exposures which was offset by the SFAS 13 leasing adjustments. The Company anticipates the tax rate for the year 2006 to increase slightly to 33.7%.

The Company invests in synthetic fuel (Section 29) and low income housing (Section 42) investments generating tax credits, which have the effect of permanently reducing the Company’s tax expense. The effective tax rates in all periods reflect a reclassification related to Section 42 tax credits. See “Accounting Changes and New Accounting Pronouncements” in the Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements. The Company also invests in leveraged leases which, through accelerated depreciation, postpone the payment of taxes to future years. For financial statement purposes, deferred taxes are recorded as a liability for future payment.

 

11


Table of Contents

BUSINESS SEGMENT REVIEW

Segment Data

The Company has an internal information system that produces performance data for its four business segments along product and service lines.

Business Segments Accounting Principles

The Company’s segment data has been determined on an internal management basis of accounting, rather than the generally accepted accounting principles used for consolidated financial reporting. These measurement principles are designed so that reported results of the segments will track their economic performance. Segment results are subject to restatement whenever improvements are made in the measurement principles or when organizational changes are made.

In 2005, the Company has determined that it is appropriate to modify its segment presentation in order to provide more transparency into its results of operations and to better reflect modifications in the management structure that the Company implemented during the fourth quarter of 2005. As such, the Company has identified four major business segments for assessing its overall performance, with the Institutional Services segment being further subdivided into four business groupings. These segments are shown below:

 

    Institutional Services Segment

 

    Investor & Broker-Dealer Services Business

 

    Execution & Clearing Services Business

 

    Issuer Services Business

 

    Treasury Services Business

 

    Private Bank & BNY Asset Management Segment

 

    Retail & Middle Market Banking Segment

 

    Corporate and Other Segment

All prior periods have been restated to reflect this realignment. Other specific accounting principles employed include:

 

    The measure of revenues and profit or loss by a segment has been adjusted to present segment data on a tax equivalent basis.

 

    The provision for credit losses allocated to each segment is based on management’s judgment as to average credit losses that will be incurred in the operations of the segment over a credit cycle of a period of years. Management’s judgment includes the following factors among others: historical charge-off experience and the volume, composition, and size of the credit portfolio. This method is different from that required under generally accepted accounting principles as it anticipates future losses which are not yet probable and therefore not recognizable under generally accepted accounting principles.

 

    Balance sheet assets and liabilities and their related income or expense are specifically assigned to each segment.

 

    Net interest income is allocated to segments based on the yields on the assets and liabilities generated by each segment. Assets and liabilities generated by credit-related activities are allocated to businesses based on borrower usage of that businesses’ products or services. Credit-only relationships and borrowers using both credit and payment services remain in Treasury Services. Segments with a net liability position are allocated assets primarily from the securities portfolio.

 

    Noninterest income associated with Treasury-related services is similarly allocated back to those businesses.

 

12


Table of Contents
    Revenues and expenses associated with specific client bases are included in those segments. For example, foreign exchange activity associated with clients using custody products is allocated to Investor & Broker-Dealer Services.

 

    Support and other indirect expenses are allocated to segments based on internally-developed methodologies.

Description of Business Segments

The activities within each business segment are described below.

Institutional Services Segment

Investor & Broker-Dealer Services Business

Investor & Broker-Dealer Services includes global custody, global fund services, securities lending, global liquidity services, outsourcing, government securities clearance, collateral management, credit-related services, and other linked revenues, principally foreign exchange and execution and clearing revenues.

In Investor Services, the Company is one of the leading custodians with $10.9 trillion of assets under custody at December 31, 2005. The Company is one of the largest mutual fund custodians for U.S. funds and one of the largest providers of fund services in the world with over $1.6 trillion in total assets. The Company, also services more than 17% of the total industry assets for exchange-traded funds, and is a leading U.K. custodian. In securities lending, the Company is the largest lender of U.S. Treasury securities and depositary receipts with a lending pool of approximately $1.5 trillion in 27 markets around the world.

The Company’s Broker-Dealer Services business clears approximately 50% of U.S. Government securities. The Company is the leader in global clearance, clearing equity and fixed income transactions in 101 markets. With over $1.1 trillion in tri-party balances worldwide, the Company is the world’s largest collateral management agent.

Execution & Clearing Services Business

The Company provides execution, clearing and financial services outsourcing solutions in over 80 global markets, executing trades for 575 million shares and clearing 930,000 trades daily. In Execution Services, the Company conducts institutional agency brokerage, electronic trading, transition management services, and independent research. The Company’s Execution Services business is one of the largest global institutional agency brokerage organizations. In addition, it is one of the leading institutional electronic brokers for non-U.S. dollar equity execution.

Pershing’s clearing business provides clearing, execution, financing, and custody for introducing broker-dealers and registered investment advisors. Pershing services more than 1,100 institutional and retail financial organizations and independent investment advisors who collectively represent nearly 6 million individual investors.

Issuer Services Business

Issuer Services includes corporate trust, depositary receipts, employee investment plan services, stock transfer, and credit-related services.

In Issuer Services, the Company is depositary for more than 1,200 American and global depositary receipt programs, a 64% market share, acting in partnership with leading companies from 60 countries. As a trustee, the

 

13


Table of Contents

Company provides diverse services for corporate, municipal, structured, and international debt securities. Over 90,000 appointments for more than 30,000 worldwide clients have resulted in the Company being trustee for more than $3 trillion in outstanding debt securities. The Company is the third largest stock transfer agent, servicing more than 16 million shareowners. Employee Investment Plan Services has more than 124 clients with 650,000 employees in over 54 countries.

Treasury Services Business

Treasury Services includes global payment services for corporate customers as well as lending and credit-related services.

Corporate global payment services offers leading-edge technology, innovative products, and industry expertise to help its clients optimize cash flow, manage liquidity, and make payments around the world in more than 90 different countries. The Company maintains a global network of branches, representative offices and correspondent banks to provide comprehensive payment services including funds transfer, cash management, trade services and liquidity management. The Company is one of the largest funds transfer banks in the U.S. transferring over $1.18 trillion daily via more than 135,500 wire transfers.

The Company provides lending and credit-related services to large public and private corporations nationwide. Special industry groups focus on industry segments such as media, telecommunications, cable, energy, real estate, retailing, and healthcare. Credit-related revenues are allocated to businesses other than Treasury Services to the extent the borrower uses that businesses’ products or services. Credit-only relationships and borrowers using both credit and payment services remain in Treasury Services. Through BNY Capital Markets, Inc., the Company provides a broad range of capital markets and investment banking services including syndicated loans, bond underwriting, private placements of corporate debt and equity securities, and merger, acquisition, and advisory services. The Company is a leading arranger of syndicated financings for clients with 151 transactions totaling in excess of $59 billion in 2005.

For its credit services business overall, the Company’s corporate lending strategy is to focus on those clients and industries that are major users of securities servicing and global payment services.

Private Bank and BNY Asset Management

The Private Bank & BNY Asset Management segment includes traditional banking and trust services to wealthy clients and investment management services for institutional and high-net-worth clients. In private banking, the Company offers a full array of wealth management services to help individuals plan, invest and transition and includes financial and estate planning, trust and fiduciary services, customized banking services, brokerage and investment solutions.

BNY Asset Management provides investment solutions for some of the wealthiest individuals, largest corporate and most prestigious organizations around the world applying a broad spectrum of investment strategies and wealth management solutions. BNY Asset Management’s alternative strategies have expanded to include hedge fund of funds, private equity, alternative fixed income and real estate.

The Company’s asset management subsidiaries include:

 

    Ivy Asset Management Corporation, one of the country’s leading hedge fund of fund firms, offers a comprehensive range of multi-manager hedge fund products and customized portfolio solutions.

 

    Alcentra Group, acquired in January 2006, offers sophisticated alternative credit investments, including leveraged loans and subordinated and distressed debt.

 

    Urdang Capital, a real estate investment firm, which the Company has agreed to acquire, offers the opportunity to invest in real estate through separate accounts, a closed-end commingled fund that invests directly in properties, and a separate account that invests in publicly-traded REITs.

 

    Estabrook Capital Management LLC offers value-oriented investment management strategies, including socially responsible investing.

 

    Gannett Welsh & Kotler specializes in tax-exempt management and equity portfolio strategies.

 

14


Table of Contents

The Company also provides investment management services directly to institutions and manages the “Hamilton” family of mutual funds.

Retail & Middle Market Banking Segment

The Retail Bank includes branch banking, consumer, small business, residential mortgage and asset management activities conducted through the Company’s investment centers. The Company’s retail franchise includes more than 600,000 consumer relationships and 100,000 business relationships. The Company operates 342 branches in 23 counties in the New York tri-state region. The Company has 241 branches in New York, 93 in New Jersey and 8 in Connecticut. The New York branches are primarily suburban-based with 118 in upstate New York, 85 on Long Island and 38 in New York City. The retail network is a significant source of low-cost funding and provides a platform to cross-sell core services to both individuals and small businesses in the New York metropolitan area. The branches are a meaningful source of private client referrals. Small business and investment centers are set up in the largest 100 branches.

Investment centers provide personalized professional investment counseling to individuals. Products include mutual funds, annuities, and discount brokerage services.

In middle market lending, the Company’s regional commercial banking and regional commercial real estate divisions provide financing for a variety of businesses based in the New York metropolitan area. The types of financing include lines of credit, term loans, global trade services, and commercial mortgages.

Corporate and Other Segment

The Corporate and Other segment primarily includes the Company’s leasing operations and corporate overhead. Net interest income in this segment primarily reflects the funding cost of goodwill and intangibles. The tax equivalent adjustment on net interest income is eliminated in this segment. Provision for credit losses reflects the difference between the aggregate of the credit provision over a credit cycle for the other three reportable segments and the Company’s recorded provision. The Company’s approach to acquisitions is highly centralized and controlled by senior management. Accordingly, the resulting goodwill and other intangible assets are included in this segment for average assets. Noninterest expense includes the related amortization. Noninterest income primarily reflects leasing, securities gains, and income from the sale of other corporate assets. Noninterest expenses include direct expenses supporting the leasing activities as well as certain corporate overhead not directly attributable to the operations of the other segments.

Business Review

Institutional Services Segment

 

                    Inc/(Dec)  

(In millions)

   2005    2004    2003    2005 vs. 2004    2004 vs. 2003  

Net Interest Income

   $ 1,186    $ 1,064    $ 971    $ 122    $ 93  

Noninterest Income

     4,182      3,830      3,337      352      493  

Total Revenue

     5,368      4,894      4,308      474      586  

Provision for Credit Losses

     59      59      101      —        (42 )

Noninterest Expense

     3,444      3,140      2,691      304      449  

Income Before Taxes

     1,865      1,695      1,516      170      179  

Average Assets

     75,682      72,286      63,952      3,396      8,334  

Average Deposits

     44,833      42,533      40,683      2,300      1,850  

The Company’s Institutional Services business is conducted in four business groupings: Investor & Broker-Dealer Services, Execution & Clearing Services, Issuer Services, and Treasury Services. Income before taxes was up 10% to $1,865 million in 2005 from $1,695 million in 2004, which was up 12% versus $1,516 million in 2003.

 

15


Table of Contents

Market Data

 

                    Percent Inc/(Dec)  
     2005    2004    2003    2005 vs. 2004     2004 vs. 2003  

S&P 500® Index

   1,248    1,212    1,112    3 %   9 %

NASDAQ® Index

   2,205    2,175    2,003    1     9  

Lehman Brothers

             

Aggregate Bondsm Index

   206.2    220.6    193.4    (7 )   14  

MSCI® EAFE

   1,680.1    1,515.5    1,288.8    11     18  

NYSE Volume (In billions)

   403.8    367.1    352.4    10     4  

NASDAQ® Volume (In billions)

   449.2    453.9    424.6    (1 )   7  

The S&P 500® Index was up 3% for the year, with average daily price levels up 7% from 2004. Performance for the NASDAQ® Index was up 1% for the year, with average daily prices up by 6%. Globally, the MSCI® EAFE index was up 11%. Combined NYSE and NASDAQ® non-program trading volumes were down an estimated 1% during the year. As the Company’s business model is more volume than price sensitive, this created a drag on the Company’s equity-linked businesses. The Lehman Brothers Aggregate Bondsm index was down 7%. Average fixed-income trading volume was up 14% offsetting some of the weakness in equities.

As of December 31, 2005, assets under custody rose to $10.9 trillion, from $9.7 trillion at December 31, 2004. The increase in assets under custody primarily reflects rising equity prices and new business wins. Equity securities composed 32% of the assets under custody at December 31, 2005 compared with 35% at December 31, 2004, while fixed income securities were 68% compared with 65% last year. Assets under custody in 2005 consisted of assets related to the custody and mutual funds businesses of $7.3 trillion, broker-dealer services assets of $2.2 trillion, and all other assets of $1.4 trillion.

The results for the businesses in the Institutional Service segment are discussed below.

Investor & Broker-Dealer Services Business

 

                    Inc/(Dec)  

(In millions)

   2005    2004    2003    2005 vs. 2004     2004 vs. 2003  

Net Interest Income

   $ 564    $ 518    $ 501    $ 46     $ 17  

Noninterest Income

     1,826      1,627      1,474      199       153  

Total Revenue

     2,390      2,145      1,975      245       170  

Provision for Credit Losses

     7      7      13      —         (6 )

Noninterest Expense

     1,636      1,441      1,316      195       125  

Income Before Taxes

     747      697      646      50       51  

Average Assets

     36,233      35,225      33,123      1,008       2,102  

Average Deposits

     28,316      26,231      24,671      2,085       1,560  

Nonperforming Assets

     5      28      55      (23 )     (27 )

Net Charge-offs

     —        4      24      (4 )     (20 )

In 2005, income before taxes in the Investor & Broker-Dealer Services business increased to $747 million from $697 million in 2004 and $646 million in 2003. The increase in 2005 reflects improvements in net interest income and noninterest income.

Noninterest income was $1,826 million in 2005, compared with $1,627 million in 2004 and $1,474 million in 2003. The increase in noninterest income in 2005 is attributable to an increase in both investor and broker-dealer service fees as well as foreign exchange and other trading revenue generated by clients in this segment.

 

16


Table of Contents

Investor services fees were up in both 2005 and 2004. The increase over 2004 reflects strength in global and domestic fund services and custody, as well as new business wins and strong organic growth. Securities lending fees showed good growth in 2005 benefiting from higher loan volumes, driven by new business wins as well as a favorable spread environment. In 2004, investor services fee growth resulted from good organic growth in most areas.

Broker-dealer services fees were up compared with 2004 and 2003. The increase in 2005 reflects higher volumes due to new business wins in the collateral management business and greater volumes in government securities clearance. The Company now handles approximately $1.1 trillion of financing for the Company’s broker-dealer clients daily through tri-party collateralized financing agreements, up 18% from a year ago. In 2004, increased broker-dealer services fees reflected higher volumes due to new business wins in the collateral management business and higher levels of mortgage-backed and government trading activity.

Net interest income in the Investor & Broker-Dealer Services business was $564 million in 2005, compared with $518 million in 2004 and $501 million in 2003. Net interest income growth in 2005 reflects increased deposit flows from customers in both businesses. The increase in net interest income in 2004 also reflected growth in deposits, primarily in investor services. Average deposits generated by the Investor & Broker-Dealer Services business were $28.3 billion in 2005, compared with $26.2 billion in 2004 and $24.7 billion in 2003. Average assets in the business were $36.2 billion in 2005, compared with $35.2 billion in 2004 and $33.1 billion in 2003.

Noninterest expense was $1,636 million in 2005, compared with $1,441 million in 2004 and $1,316 million in 2003. The rise in noninterest expense in 2005 was attributable primarily to higher salaries, benefits and sub-custody expenses tied to business growth, increased costs related to business continuity, and higher stock option and pension expenses. The increase in noninterest expense in 2004 was due to higher costs tied to increased activity levels, as well as the upfront expenses associated with the implementation of cost reduction initiatives and higher pension and option expense.

Net charge-offs were zero in 2005, compared with $4 million in 2004 and $24 million in 2003. Nonperforming assets were $5 million in 2005, compared with $28 million in 2004 and $55 million in 2003.

Execution & Clearing Services Business

 

                    Inc/(Dec)  

(In millions)

   2005    2004    2003    2005 vs. 2004     2004 vs. 2003  

Net Interest Income

   $ 211    $ 170    $ 108    $ 41     $ 62  

Noninterest Income

     1,327      1,242      959      85       283  

Total Revenue

     1,538      1,412      1,067      126       345  

Provision for Credit Losses

     1      1      1      —         —    

Noninterest Expense

     1,151      1,087      809      64       278  

Income Before Taxes

     386      324      257      62       67  

Average Assets

     15,478      15,122      11,022      356       4,100  

Average Payables to Customers and Broker-Dealers

     6,014      6,361      3,945      (347 )     2,416  

Nonperforming Assets

     —        2      3      (2 )     (1 )

Net Charge-offs

     8      10      1      (2 )     9  

In 2005, income before taxes in the Execution & Clearing Services Business increased to $386 million from $324 million and $257 million in 2004 and 2003. The increase in 2005 reflects strong growth in net interest income and higher value added fees at Pershing as well as incremental revenues and earnings contribution from the LJR acquisition in the execution business.

 

17


Table of Contents

Noninterest income was $1,327 million in 2005, compared with $1,242 million in 2004 and $959 million in 2003. The execution business benefited in 2005 from increased client activity, strong growth in transition management and incremental revenues from the LJR acquisition. These factors offset the relatively weak market environment, in which non-program trading volumes were down 1%.

Pershing’s 2005 noninterest income was up reflecting organic growth from value added fees, partially offset by business lost through client consolidation. The majority of Pershing’s revenues are generated from non-transactional activities, such as asset gathering, administration and other services. Pershing’s assets under administration were $749 billion at year-end 2005, compared with $706 billion at December 31, 2004. At year-end 2005, margin loans remained flat at $6.1 billion. In 2004, clearing services fees benefited from the full-year impact of Pershing and increased client activity.

In January 2006, a significant customer ended its clearing relationship with Pershing following its acquisition by a major broker-dealer. Pershing currently is in discussions seeking compensation for the termination of the relationship.

Execution and clearing service fees were $1,145 million in 2004, compared with $885 million in 2003. These businesses benefited from the full-year impact of Pershing, as well as increased client activity and strong growth in transition management.

Net interest income in the Execution and Clearing Services business was $211 million in 2005, compared with $170 million in 2004, and $108 million in 2003. Net interest income growth in 2005 and 2004 reflects the benefit of rising interest rates on spreads at Pershing. The year 2004 also benefited from the full-year impact of the Pershing acquisition. Average assets in the business were $15.5 billion in 2005, compared with $15.1 billion in 2004 and $11.0 billion in 2003.

Noninterest expense was $1,151 million in 2005, compared with $1,087 million in 2004 and $809 million in 2003. The rise in noninterest expense in 2005 was attributable to higher salaries, benefits and clearing expenses tied to both higher business activity overall as well as the LJR acquisition. The increase in noninterest expense in 2004 was due to stronger business activity and the full-year impact of the Pershing acquisition.

Net charge-offs were $8 million, $10 million, and $1 million in 2005, 2004, and 2003, respectively. The increase in charge-offs in 2004 is attributable to a credit loss in Pershing’s UK clearing business as a result of an alleged deceptive scheme perpetrated on Pershing. Nonperforming assets were zero in 2005, compared with $2 million in 2004 and $3 million in 2003.

Issuer Services Business

 

                    Inc/(Dec)  

(In millions)

   2005    2004    2003    2005 vs. 2004     2004 vs. 2003  

Net Interest Income

   $ 238    $ 214    $ 208    $ 24     $ 6  

Noninterest Income

     757      696      636      61       60  

Total Revenue

     995      910      844      85       66  

Provision for Credit Losses

     11      11      18      —         (7 )

Noninterest Expense

     458      426      393      32       33  

Income Before Taxes

     526      473      433      53       40  

Average Assets

     13,349      11,776      11,310      1,573       466  

Average Deposits

     8,357      7,396      7,124      961       272  

Nonperforming Assets

     5      30      56      (25 )     (26 )

Net Charge-offs

     —        4      25      (4 )     (21 )

In 2005, income before taxes in the Issuer Services Business increased to $526 million from $473 million in 2004 and $433 million in 2003. The increase in 2005 reflects growth in net interest income tied primarily to corporate trust, and higher fees in both depositary receipts and corporate trust.

 

18


Table of Contents

Noninterest income was $757 million in 2005, compared with $696 million in 2004 and $636 million in 2003. In 2005, the increase reflects higher levels of trading activity and greater corporate actions in depositary receipts, as well as continued strength in international issuance and structured products in corporate trust. The European corporate trust market is growing rapidly and the Company was able to attract significant amounts of new business. In 2004, the increase reflects strong growth in depositary receipts and solid results in corporate trust.

The overall environment for depositary receipts has improved steadily from 2003 to 2005, with trading volumes increasing at a compound rate of 9%. The trend in net issuance has been strong, fueled by increased cross-border activity. The value of foreign equities held by U.S. investors has increased from 13% in 2003 to 16% in 2005. In addition, the increase in cross-border merger and acquisitions and capital raisings has been strong, particularly in 2005.

The growth in corporate trust fees has been solid over the period. The principal growth drivers have been the structured and international product areas, where the markets are growing more rapidly and the Company is gaining market share.

Net interest income in the Issuer Services business was $238 million in 2005, compared with $214 million in 2004 and $208 million in 2003. Net interest income growth in 2005 reflects the positive impact of rising rates on spreads and increased deposit levels generated by the corporate trust business. The increase in net interest income in 2004 was also driven by the increase in interest rates during the period. Average deposits generated by the Issuer Services business were $8.4 billion in 2005, compared with $7.4 billion in 2004 and $7.1 billion in 2003. Average assets in the business were $13.3 billion in 2005, compared with $11.8 billion in 2004 and $11.3 billion in 2003.

Noninterest expense was $458 million in 2005, compared with $426 million in 2004 and $393 million in 2003. The rise in noninterest expense in 2005 and 2004 was attributable to increased client activity as well as higher technology, stock option and pension expenses.

Net charge-offs were zero in 2005, compared with $4 million in 2004 and $25 million in 2003. Nonperforming assets were $5 million in 2005, compared with $30 million in 2004 and $56 million in 2003.

Treasury Services Business

 

                    Inc/(Dec)  

(In millions)

   2005    2004    2003    2005 vs. 2004     2004 vs. 2003  

Net Interest Income

   $ 173    $ 162    $ 154    $ 11     $ 8  

Noninterest Income

     272      265      268      7       (3 )

Total Revenue

     445      427      422      18       5  

Provision for Credit Losses

     40      40      69      —         (29 )

Noninterest Expense

     199      186      173      13       13  

Income Before Taxes

     206      201      180      5       21  

Average Assets

     10,622      10,163      8,497      459       1,666  

Average Deposits

     7,914      8,793      8,810      (879 )     (17 )

Nonperforming Assets

     16      95      177      (79 )     (82 )

Net Charge-offs

     2      14      79      (12 )     (65 )

In 2005, income before taxes in the Treasury Services Business was $206 million, compared with $201 million in 2004 and $180 million in 2003. The moderate growth rate of this segment reflects both the Company’s overall strategy to reduce corporate credit exposures as part of its risk reduction efforts, as well as specific initiatives to reduce the number and size of credit relationships with clients that do not use other securities servicing products. The results in 2005 reflect the continued strong credit environment. The improvement in 2004 over 2003 is primarily attributable to lower credit costs resulting from the reduction in credit risk as well as favorable conditions in credit markets.

 

19


Table of Contents

The increase in noninterest income to $272 million in the current year from $265 million in 2004 was due to higher capital market fees associated with clients in this segment, partially offset by lower fees from global payments as more clients used compensating balances to pay for services.

The Treasury Services business’s net interest income was $173 million in 2005, compared with $162 million in 2004 and $154 million in 2003. The increase in 2005 reflects customers’ increased use of compensating balances to pay for global payment services, partially offset by the impact of the credit reduction program. Credit spreads were lower, reflecting the higher asset quality of the portfolio. Average assets for 2005 were $10.6 billion, compared with $10.2 billion in 2004 and $8.5 billion in 2003. Average deposits were $7.9 billion versus $8.8 billion in 2004 and $8.8 billion in 2003.

The provision for credit losses, which is assessed on a long-term credit cycle basis (see “Business Segment Accounting Principles”), was $40 million in 2005 compared with $40 million in 2004 and $69 million in 2003. The decrease in 2004 compared to 2003 principally reflects the benefits of the Company’s corporate credit risk reduction program. Over the past several years, the Company has been seeking to improve its overall risk profile by reducing its credit exposures through elimination of non-strategic exposures, cutting back large individual exposures and avoiding outsized industry concentrations. Since 2001, the Company has reduced credit exposure to its corporate client base by 41%. In 2002, the Company set a goal of reducing corporate credit exposure to $24 billion by December 31, 2004. This goal was accomplished in early 2004 and exposures have since declined to $23.3 billion.

Net charge-offs in the Treasury Services business were $2 million, $14 million, and $79 million in 2005, 2004, and 2003. The charge-offs in 2004 primarily relate to loans to media, corporate, and foreign borrowers. The charge-offs in 2003 primarily relate to corporate borrowers. Nonperforming assets were $16 million in 2005, compared with $95 million in 2004 and $177 million in 2003. The decrease in nonperforming assets in 2005 primarily reflects loan sales, paydowns and charge-offs of commercial loans. The decrease in nonperforming assets in 2004 primarily reflects the sale of $43 million of loans to the operating subsidiaries of a major cable company as well as paydowns and charge-offs of domestic and foreign commercial loans.

Noninterest expense in 2005 was $199 million, compared to $186 million in 2004 and $173 million in 2003. The increase in noninterest expense in 2005 and 2004 was due in part to a higher pension expense, stock option expensing, and an increase in incentive compensation tied to revenues.

Private Bank and BNY Asset Management Segment

 

                    Inc/(Dec)  

(In millions)

   2005    2004    2003    2005 vs. 2004     2004 vs. 2003  

Net Interest Income

   $ 65    $ 61    $ 60    $ 4     $ 1  

Noninterest Income

     454      416      348      38       68  

Total Revenue

     519      477      408      42       69  

Provision for Credit Losses

     3      3      —        —         3  

Noninterest Expense

     317      288      233      29       55  

Income Before Taxes

     199      186      175      13       11  

Average Assets

     2,205      2,144      2,027      61       117  

Average Deposits

     1,673      1,616      1,765      57       (149 )

Nonperforming Assets

     1      1      8      —         (7 )

Net Charge-offs

     —        5      7      (5 )     (2 )

In 2005, income before taxes in the Private Bank and BNY Asset Management Segment was $199 million, compared with $186 million in 2004 and $175 million in 2003. The improvement over the period is primarily attributable to strong revenue growth at Ivy Asset Management.

 

20


Table of Contents

Noninterest income was $454 million in 2005, compared with $416 million in 2004 and $348 million in 2003. Private Bank and BNY Asset Management revenues in 2005 were up compared with 2004 and 2003. The increase in 2005 reflects strong growth at Ivy, higher fees in private client services, and higher equity price levels. The S&P 500® Index was up 3% for the year, with average daily price levels up 7% from 2004. Performance for the NASDAQ® Index was up 1% for the year, with average daily prices up by 6%. In 2004, the increase reflects strong growth at Ivy, higher fees in private client services, and higher equity price. In 2004, Ivy opened an office in Tokyo to serve the expanding market for hedge fund products in Asia. Ivy successfully launched its London office in 2003.

Assets Under Management—Asset Management Sector

 

(In billions)—Estimated

   2005     2004     2003  

Total Assets Under Management

   105     102     89  

Equity Securities

   35 %   36 %   34 %

Fixed Income Securities

   20     21     22  

Alternative Investments

   14     15     10  

Liquid Assets

   31     28     34  

Assets under management (“AUM”) were $105 billion at December 31, 2005, compared with $102 billion at December 31, 2004 and $89 million at December 31, 2003. The increase in assets under management for 2005 reflects growth in Ivy, institutional equity products, and liquid assets as well as a rise in equity market values. Institutional clients represent 68% of AUM while individual clients equal 32%. AUM at December 31, 2005, are 35% invested in equities, 20% in fixed income, and 14% in alternative investments, with the remaining amount in liquid assets.

Net interest income in the Private Bank and BNY Asset Management segment was $65 million in 2005, compared with $61 million in 2004 and $60 million in 2003. Net interest income growth in 2005 and 2004 reflects wider spreads given higher interest rates. Average deposits generated by the Private Bank and BNY Asset Management segment were $1.7 billion in 2005, compared with $1.6 billion in 2004 and $1.8 billion in 2003. Average assets in the segment were $2.2 billion in 2005, compared with $2.1 billion in 2004 and $2.0 billion in 2003.

Noninterest expense was $317 million in 2005, compared with $288 million in 2004 and $233 million in 2003. The rise in noninterest expense in 2005 and 2004 was attributable to higher salaries, employee benefits, and technology costs.

Net charge-offs were zero, $5 million, and $7 million in 2005, 2004, and 2003. Nonperforming assets were $1 million in 2005, compared with $1 million and $8 million in 2004 and 2003.

 

21


Table of Contents

Retail & Middle Market Banking Segment

 

                    Inc/(Dec)  

(In millions)

   2005    2004    2003    2005 vs. 2004     2004 vs. 2003  

Net Interest Income

   $ 650    $ 616    $ 597    $ 34     $ 19  

Noninterest Income

     245      255      261      (10 )     (6 )

Total Revenue

     895      871      858      24       13  

Provision for Credit Losses

     29      31      31      (2 )     —    

Noninterest Expense

     511      484      474      27       10  

Income Before Taxes

     355      356      353      (1 )     3  

Average Assets

     13,778      15,166      15,996      (1,388 )     (830 )

Average Noninterest-Bearing Deposits

     5,626      5,572      5,477      54       95  

Average Deposits

     15,709      16,907      16,167      (1,198 )     740  

Nonperforming Assets

     34      52      42      (18 )     10  

Net Charge-offs

     36      31      41      5       (10 )

Number of Branches

     342      341      341      1       —    

Number of ATMs

     401      378      378      23       —    

In 2005, income before taxes was $355 million, compared with $356 million in 2004 and $353 million in 2003.

Net interest income in the Retail & Middle Market Banking Segment was $650 million in 2005, compared with $616 million in 2004 and $597 million in 2003. Net interest income growth in both 2005 and 2004 reflects the benefit of higher rates on interest spreads, growth in consumer loans, and the increasing number of small business customers’ use of compensating balances to pay for services.

Average deposits generated by the Retail & Middle Market Banking Segment were $15.7 billion in 2005, compared with $16.9 billion in 2004 and $16.2 billion in 2003. Average noninterest-bearing deposits were $5.6 billion in 2005, compared with $5.6 billion in 2004 and $5.5 billion in 2003. Average assets in the Retail & Middle Market Banking segment were $13.8 billion, compared with $15.2 billion in 2004 and $16.0 billion in 2003.

Noninterest income was $245 million in 2005, compared with $255 million in 2004 and $261 million in 2003. The decline in noninterest income in 2005 is attributable to lower monthly checking fees, lower gains from the sale of consumer loans given the Company’s decision to retain more consumer loans, and small business customers using compensating balances rather than fees to pay for services.

Noninterest expense was $511 million in 2005, compared with $484 million in 2004 and $474 million in 2003. The rise in noninterest expense in 2005 and 2004 was primarily attributable to higher pension, option, marketing, occupancy, and consultant expenses.

Net charge-offs were $36 million, $31 million, and $41 million in 2005, 2004, and 2003. Nonperforming assets were $34 million in 2005, compared with $52 million in 2004 and $42 million in 2003.

 

22


Table of Contents

Corporate and Other

 

                       Inc/(Dec)  

(In millions)

   2005     2004     2003     2005 vs. 2004     2004 vs. 2003  

Net Interest Income

   $ 8     $ (96 )   $ (19 )   $ 104     $ (77 )

Noninterest Income

     75       149       50       (74 )     99  

Total Revenue

     83       53       31       30       22  

Provision for Credit Losses

     (76 )     (78 )     23       2       (101 )

Noninterest Expense

     211       210       300       1       (90 )

Income Before Taxes

     (52 )     (79 )     (292 )     27       213  

Average Assets

     9,770       9,744       9,492       26       252  

Nonperforming Assets

     18       6       8       12       (2 )

Net Charge-offs

     140       15       5       125       10  

In 2005, income before taxes in the Corporate and Other Segment was a loss of $52 million, compared with a loss of $79 million and $292 million in 2004 and 2003.

Net interest income in the Corporate and Other Segment was $8 million in 2005, compared with a loss of $96 million in 2004 and a loss of $19 million in 2003. Net interest income in 2004 included the SFAS 13 cumulative adjustments to the leasing portfolio, which reduced net interest income by $66 million. Excluding the impact of this adjustment, the increase in net interest income in 2005 reflects lower earnings from the leasing portfolio, given the rising rate environment.

Noninterest income was $75 million in 2005, compared with $149 million in 2004 and $50 million in 2003. The decline in noninterest income in 2005 is attributable to both lower securities gains and lower gains from corporate asset sales in 2005 compared with 2004, given the $48 million gain on the sale of 5% of the Company’s stake in Wing Hang Bank in 2004. Securities gains were $68 million in 2005, compared to $78 million in 2004 and $35 million in 2003. In 2004, securities gains included $19 million of higher than anticipated gains from four large sponsor funds.

Provision for credit losses was a credit of $76 million in 2005, compared with a $78 million credit in 2004 and a $23 million expense in 2003. The provision for credit losses reflects the difference between the aggregate of the credit provision over a credit cycle assigned to the other segments and the Company’s recorded provision. The SFAS 13 aircraft adjustments lowered the provision by $7 million in 2004.

Noninterest expense, largely reflecting unallocated corporate overhead, amortization of goodwill, and nonrecurring items, was $211 million in 2005, compared with $210 million in 2004 and $300 million in 2003. The decrease in noninterest expense in 2004 versus 2003 was due to the $96 million of merger and integration costs associated with Pershing and the $78 million GMAC settlement in 2003, partially offset by growth in corporate overhead and goodwill amortization in 2004.

Net charge-offs were $140 million for 2005, compared to $15 million for 2004 and $5 million for 2003. The charge-offs in 2005 are attributable to the Company’s airline leasing portfolio.

 

23


Table of Contents

Significant other items related to the Corporate and Other segment for the past three years are presented in the following table.

 

(In millions)

       2005             2004             2003      

Items impacting net interest income:

      

Cost to Carry Goodwill

   (99 )   (105 )   (95 )

Tax Equivalent Basis

   (29 )   (30 )   (35 )

SFAS 13 Lease Adjustment

   —       (66 )   —    

Items impacting noninterest income:

      

Gain on Sale of FMC

   17     —       —    

Gain on Sale of Wing Hang

   —       48     —    

Other Gains

   —       —       16  

Items impacting noninterest expense:

      

Severance Costs

   5     12     6  

Goodwill and Intangibles Amortization

   40     34     25  

Pershing Integration Expenses

   —       —       96  

RW and Other Regulatory Matters

   24     30     —    

GMAC Settlement

   —       —       78  

Lease Termination

   —       8     —    

Other items—Acquisitions are the responsibility of corporate management. Accordingly, goodwill and the funding cost of goodwill are assigned to the Corporate and Other segment. If the funding cost of goodwill was allocated to the other three segments, it would be assigned based on the goodwill attributable to each segment.

The tax equivalent adjustment is eliminated in the Corporate and Other Segment. Certain revenue and expense items have been driven by corporate decisions and have been included in the Corporate and Other Segment. In 2005, these include the $17 million gain on the sale of FMC and the $24 million charge for the Russian Funds transfer matter and other regulatory matters. Alternatively these items could be allocated to the Institutional Services Segment. In 2004, the $48 million gain on the sale of Wing Hang would be attributable to the Institutional Services Segment. The 2004 charge for the RW Matter would be attributable to the Retail & Middle Market Banking Segment.

Severance and lease termination costs in 2004 primarily relate to the Institutional Services Segment and to staff areas that cut across all business lines. Intangible amortization primarily relates to the Institutional Services Segment. In 2003, the GMAC settlement and the Pershing integration expenses are attributable to the Institutional Services Segment.

 

24


Table of Contents

The consolidating schedule below shows the contribution of the Company’s businesses to its overall profitability.

 

(Dollars in millions)

For the Year Ended
December 31, 2005

  Investor &
Broker-Dealer
Services
   

Execution

& Clearing

Services

   

Issuer

Services

   

Treasury

Services

   

Sub-total

Institutional

Services

   

Private

Bank &

BNY Asset

Management

   

Retail &

Middle

Market

   

Corporate

and Other

    Total

Net Interest Income

  $ 564     $ 211     $ 238     $ 173     $ 1,186     $ 65     $ 650     $ 8     $ 1,909

Noninterest Income

    1,826       1,327       757       272       4,182       454       245       75       4,956

Total Revenue

    2,390       1,538       995       445       5,368       519       895       83       6,865

Provision for Credit Losses

    7       1       11       40       59       3       29       (76 )     15

Noninterest Expense

    1,636       1,151       458       199       3,444       317       511       211       4,483
                                                                     

Income Before Taxes

  $ 747     $ 386     $ 526     $ 206     $ 1,865     $ 199     $ 355     $ (52 )   $ 2,367
                                                                     

Contribution Percentage*

    31 %     16 %     22 %     8 %     77 %     8 %     15 %    

Average Assets

  $ 36,233     $ 15,478     $ 13,349     $ 10,622     $ 75,682     $ 2,205     $ 13,778     $ 9,770     $ 101,435

(Dollars in millions)

For the Year Ended
December 31, 2004

  Investor &
Broker-Dealer
Services
    Execution
& Clearing
Services
    Issuer
Services
    Treasury
Services
    Sub-total
Institutional
Services
    Private
Bank &
BNY Asset
Management
    Retail &
Middle
Market
    Corporate
and Other
    Total

Net Interest Income

  $ 518     $ 170     $ 214     $ 162     $ 1,064     $ 61     $ 616     $ (96 )   $ 1,645

Noninterest Income

    1,627       1,242       696       265       3,830       416       255       149       4,650

Total Revenue

    2,145       1,412       910       427       4,894       477       871       53       6,295

Provision for Credit Losses

    7       1       11       40       59       3       31       (78 )     15

Noninterest Expense

    1,441       1,087       426       186       3,140       288       484       210       4,122
                                                                     

Income Before Taxes

  $ 697     $ 324     $ 473     $ 201     $ 1,695     $ 186     $ 356     $ (79 )   $ 2,158
                                                                     

Contribution Percentage*

    31 %     15 %     21 %     9 %     76 %     8 %     16 %    

Average Assets

  $ 35,225     $ 15,122     $ 11,776     $ 10,163     $ 72,286     $ 2,144     $ 15,166     $ 9,744     $ 99,340

(Dollars in millions)

For the Year Ended
December 31, 2003

  Investor &
Broker-Dealer
Services
    Execution
& Clearing
Services
    Issuer
Services
    Treasury
Services
    Sub-total
Institutional
Services
    Private
Bank &
BNY Asset
Management
    Retail &
Middle
Market
    Corporate
and Other
    Total

Net Interest Income

  $ 501     $ 108     $ 208     $ 154     $ 971     $ 60     $ 597     $ (19 )   $ 1,609

Noninterest Income

    1,474       959       636       268       3,337       348       261       50       3,996

Total Revenue

    1,975       1,067       844       422       4,308       408       858       31       5,605

Provision for Credit Losses

    13       1       18       69       101       —         31       23       155

Noninterest Expense

    1,316       809       393       173       2,691       233       474       300       3,698
                                                                     

Income Before Taxes

  $ 646     $ 257     $ 433     $ 180     $ 1,516     $ 175     $ 353     $ (292 )   $ 1,752
                                                                     

Contribution Percentage*

    31 %     13 %     21 %     9 %     74 %     9 %     17 %    

Average Assets

  $ 33,123     $ 11,022     $ 11,310     $ 8,497     $ 63,952     $ 2,027     $ 15,996     $ 9,492     $ 91,467

*As a percent of total income before tax excluding Corporate and Other.

Foreign Operations

The Company’s primary foreign activities consist of securities servicing and global payment services. Target customers include financial service companies, pension funds and securities issuers worldwide. The Company’s international clearing business delivers clearing and financial services outsourcing solutions in 65 countries. In Execution, the Company provides institutional trade execution services in over 80 global markets, including 50 emerging markets.

 

25


Table of Contents

In Investor Services, the Company is a leading global custodian. In the United Kingdom the Company provides a full global and local product set. In Continental Europe a full global product set is provided with access to local markets through strategic partnerships. Off-shore mutual fund servicing capabilities for funds registered in Dublin, the Channel Islands, Luxembourg and Singapore are provided through operations in Luxembourg and Dublin.

In Issuer Services, the Company has been a leader in the ADR market, currently acting as the depositary receipts agent for 64% of all publicly sponsored listings by foreign companies. For debt issuance, the Company is one of the leading corporate trust providers for global debt issuance.

In the Asia-Pacific region, the Company has over 50 years experience providing trade and cash services to financial institutions and central banks. In addition, the Company offers a broad range of servicing and fiduciary products to financial institutions, corporations and central banks depending on the state of market development. In emerging markets, the Company leads with global payments and issuer services, introducing other products as the markets mature. For more established markets, the Company focus is on global, not local, investor services products and alternative investments.

The Company is also a leading provider and major market maker in the area of foreign exchange and interest-rate risk management services, dealing in over 100 currencies, and provides traditional trust and banking services to customers domiciled outside of the United States, principally in Europe and Asia. Ivy UK provides clients in Europe and the Middle East with hedge fund of funds investment advisory services.

Major operation centers are based in London, England; Brussels, Belgium; and Singapore with additional subsidiaries, branches, and representative offices in 33 countries.

International clients accounted for 25% of revenue and 18% of net income in 2005. The Company has approximately 3,699 employees in Europe and 1,693 in Asia. Foreign revenue, income before income taxes, net income and assets from foreign operations are shown in the table below.

 

     2005   2004   2003

(In millions)

Geographic Data

  Revenues  

Income

Before

Income

Taxes

 

Net

Income

 

Total

Assets

  Revenues  

Income

Before

Income

Taxes

 

Net

Income

 

Total

Assets

  Revenues  

Income

Before

Income

Taxes

   

Net

Income

   

Total

Assets

Domestic

  $ 5,177   $ 1,933   $ 1,283   $ 75,795   $ 4,703   $ 1,706   $ 1,139   $ 74,343   $ 4,367   $ 1,442     $ 952     $ 72,830

Europe

    1,209     306     203     19,414     1,140     308     205     15,062     943     286       189       13,771

Asia

    298     97     64     4,828     306     135     90     3,759     184     25       17       4,348

Other

    181     31     21     2,037     146     9     6     1,365     111     (1 )     (1 )     1,448
                                                                           

Total

  $ 6,865   $ 2,367   $ 1,571   $ 102,074   $ 6,295   $ 2,158   $ 1,440   $ 94,529   $ 5,605   $ 1,752     $ 1,157     $ 92,397
                                                                           

In 2005, revenues from Europe were $1,209 million, compared with $1,140 million in 2004 and $943 million in 2003. Excluding the 2004 impact of a SFAS 13 leasing adjustment, revenues in Europe were up 11% in 2005. The increase in 2005 reflects strong growth in investor and issuer service revenues. The increase in 2004 reflects the positive impact of a SFAS 13 leasing adjustment, full-year impact of the Pershing acquisition, new business growth, increased revenue from depositary receipts, and Ivy. Revenues from Asia were $298 million in 2005, compared with $306 million and $184 million in 2004 and 2003, respectively. The slight decrease in Asia in 2005 was primarily due to the large gain in 2004 related to Wing Hang Bank. Excluding the impact of the 2004 Wing Hang Bank sale, revenues in Asia were up 16% in 2005 reflecting strength in investor services, execution services and Ivy. Net income from Europe was $203 million in 2005, compared with $205 million and $189 million in 2004 and 2003, respectively. Net income from Asia was $64 million in 2005, compared with $90 million and $17 million in 2004 and 2003, respectively. Net income in Europe and Asia were driven by the same factors affecting revenue. In addition, in 2005 and 2004, net income in Europe was adversely impacted by the strength of the Euro and Sterling versus the dollar.

 

26


Table of Contents

Cross-Border Risk

Foreign assets are subject to general risks attendant to the conduct of business in each foreign country, including economic uncertainties and each foreign government’s regulations. In addition, the Company’s foreign assets may be affected by changes in demand or pricing resulting from fluctuations in currency exchange rates or other factors. Cross-border outstandings include loans, acceptances, interest-bearing deposits with other banks, other interest bearing investments, and other monetary assets which are denominated in dollars or other non-local currency. Also included are local currency outstandings not hedged or funded by local borrowings.

The tables below show the Company’s cross-border outstandings for the last three years where cross-border exposure exceeds 1.00% of total assets (denoted with “*”) or 0.75% of total assets (denoted with “**”).

 

(In millions)

 

2005

   Germany*   

United

Kingdom*

   Netherlands*    France*    Belgium**    Switzerland**

Banks and other Financial Institutions

   $ 2,216    $ 571    $ 1,010    $ 740    $ 634    $ 744

Public Sector

     185      —        —        169      49      —  

Commercial, Industrial and Other

     406      1,256      570      203      257      141
                                         

Total Cross-Border Outstandings

   $ 2,807    $ 1,827    $ 1,580    $ 1,112    $ 940    $ 885
                                         

 

(In millions)

 

2004

   Germany*    United
Kingdom*
   France*

Banks and other Financial Institutions

   $ 2,586    $ 307    $ 850

Public Sector

     176      —        128

Commercial, Industrial and Other

     433      776      302
                    

Total Cross-Border Outstandings

   $ 3,195    $ 1,083    $ 1,280
                    

 

(In millions)

 

2003

   Germany*    United
Kingdom*
   Belgium*    Netherlands*    France**

Banks and other Financial Institutions

   $ 1,988    $ 1,048    $ 815    $ 719    $ 473

Public Sector

     169      1      217      —        143

Commercial, Industrial and Other

     377      885      108      359      299
                                  

Total Cross-Border Outstandings

   $ 2,534    $ 1,934    $ 1,140    $ 1,078    $ 915
                                  

CRITICAL ACCOUNTING POLICIES

The Company’s significant accounting policies are described in the Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements under “Summary of Significant Accounting and Reporting Policies”. Four of the Company’s more critical accounting policies are those related to the allowance for credit losses, the valuation of derivatives and securities where quoted market prices are not available, goodwill and other intangibles, and pension accounting. In addition to the “Summary of Significant Accounting and Reporting Policies” footnote, further information on policies related to the allowance for credit losses can be found under “Asset Quality and Allowance for Credit Losses” in the MD&A. Further information on the valuation of derivatives and securities where quoted market prices are not available can be found under “Market Risk Management” and “Trading Activities and Risk Management” in the MD&A section and in “Fair Value of Financial Instruments” in the Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements. Further information on goodwill and intangible assets can be found in “Goodwill and Intangibles” in the Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements. Additional information on pensions can be found in “Employee Benefit Plans” in the Notes to the Consolidated Financial Statements.

 

27


Table of Contents

Allowance for Credit Losses

The allowance for credit losses and allowance for lending-related commitments consist of four elements: (1) an allowance for impaired credits; (2) an allowance for higher risk rated loans and exposures; (3) an allowance for pass rated loans and exposures; and (4) an unallocated allowance based on general economic conditions and certain risk factors in the Company’s individual portfolio and markets. Further discussion on the four elements can be found under “Asset Quality and Allowance for Credit Losses” in the MD&A section.

The allowance for credit losses represents management’s estimate of probable losses inherent in the Company’s loan portfolio. This evaluation process is subject to numerous estimates and judgments. Probability of default ratings are assigned after analyzing the credit quality of each borrower/counterparty and the Company’s internal rating are generally consistent with external ratings agency’s default databases. Loss given default ratings are driven by the collateral, structure, and seniority of each individual asset and are consistent with external loss given default/recovery databases. The portion of the allowance related to impaired credits is based on the present value of future cash flows. Changes in the estimates of probability of default, risk ratings, loss given default/recovery rates, and cash flows could have a direct impact on the allocated allowance for loan losses.

To the extent actual results differ from forecasts or management’s judgment, the allowance for credit losses may be greater or less than future charge-offs.

The Company considers it difficult to quantify the impact of changes in forecast on its allowance for credit losses. Nevertheless, the Company believes the following discussion may enable investors to better understand the variables that drive the allowance for credit losses.

A key variable in determining the allowance is management’s judgment in determining the size of the unallocated allowance. At December 31, 2005, the unallocated allowance was 17% of the total allowance. If the unallocated allowance were five percent higher or lower, the allowance would have increased or decreased by $28 million, respectively.

The credit rating assigned to each credit is another significant variable in determining the allowance. If each credit were rated one grade better, the allowance would have decreased by $96 million, while if each credit were rated one grade worse, the allowance would have increased by $151 million.

Similarly, if the loss given default were one rating worse, the allowance would have increased by $62 million, while if the loss given default were one rating better, the allowance would have decreased by $56 million.

For impaired credits, if the fair value of the loans were 10% higher or lower, the allowance would have increased or decreased by $3 million, respectively.

Valuation of Derivatives and Securities Where Quoted Market Prices Are Not Available

When quoted market prices are not available for derivatives and securities values, such values are determined at estimated fair value, which is defined as the value at which positions could be closed out or sold in a transaction with a willing counterparty over a period of time consistent with the Company’s trading or investment strategy. Fair value for these instruments is determined based on discounted cash flow analysis, comparison to similar instruments, and the use of financial models. Financial models use as their basis independently-sourced market parameters including, for example, interest rate yield curves, option volatilities, and currency rates. Discounted cash flow analysis is dependent upon estimated future cash flows and the level of interest rates. Model-based pricing uses inputs of observable prices for interest rates, foreign exchange rates, option volatilities and other factors. Models are benchmarked and validated by independent parties. The Company’s valuation process takes into consideration factors such as counterparty credit quality, liquidity and

 

28


Table of Contents

concentration concerns. The Company applies judgment in the application of these factors. In addition, the Company must apply judgment when no external parameters exist. Finally, other factors can affect the Company’s estimate of fair value, including market dislocations, incorrect model assumptions, and unexpected correlations.

These valuation methods could expose the Company to materially different results should the models used or underlying assumptions be inaccurate. See “Use of Estimates” in the Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements “Summary of Significant Accounting and Reporting Policies”.

To assist in assessing the impact of a change in valuation, at December 31, 2005, approximately $2.2 billion of the Company’s portfolio of securities and derivatives is not priced based on quoted market prices. A change of 2.5% in the valuation of these securities and derivatives would result in a change in pre-tax income of $56 million.

Goodwill and Other Intangibles

The Company records all assets and liabilities acquired in purchase acquisitions, including goodwill, indefinite-lived intangibles, and other intangibles, at fair value as required by SFAS 141. Goodwill ($3,619 million at December 31, 2005) and indefinite-lived intangible assets ($370 million at December 31, 2005) are not amortized but are subject to annual tests for impairment or more often if events or circumstances indicate they may be impaired. Other intangible assets are amortized over their estimated useful lives and are subject to impairment if events or circumstances indicate a possible inability to realize the carrying amount. The initial recording of goodwill and other intangibles requires subjective judgments concerning estimates of the fair value of the acquired assets. The goodwill impairment test is performed in two phases. The first step compares the fair value of the reporting unit with its carrying amount, including goodwill. If the fair value of the reporting unit exceeds its carrying amount, goodwill of the reporting unit is considered not impaired; however, if the carrying amount of the reporting unit exceeds its fair value, an additional procedure must be performed. That additional procedure compares the implied fair value of the reporting unit’s goodwill with the carrying amount of that goodwill. An impairment loss is recorded to the extent that the carrying amount of goodwill exceeds its implied fair value. Indefinite-lived intangible assets are evaluated for impairment at least annually by comparing their fair value to their carrying value.

Other identifiable intangible assets ($441 million at December 31, 2005) are evaluated for impairment if events and circumstances indicate a possible impairment. Such evaluation of other intangible assets is based on undiscounted cash flow projections. Fair value may be determined using: market prices, comparison to similar assets, market multiples, discounted cash flow analysis and other determinants. Estimated cash flows may extend far into the future and, by their nature, are difficult to determine over an extended timeframe. Factors that may significantly affect the estimates include, among others, competitive forces, customer behaviors and attrition, changes in revenue growth trends, cost structures and technology, and changes in discount rates and specific industry or market sector conditions. Other key judgments in accounting for intangibles include useful life and classification between goodwill and indefinite-lived intangibles or other intangibles which require amortization. See “Goodwill and Intangibles” in the Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements for additional information regarding intangible assets.

To assist in assessing the impact of a goodwill or intangible asset impairment charge, at December 31, 2005, the Company has $4.4 billion of goodwill and intangible assets. The impact of a 5% impairment charge would result in a reduction in pre-tax income of approximately $222 million.

Pension Accounting

The Company has defined benefit plans covering approximately 13,900 U.S. employees and approximately 3,175 non-US employees.

 

29


Table of Contents

The Company has three defined benefit pension plans in the U.S. and six overseas. The U.S. plans account for 82% of the projected benefit obligation. Pension expense was $26 million in 2005 while there were pension credits in 2004 and 2003 of $24 million and $39 million. In addition to its pension plans, the Company also has an Employee Stock Ownership Plan (“ESOP”) which may provide additional benefits to certain employees. Upon retirement, covered employees are entitled to the higher of their benefit under the ESOP or the defined benefit plan. If the benefit is higher under the defined benefit plan, the employees’ ESOP account is contributed to the pension plan.

A number of key assumption and measurement date values determine pension expense. The key elements include the long-term rate of return on plan assets, the discount rate, the market-related value of plan assets, and for the primary U.S. plan the price used to value stock in the ESOP. Since 2003, these key elements have varied as follows:

 

(Dollars in millions, except per share amounts)

   2006     2005     2004     2003  

Domestic Plans:

        

Long-Term Rate of Return on Plan Assets

     7.88 %     8.25 %     8.75 %     9.00 %

Discount Rate

     5.88       6.00       6.25       6.50  

Market-Related Value of Plan Assets(1)

   $ 1,324     $ 1,502     $ 1,523     $ 1,483  

ESOP Stock Price(1)

     30.46       30.67       27.88       33.30  

Net U.S Pension Credit/(Expense)

     $ (17 )   $ 31     $ 46  

All other Pension Credit/(Expense)

       (9 )     (7 )     (7 )
                          

Total Pension Credit/(Expense)

     $ (26 )   $ 24     $ 39  
                          

(1) Actuarially smoothed data. See “Summary of Significant Accounting and Reporting Policies” in Notes to the Consolidated Financial Statements.

The discount rate for U.S. pension plans was determined after reviewing a number of high quality long-term bond indices whose yields were adjusted to match the duration of the Company’s pension liability. The Company also reviewed the results of several models that matched bonds to the Company’s pension cash flows. The various indices and models produced discount rates ranging from 5.68% to 6.2%. After reviewing the various indices and models the Company selected a discount rate of 5.875%. The discount rates for foreign pension plans are based on high quality corporate bonds rates in countries that have an active corporate bond market. In those countries with no active corporate bond market, discount rates are based on local government bond rates plus a credit spread.

The Company’s expected long-term rate of return on plan assets is based on anticipated returns for each asset class. At September 30, 2005 and 2004, the assumptions for the long-term rates of return on plan assets were 7.88% and 8.25%, respectively. Anticipated returns are weighted for the target allocation for each asset class. Anticipated returns are based on forecasts for prospective returns in the equity and fixed income markets, which should track the long-term historical returns for these markets. The Company also considers the growth outlook for U.S. and global economies, as well as current and prospective interest rates.

The market-related value of plan assets also influences the level of pension expense. Differences between expected and actual returns are recognized over five years to compute an actuarially derived market-related value of plan assets. In 2005, the market-related value of plan assets declined as the extraordinary actual return in 2000 was replaced with a more modest return.

Unrecognized actuarial gains and losses are amortized over the future service period (11 years) of active employees if they exceed a threshold amount. The Company currently has unrecognized losses which are being amortized.

 

30


Table of Contents

For 2005, U.S. pension expense increased by $48 million reflecting changes in assumptions, the amortization of unrecognized pension losses and a decline in the market-related value of plan assets. These same factors are expected to further increase pension expense in 2006. To reduce the impact of these factors, the Company changed certain of its domestic defined benefit pension plans during the third quarter of 2005. The primary change was to switch the computation of the benefits from final average pay to career average pay effective January 1, 2006. As a result U.S. pension expense is expected to increase by approximately $21 million.

The annual impacts on the primary U.S. plan of hypothetical changes in the key elements on the pension expense are shown in the tables below.

 

(Dollars in millions)

  

Increase in

Pension Expense

    2006 Base    

Decrease in

Pension Expense

 

Long-Term Rate of Return on Plan Assets

     6.88 %     7.38 %     7.88 %     8.38 %     8.88 %

Change in Pension Expense

   $ 16.0     $ 7.9       N/A     $ 7.9     $ 15.7  

Discount Rate

     5.38 %     5.63 %     5.88 %     6.13 %     6.38 %

Change in Pension Expense

   $ 14.9     $ 7.2       N/A     $ 6.9     $ 13.4  

Market-Related Value of Plan Assets

     -20.00 %     -10.00 %   $ 1,324       +10.00 %     +20.00 %

Change in Pension Expense

   $ 50.8     $ 25.4       N/A     $ 25.4     $ 50.8  

ESOP Stock Price

   $ 20.46     $ 25.46     $ 30.46     $ 35.46     $ 40.46  

Change in Pension Expense

   $ 15.2     $ 7.3       N/A     $ 6.7     $ 12.9  

CONSOLIDATED BALANCE SHEET REVIEW

The Company’s assets were $102.1 billion at December 31, 2005, up from $94.5 billion in the prior year. The increase in 2005 from 2004 primarily reflects increased loans to financial institutions and growth in the securities portfolio. Investment securities as a percent of the Company’s year-end assets were 27% in 2005 and 25% in 2004. Loans as a percent of assets was 39% and 37% of assets in 2005 and 2004, respectively. Total shareholders’ equity was $9.9 billion at December 31, 2005 compared with $9.3 billion in 2004. The major reason for the increase in shareholders’ equity was the retention of earnings.

Investment Securities

Total investment securities were $27.3 billion in 2005 compared with $23.8 billion in 2004 and $22.8 billion in 2003. The increases in 2005 and 2004 were primarily due to growth in the Company’s portfolio of highly rated mortgage-backed securities. In 2005 and 2004, the Company added approximately $3.1 billion and $0.7 billion, respectively, of mortgage-backed securities to its investment portfolio. Average investment securities were $25.2 billion in 2005 compared with $23.0 billion in 2004 and $19.9 billion in 2003. At December 31, 2005, the fixed income portfolio composition was approximately 39% hybrid, 35% fixed rate, and 12% variable rate mortgage-backed securities while treasuries, government agencies, municipalities and short-term securities were 8% and other securities were 6%.

The Company’s portfolio of mortgage-backed securities is 89% rated AAA, 8% AA, and 3% A. Mortgage-backed securities increased to $22.5 billion in 2005 from $19.4 billion in 2004. The primary risk in these securities is interest rate sensitivity. The Company seeks to reduce interest rate risk by investing in securities that convert to floating within three to five years or by investing in traunches of mortgage-backed securities that have rapid repayment characteristics. See “Asset/Liability Management”. The Company has been adding either adjustable or short life classes of structured mortgage-backed securities, both of which have short durations. The Company has maintained an effective duration of approximately 1.9 years on its mortgage portfolio to best match its liabilities and to reduce the adverse impact from a rise in interest rates.

Corporate debt securities declined in 2005. The primary risks in corporate debt securities are credit risk and interest rate risk. Almost all of the corporate securities are investment grade. Included in these securities are $0.9 billion of investment grade securities that are guaranteed by highly rated financial institutions.

 

31


Table of Contents

The short-term money market instruments and obligations of state and political subdivisions have a modest amount of credit risk. The U.S. Treasury and Agency securities and obligations of state and political subdivision are generally fixed rate securities so they expose the Company to interest rate risk.

The table below shows the distribution of the Company’s securities portfolio:

Investment Securities (at Fair Value)

 

(In millions)

   December 31,
2005
   December 31,
2004

Fixed Income:

     

Mortgage-Backed Securities

   $ 22,483    $ 19,393

Asset-Backed Securities

     305      —  

Corporate Debt

     1,034      1,259

Short-Term Money Market Instruments

     975      982

U.S. Treasury Securities

     226      403

U.S. Government Agencies

     620      505

State and Political Subdivisions

     224      197

Emerging Market Debt (Collateralized by US Treasury
Zero Coupon Obligations)

     117      107

Other Foreign Debt

     363      545
             

Subtotal Fixed Income

     26,347      23,391

Equity Securities:

     

Money Market Funds

     922      388

Other

     31      10
             

Subtotal Equity Securities

     953      398
             

Total Securities

   $ 27,300    $ 23,789
             

The net unrealized loss on securities available-for-sale was $108 million at December 31, 2005, compared with a gain of $75 million at December 31, 2004. The decline in unrealized gains reflects the rise in interest rates in 2005.

 

32


Table of Contents

The following table shows the maturity distribution by carrying amount and yield (not on a tax equivalent basis) of the Company’s securities portfolio at December 31, 2005.

 

(Dollars in millions)

 

U.S.

Government

   

U.S

Government
Agency

    States and
Political
Subdivisions
    Other Bonds,
Notes and
Debentures
   

Mortgage/

Asset-Backed

and Equity
Securities

    Total
  Amount   Yield*     Amount   Yield*     Amount   Yield*     Amount   Yield*     Amount   Yield*    

Securities Held-to-Maturity

                     

One Year or Less

  $ —     —   %   $ —     —   %   $ 105   4.77 %   $ 7   4.47 %   $ —     —   %   $ 112

Over 1 through 5 Years

    15   3.47       245   3.42       —     —         —     —         —     —         260

Over 5 through
10 Years

    33   4.70       —     —         —     —         —     —         —     —         33

Over 10 years

    —     —         —     —         —     —         121   6.25       —     —         121

Mortgage-Backed Securities

    —     —         —     —         —     —         —     —         1,451   4.78       1,451
                                             
  $ 48   4.32 %   $ 245   3.42 %   $ 105   4.77 %   $ 128   6.15 %   $ 1,451   4.78 %   $ 1,977
                                             

Securities Available-for-Sale

                     

One Year or Less

  $ 178   3.31 %   $ 221   3.35 %   $ 8   5.58 %   $ 1,799   4.03 %   $ —     —   %   $ 2,206

Over 1 through 5 Years

    —     —         163   4.03       36   6.07       4   5.90       —     —         203

Over 5 through
10 Years

    —     —         —     —         43   5.86       4   6.46       —     —         47

Over 10 years

    —     —         —     —         28   6.40       547   3.10       —     —         575

Mortgage-Backed Securities

    —     —         —     —         —     —         —     —         21,162   4.67       21,162

Asset-Backed Securities

    —     —         —     —         —     —         —     —         307   5.19       307

Equity Securities

    —     —         —     —         —     —         —     —         957   4.03       957
                                             
  $ 178   3.31 %   $ 384   3.64 %   $ 115   6.04 %   $ 2,354   3.96 %   $ 22,426   4.65 %   $ 25,457
                                             

* Yields are based upon the amortized cost of securities.

The Company also has equity investments categorized as other assets (bracketed amounts indicate carrying values). Included in other assets are strategic investments related to securities servicing ($73 million), venture capital investments ($341 million), an investment in Wing Hang Bank Ltd. ($215 million), tax advantaged low-income housing ($176 million), Federal Reserve Bank stock ($106 million), and other equity investments ($4 million).

The largest minority interest is Wing Hang with a fair value of $427 million (book value of $215 million) at December 31, 2005. An agreement with certain other shareholders of Wing Hang prohibits the sale of this interest without their permission. The Company received dividends from Wing Hang of $16 million, $12 million, and $17 million in 2005, 2004, and 2003, respectively. In 2004, the Company reduced its investment in Wing Hang from approximately 25% of Wing Hang’s outstanding shares to 20%.

Venture capital activities consist of investments in private equity funds, mezzanine financings, and direct equity investments. The carrying and fair value of the Company’s venture capital investments was $341 million at December 31, 2005, consisting of investments in private equity funds of $246 million, direct equity of $29 million, mezzanine financings of $39 million and leveraged bond funds of $27 million. Fair values for private equity funds are generally based upon information provided by fund sponsors and the Company’s knowledge of the underlying portfolio while mezzanine financing and direct equity investments are based upon Company models.

In 2005, the Company had an average invested balance of $347 million in venture capital. Securities gains and interest income were $54 million, a pre-tax return of 16%. For 2006, the Company enters the year with a $341 million investment balance, and would expect returns to be somewhat lower.

 

33


Table of Contents

At December 31, 2005, the Company had $35 million of principal investment commitments to private equity funds and partnerships compared with $60 million at December 31, 2004. The timing of future cash requirements to fund such commitments is generally dependent on the investment cycle. This cycle, the period over which privately-held companies are funded by private equity investors and ultimately sold, merged, or taken public through an initial offering, can vary based on overall market conditions as well as the nature and type of industry in which the companies operate. If unused, the commitments expire as follows:

 

(In millions)

   Commitments

2006

   $ 25

2007

     3

2008 - 2010

     7
      

Total

   $ 35
      

Commitments to venture capital limited partnerships may extend beyond expiration period shown to cover certain follow-on investments, claims and liabilities, and organizational and partnership expenses.

Consistent with the Company’s policy to focus on its core activities, it continues to reduce its exposure to venture capital activities. At December 31, 2005, the Company had hedged approximately $39 million of its private equity fund investments. Hedge gains and losses are recorded at fair value in securities gains. Consistent with its objective to expand its asset management activities, the Company expects to start the $200 million BNY Mezzanine Fund LLP in 2006 and plans to commit up to $75 million to the fund, and it may make other commitments consistent with that strategy from time to time.

Loans

 

(In billions)

   December 31,    Annual Average
   Total    Non-Margin    Margin    Total    Non-Margin    Margin

2005

   $ 40.7    $ 34.6    $ 6.1    $ 39.7    $ 33.3    $ 6.4

2004

     35.8      29.7      6.1      37.8      31.5      6.3

2003

     35.3      29.6      5.7      35.6      31.8      3.8

Total loans were $40.7 billion at December 31, 2005, compared with $35.8 billion in 2004. The increase in 2005 versus 2004 primarily reflects an increase in overdrafts, securities industry loans, and residential mortgages. The Company continues to focus on its strategy of reducing non-strategic and outsized corporate loan exposures to improve its credit risk profile. Average total loans were $39.7 billion in 2005, compared with $37.8 billion in 2004. The increase in average loans in 2005 primarily results from increased lending to financial institutions.

 

34


Table of Contents

The table below shows trends in the loans outstanding at year-end over the last five years based on a product analysis.

 

(In millions)

   2005     2004     2003     2002     2001  

Domestic

          

Commercial and Industrial Loans

   $ 6,271     $ 6,168     $ 6,611     $ 10,612     $ 11,633  

Real Estate Loans:

          

Construction and Land Development

     324       284       304       480       434  

Other, Principally Commercial Mortgages

     1,694       2,040       2,335       2,420       2,501  

Collateralized by Residential Properties

     5,890       4,593       3,739       3,416       3,050  

Banks and Other Financial Institutions

     2,156       1,323       1,320       1,292       2,075  

Loans for Purchasing or Carrying Securities

     4,935       3,028       4,221       1,720       3,581  

Lease Financings

     3,262       3,595       3,727       3,529       3,576  

Less:

          

Unearned Income on Lease Financings

     (938 )     (1,072 )     (1,063 )     (944 )     (1,026 )

Consumer Loans

     1,372       1,293       1,429       1,669       1,782  

Margin loans

     6,089       6,059       5,712       352       452  

Other

     946       548       431       238       427  
                                        

Total Domestic

     32,001       27,859       28,766       24,784       28,485  
                                        

Foreign

          

Commercial and Industrial Loans

     1,456       793       1,305       1,780       2,390  

Banks and Other Financial Institutions

     3,924       3,939       2,045       1,624       2,060  

Lease Financings

     5,816       5,871       6,026       6,062       5,271  

Less:

          

Unearned Income on Lease Financings

     (2,615 )     (2,731 )     (2,960 )     (3,124 )     (2,810 )

Government and Official Institutions

     101       42       93       205       224  

Other

     43       8       8       9       127  
                                        

Total Foreign

     8,725       7,922       6,517       6,556       7,262  
                                        

Less: Allowance for Loan Losses

     (411 )     (591 )     (668 )     (656 )     (415 )
                                        

Net Loans

   $ 40,315     $ 35,190     $ 34,615     $ 30,684     $ 35,332  
                                        

Asset Quality and Allowance for Credit Losses

Over the past several years, the Company has improved its risk profile through greater focus on clients who are active users of the Company’s non-credit services, with a de-emphasis on broad-based loan growth. The Company’s primary exposure to credit risk of a customer consists of funded loans, unfunded formal contractual commitments to lend, counterparty risk associated with derivative transactions and overdrafts associated with clearing and settlement.

The role of credit has shifted to one that complements the Company’s other services instead of as a lead product. Credit solidifies customer relationships and, through a disciplined allocation of capital, can earn acceptable rates of return as part of an overall relationship. The Company’s credit risk management objectives are: (1) to eliminate non-strategic exposures; (2) to increase granularity in the portfolio by cutting back large individual borrower exposures; (3) to restructure the portfolio to avoid outsized industry concentrations; and (4) to limit exposures to non-investment grade counterparties. The goal of these objectives is to reduce volatility in the Company’s credit provisioning and earnings. The Company regularly culls its loan portfolio of credit exposures that no longer meet risk/return criteria, including an assessment of overall relationship profitability. In addition, the Company makes use of credit derivatives and other risk mitigants to hedge portions of the credit risk in its portfolio. The effect of these transactions is to transfer credit risk to creditworthy, independent third parties.

 

35


Table of Contents

The Company continues to make progress towards improving its credit risk profile.

 

    At December 31, 2005, corporate exposure was $23.3 billion.

 

    The Company brought industry concentrations in line with reduced targets in areas such as telecom, retailing, and automotive. The largest single corporate industry exposure is now media at 13%.

 

    The Company continued to eliminate non-strategic exposures that do not meet yield or cross-sell criteria.

 

    At December 31, 2005, the Company has used credit default swaps to reduce exposure on $1,099 million of loans and commitments.

At December 31, 2005, total exposures were $89.0 billion up from $82.5 billion in 2004 reflecting greater lending to financial institutions and increased residential mortgage lending.

The Company’s largest absolute risk is lending to financial institutions and corporates, which make up 66% of the total and remained the same as 2004. The consumer and middle market portfolio increased by 13% reflecting increased residential mortgage lending. The business unit components of the loan portfolio are detailed below.

Loan Portfolio

 

      12/31/05    12/31/04    12/31/03    12/31/02

(In billions)

   Loans    Exposure    Loans    Exposure    Loans    Exposure    Loans    Exposure

Financial Institutions

   $ 13.0    $ 35.5    $ 9.5    $ 31.1    $ 9.2    $ 31.0    $ 6.6    $ 30.7

Corporate

     3.7      23.3      3.6      23.0      4.0      24.5      8.2      31.6
                                                       
     16.7      58.8      13.1      54.1      13.2      55.5      14.8      62.3
                                                       

Consumer & Middle Market

     10.3      15.1      8.9      13.4      8.2      12.3      8.0      12.1

Lease Financings

     5.5      5.5      5.6      5.6      5.8      5.8      5.6      5.7

Commercial Real Estate

     2.1      3.5      2.1      3.3      2.4      3.2      2.5      3.3

Margin Loans

     6.1      6.1      6.1      6.1      5.7      5.7      0.4      0.4
                                                       

Total

   $ 40.7    $ 89.0    $ 35.8    $ 82.5    $ 35.3    $ 82.5    $ 31.3    $ 83.8
                                                       

Of the credits in the financial institutions and corporate segments with a rating equivalent to non-investment grade at December 31, 2005, 47% of these credits mature in less than one year.

 

36


Table of Contents

Financial Institutions

The financial institutions portfolio exposure was up from $30.7 billion in 2002 to $35.5 billion at year-end 2005. The financial institutions exposure fluctuates day to day based on the financing needs of the Company’s broker-dealer customers and overdrafts relating to security settlements. These exposures are generally high quality, with 85% meeting the investment grade criteria of the Company’s rating system. The exposures are short-term with 74% expiring within one year, and are frequently secured. For example, mortgage banking, securities industry, and investment managers often borrow against marketable securities held in custody at the Company. The diversity of the portfolio is shown in the accompanying table.

 

     12/31/05   % Inv
Grade
    % due
<1 Yr
    12/31/04   12/31/03

(In billions)

Lending Division

  Loans   Unfunded
Commitments
  Total
Exposures
      Loans   Unfunded
Commitments
  Total
Exposures
  Loans   Unfunded
Commitments

Banks

  $ 5.1   $ 3.8   $ 8.9   65 %   87 %   $ 4.2   $ 3.5   $ 7.7   $ 2.6   $ 3.1

Securities Industry

    3.4     3.7     7.1   88     96       1.5     3.0     4.5     1.9     3.5

Insurance

    0.4     4.9     5.3   96     44       0.5     4.8     5.3     0.3     5.0

Government

    0.1     4.7     4.8   98     52       —       5.0     5.0     0.2     5.6

Asset Managers

    3.8     3.6     7.4   89     80       3.0     3.8     6.8     3.6     3.5

Mortgage Banks

    0.1     0.7     0.8   70     51       0.2     0.7     0.9     0.4     0.5

Endowments

    0.1     1.1     1.2   99     55       0.1     0.8     0.9     0.2     0.6
                                                           

Total

  $ 13.0   $ 22.5   $ 35.5   85 %   74 %   $ 9.5   $ 21.6   $ 31.1   $ 9.2   $ 21.8
                                                           

Corporate

The corporate portfolio exposure was reduced to $23.3 billion at December 31, 2005, from $31.6 billion at year-end 2002. Approximately 74% of the portfolio is investment grade based on the Company’s rating system and 16% of the portfolio matures within one year. In 2004, the Company reached its goal of reducing corporate exposure below $24.0 billion. This represents a decline of over $9 billion since the Company announced its goal to reduce corporate exposure in 2002.

 

     12/31/05   % Inv
Grade
    % due
<1 Yr
    12/31/04   12/31/03

(In billions)

Lending Division

  Loans   Unfunded
Commitments
  Total
Exposures
      Loans   Unfunded
Commitments
  Total
Exposures
  Loans   Unfunded
Commitments

Media

  $ 1.1   $ 2.0   $ 3.1   62 %   10 %   $ 0.9   $ 2.2   $ 3.1   $ 0.9   $ 2.3

Cable

    0.4     0.5     0.9   41     18       0.6     0.4     1.0     0.7     0.7

Telecom

    0.1     0.4     0.5   79     7       0.1     0.5     0.6     0.3     0.6
                                                   

Subtotal

    1.6     2.9     4.5   60     11       1.6     3.1     4.7     1.9     3.6

Energy

    0.4     4.9     5.3   84     10       0.4     4.4     4.8     0.4     4.2

Retailing

    0.1     2.1     2.2   75     23       0.1     2.1     2.2     0.1     2.3

Automotive*

    0.1     1.2     1.3   55     38       0.1     1.7     1.8     0.1     2.1

Healthcare

    0.3     1.7     2.0   82     11       0.3     1.5     1.8     0.2     1.3

Other**

    1.2     6.8     8.0   77     18       1.1     6.6     7.7     1.3     7.0
                                                           

Total

  $ 3.7   $ 19.6   $ 23.3   74 %   16 %   $ 3.6   $ 19.4   $ 23.0   $ 4.0   $ 20.5
                                                           

* In 2005, the Company reduced its automotive exposure, eliminated the Automotive division, and transferred the remaining customers to the other geographic lending divisions. The amounts in the table were reconstructed for comparison to prior years.
** Diversified portfolio of industries and geographies

Other Corporate Risks

Included in the Company’s corporate exposures are automotive and airline exposures. The Company continues to selectively reduce automotive exposures given ongoing weakness in the domestic automotive industry. Total exposure previously reported in the Automotive Division was $1.3 billion at December 31, 2005,

 

37


Table of Contents

down $516 million from December 31, 2004. This broadly defined industry portfolio consists of $194 million to Big Three automotive manufacturing, $199 million to finance subsidiaries, $453 million to highly rated asset- backed securitizations, $311 million to suppliers, and $144 million of other.

The Company’s exposure to the airline industry consists of a $337 million leasing portfolio, including a $16 million real estate lease exposure. The airline leasing portfolio consists of $141 million to major U.S. carriers, $133 million to foreign airlines, and $63 million to U.S. regionals. In 2005, the industry continued to face the dilemma of an increasingly uncompetitive cost structure, weak demand with further downward pressure. In addition, considerable excess capacity and higher oil prices continue to negatively impact the valuations of the industry’s aircraft in the secondary market. Because of these factors, the Company continues to maintain a sizable allowance for loan losses against these exposures and to closely monitor the portfolio. In 2005, the Company charged-off $140 million of a $153 million exposure to two bankrupt domestic airlines.

Consumer and Middle Market

The Company’s consumer loan exposure is concentrated in the New York Tri-State region and consists primarily of loans secured by real estate and small business loans, as well as unsecured closed-end and open-end loans to individual consumers. These loans are originated through the Company’s Private Client Services and Retail Banking businesses. The Company’s middle market loan portfolio is very granular, with an average loan size of less than $2.5 million. It consists of loans to midsize companies, and focuses on users of cash management, trade finance, capital markets, and private client services.

Lease Financings

The Company utilizes the leasing portfolio as part of its tax cash flow management strategy. This portfolio generates attractive after-tax risk-adjusted returns. Counterparties in the leasing transactions are generally highly rated. The leasing portfolio consists of non-airline exposures of $5.2 billion and $337 million of airline exposures.

The non-airline portion of the leasing portfolio is backed by well-diversified assets, primarily large-ticket transportation equipment. The largest component is rail, consisting of both passenger and freight trains. Assets are both domestic and foreign-based, with primary concentrations in the United States and European countries. Excluding airline leasing, counterparty rating equivalents are as follows: 43% AA or better, 34% single A, 17% BBB, and 6% non-investment grade.

Commercial Real Estate

The Company’s commercial real estate loan portfolio totaled $3.6 billion of exposure at December 31, 2005. Over 72% of the portfolio is secured by mortgages on properties predominantly located in the Tri-State region. The portfolio is diverse by project type with approximately 19% secured by office buildings, 33% secured by residential buildings, approximately 8% secured by retail buildings, while approximately 20% are unsecured loans to real estate investment trusts (REIT’s) and approximately 20% fall into other categories.

The Company avoids speculative development loans and concentrates its activities largely within its retail branch network footprint. Real estate credit facilities are focused on experienced owners and are structured with moderate leverage based on existing cash flows.

International Loans

The Company is active in the international markets, particularly in areas associated with securities servicing and trade finance. Excluding leasing, these activities result in outstanding loans to foreign institutions of $5.5 billion and $4.8 billion at December 31, 2005 and 2004, respectively.

At December 31, 2005, the Company’s emerging markets exposures consisted of $96 million in medium-term loans, $1,267 million in short-term loans, primarily trade related, and a $215 million investment in Wing

 

38


Table of Contents

Hang. In addition, the Company has $117 million of Philippine bonds whose principal payments are collateralized by U.S. Treasury zero coupon obligations and whose interest payments are partially collateralized. Emerging market countries where the Company has exposure include Argentina, Brazil, Bulgaria, China, Colombia, Costa Rica, Dominican Republic, Ecuador, Egypt, Honduras, Indonesia, Jamaica, Malaysia, Mexico, Morocco, Panama, Peru, Philippines, Russia, Thailand, Uruguay, Venezuela, and Vietnam.

Further details of the Company’s outstandings are detailed under “Loans”.

Counterparty Risk Ratings Profile

The table below summarizes the risk ratings of the Company’s foreign exchange and interest rate derivative counterparty credit exposure for the past year.

 

     For the Quarter Ended  

Rating(1)

   12/31/05     9/30/05     6/30/05     3/31/05     12/31/04  

AAA to AA-

   74 %   71 %   68 %   74 %   68 %

A+ to A-

   13     13     15     13     19  

BBB+ to BBB-

   9     13     14     10     10  

Noninvestment Grade

   4     3     3     3     3  
                              

Total

   100 %   100 %   100 %   100 %   100 %
                              

(1) Represents credit rating agency equivalent of internal credit ratings.

For derivative counterparty credit exposure see “Commitments and Contingent Liabilities” in the Notes to the Company’s Consolidated Financial Statements.

Nonperforming Assets

Nonperforming assets decreased by $135 million to $79 million at December 31, 2005. The decrease in nonperforming assets during 2005 is primarily attributable to sales of the Company’s exposure to a cable operator that was categorized as nonperforming as well as paydowns and charge-offs of commercial loans. See “Loans” in the Notes to the Consolidated Financial Statements.

Activity in Nonperforming Assets

 

     Year ended December 31,  

(In millions)

       2005             2004      

Balance at beginning of year

   $ 214     $ 349  

Additions

     45       118  

Charge-offs

     (25 )     (58 )

Paydowns/Sales

     (155 )     (179 )

Other

     —         (16 )
                

Balance at end of year

   $ 79     $ 214  
                

 

39


Table of Contents

The following table shows the distribution of nonperforming assets at the end of each of the last five years:

 

(Dollars in millions)

   2005     2004     2003     2002     2001  

Category of Loans:

          

Domestic:

          

Other Commercial

   $ 17     $ 132     $ 219     $ 321     $ 138  

Regional Commercial

     35       53       51       34       18  

Foreign

     14       28       79       84       64  
                                        

Total Nonperforming Loans

     66       213       349       439       220  

Other Assets Owned

     13       1       —         1       2  
                                        

Total Nonperforming Assets

   $ 79     $ 214     $ 349     $ 440     $ 222  
                                        

Nonperforming Asset Ratio

     0.2 %     0.7 %     1.2 %     1.4 %     0.6 %

Allowance for Loan Losses/Nonperforming Loans

     629.7       277.5       191.2       149.2       188.7  

Allowance for Loan Losses/Nonperforming Assets

     524.0       276.5       191.2       148.9       187.0  

Allowance for Credit Losses/Nonperforming Loans

     865.4       345.6       230.2       189.1       280.0  

Allowance for Credit Losses/Nonperforming Assets

     720.2       344.3       230.2       188.7       277.6  

Significant nonperforming assets at December 31, 2005 include $13 million related to aircraft leasing, $9 million of emerging markets exposure, and $8 million to a grocery retailer.

The following table shows loans past due 90 days or more and still accruing interest for the last five years:

 

(In millions)

   2005    2004    2003    2002    2001

Domestic:

              

Consumer

   $ 7    $ 11    $ 14    $ 3    $ 3

Commercial

     7      4      6      18      11
                                  
     14      15      20      21      14

Foreign:

              

Banks

     —        —        —        5      —  
                                  
   $ 14    $ 15    $ 20    $ 26    $ 14
                                  

 

40


Table of Contents

Activity in Allowance for Credit Losses

The following table details changes in the Company’s allowance for credit losses for the last five years.

 

(Dollars in millions)

   2005     2004     2003     2002     2001  

Loans Outstanding, December 31,

   $ 40,726     $ 35,781     $ 35,283     $ 31,340     $ 35,747  

Average Loans Outstanding

     39,682       37,778       35,623       34,305       38,770  

Allowance for Credit Losses

          

Balance, January 1

          

Domestic

   $ 590     $ 621     $ 653     $ 508     $ 491  

Foreign

     27       70       79       43       67  

Unallocated

     119       113       99       65       58  
                                        

Total, January 1

     736       804       831       616       616  
                                        

Charge-Offs:

          

Commercial

     (144 )     (24 )     (118 )     (396 )     (345 )

Foreign

     (10 )     (28 )     (26 )     (23 )     (18 )

Regional Commercial

     (11 )     (11 )     (22 )     (42 )     (7 )

Consumer

     (30 )     (30 )     (32 )     (23 )     (18 )
                                        

Total

     (195 )     (93 )     (198 )     (484 )     (388 )

Recoveries:

          

Commercial

     1       2       9       7       4  

Foreign

     2       3       1       2       5  

Regional Commercial

     2       2       3       2       1  

Consumer

     4       3       3       3       3  
                                        

Total

     9       10       16       14       13  
                                        

Net Charge-Offs

     (186 )     (83 )     (182 )     (470 )     (375 )
                                        

Provision

     15       15       155       685       375  

Balance, December 31,

          

Domestic

     458       590       621       653       508  

Foreign

     11       27       70       79       43  

Unallocated

     96       119       113       99       65  
                                        

Total, December 31,

   $ 565     $ 736     $ 804     $ 831     $ 616  
                                        

Allowance for Loan Losses

   $ 411     $ 591     $ 668     $ 656     $ 415  

Allowance for Lending-Related Commitments

     154       145       136       175       201  

Ratios

          

Net Charge-Offs to Average Loans Outstanding

     0.47 %     0.22 %     0.51 %     1.37 %     0.97 %

Net Charge-Offs to Total Allowance for Credit Losses

     32.92       11.28       22.64       56.56       60.88  

Total Allowance for Credit Losses to
Year-End Loans Outstanding

     1.39       2.06       2.28       2.65       1.72  

Allowance for Loan Losses to
Year-End Loans Outstanding

     1.01       1.65       1.89       2.09       1.16  

Net charge-offs were $186 million in 2005, $83 million in 2004, and $182 million in 2003. In 2005, net charge-offs increased from 2004 primarily due to the charge-off of $140 million of leases with two bankrupt domestic airline customers in the fourth quarter of 2005. Net charge-offs decreased in 2004 and 2003 primarily due to improvement in asset quality.

 

41


Table of Contents

The provision for credit losses was $15 million in 2005, compared with $15 million in 2004 and $155 million in 2003. The decrease in the provision in 2004 primarily reflects the Company’s improved risk profile as well as improvements in the credit environment. In 2005 and 2004, asset quality improved as nonperforming loans declined and loan granularity improved.

Allowance for Credit Losses

 

     At December 31,  

(Dollars in millions)

   2005     2004  

Margin Loans

   $ 6,089     $ 6,059  

Non-Margin Loans

     34,637       29,722  
                

Total Loans

   $ 40,726     $ 35,781  
                

Allowance for Loan Losses

   $ 411     $ 591  

Allowance for Lending-Related Commitments

     154       145  
                

Total Allowance for Credit Losses

   $ 565     $ 736  
                

Allowance for Loan Losses
As a Percent of Total Loans

     1.01 %     1.65 %

Allowance for Loan Losses
As a Percent of Non-Margin Loans

     1.19       1.99  

Total Allowance for Credit Losses
As a Percent of Total Loans

     1.39       2.06  

Total Allowance for Credit Losses
As a Percent of Non-Margin Loans

     1.63       2.48  

The total allowance for credit losses was $565 million and $736 million at year-end 2005 and 2004, respectively. The ratio of the total allowance for credit losses to year-end non-margin loans was 1.63% and 2.48% at December 31, 2005 and 2004, reflecting improved credit quality in 2005. The decline in the allowance and in the ratios also reflects the charge-off of $153 million of airline credits which had $140 million of allowance for credit losses associated with them.

The Company has $6.1 billion of secured margin loans on its balance sheet at December 31, 2005. The Company has rarely suffered a loss on these types of loans and does not allocate any of its allowance for credit losses to these loans. The Company believes that the ratio of allowance for credit losses to non-margin loans is a more appropriate metric to measure the adequacy of the reserve.

Loans at December 31, 2005, were $40.7 billion compared with $35.8 billion at the prior year-end. Non-margin loans increased to $34.6 billion in 2005 from $29.7 billion in 2004, reflecting increased lending to financial institutions and higher holdings of residual mortgage loans. The decrease in the total allowance for credit losses in 2005 reflects a charge-off of $140 million related to airline exposure and continued improvement in credit quality.

The Company’s total allowance at year-end equated to approximately 3.5 times the average charge-offs and 3.8 times the average net charge-offs for the last three years. Because historical charge-offs are not necessarily indicative of future charge-off levels, the Company also gives consideration to other risk indicators when determining the appropriate allowance level.

The allowance for loan losses and the allowance for lending-related commitments consist of four elements: (1) an allowance for impaired credits (nonaccrual commercial credits over $1 million); (2) an allowance for higher risk rated credits; (3) an allowance for pass rated credits; and (4) an unallocated allowance based on general economic conditions and risk factors in the Company’s individual markets.

 

42


Table of Contents

The first element, impaired credits, is based on individual analysis of all nonperforming commercial credits over $1 million. The allowance is measured by the difference between the recorded value of impaired loans and their fair value. Fair value is either the present value of the expected future cash flows from the borrower, the market value of the loan, or the fair value of the collateral.

The second element, higher risk rated credits, is based on the assignment of loss factors for each specific risk category of higher risk credits. The Company rates each credit in its portfolio that exceeds $1 million and assigns the credits to specific risk pools. A potential loss factor is assigned to each pool, and an amount is included in the allowance equal to the product of the amount of the loan in the pool and the risk factor. Reviews of higher risk rated loans are conducted quarterly and the loan’s rating is updated as necessary. The Company prepares a loss migration analysis and compares its actual loss experience to the loss factors on an annual basis to attempt to ensure the accuracy of the loss factors assigned to each pool. Pools of past due consumer loans are included in specific risk categories based on their length of time past due.

The third element, pass rated credits, is based on the Company’s expected loss model. Borrowers are assigned to pools based on their credit ratings. The expected loss for each loan in a pool incorporates the borrower’s credit rating, loss given default rating and maturity. The credit rating is dependent upon the borrower’s probability of default. The loss given default incorporates a recovery expectation. Borrower and loss given default ratings are reviewed semi-annually at a minimum and are periodically mapped to third party, including rating agency and default and recovery data bases to ensure ongoing consistency and validity. Commercial loans over $1 million are individually analyzed before being assigned a credit rating. In 2004, the Company began to apply this technique to its leasing and consumer portfolios. In addition, the Company adjusted the estimates for default probabilities to a long-term average and adjusted from estimated to actual maturities. At the time of these changes, the impact was to increase the reserve requirement by $56 million. All current consumer loans are included in the pass rated consumer pools.

The fourth element, the unallocated allowance, is based on management’s judgment regarding the following factors:

 

    Economic conditions including duration of the current cycle;

 

    Past experience including recent loss experience;

 

    Credit quality trends;

 

    Collateral values;

 

    Volume, composition, and growth of the loan portfolio;

 

    Specific credits and industry conditions;

 

    Results of bank regulatory and internal credit exams;

 

    Actions by the Federal Reserve Board;

 

    Delay in receipt of information to evaluate loans or confirm existing credit deterioration; and

 

    Geopolitical issues and their impact on the economy.

In 2005, the allowance for pass rated credits increased due to a slight increase in exposure and some downward credit migration, primarily in the automotive industry. This was more than offset by a decline in the allowance for impaired credits as several impaired credits were repaid or sold. The major portion of the overall decline in the allowance was due to a decline in reserve for higher risk credits as a result of the charge-offs taken on two bankrupt domestic airlines. The amount of allocated allowance decreased reflecting the continued relatively benign credit environment.

 

43


Table of Contents

Based on an evaluation of these four elements, including individual credits, historical credit losses, and global economic factors, the Company has allocated its allowance for credit losses as follows:

 

         2005             2004             2003             2002             2001      

Domestic:

          

Real Estate

   2 %   2 %   2 %   3 %   6 %

Commercial

   69     71     73     74     73  

Consumer

   10     7     2     2     3  

Foreign

   2     4     9     9     7  

Unallocated

   17     16     14     12     11  
                              
   100 %   100 %   100 %   100 %   100 %
                              

Such an allocation is inherently judgmental, and the entire allowance for credit losses is available to absorb credit losses regardless of the nature of the loss.

The following table shows the maturity structure of the Company’s commercial loan portfolio at December 31, 2005.

 

(In millions)

   Within
1 Year
   Between
1 and 5 Years
   After
5 Years
   Total

Domestic:

           

Real Estate, Excluding Loans Collateralized by 1-4 Family Residential Properties

   $ 263    $ 1,244    $ 511    $ 2,018

Commercial and Industrial Loans

     2,212      3,619      440      6,271

Loans for Purchasing or Carrying Securities

     4,800      135      —        4,935

Margin Loans

     6,089      —        —        6,089

Other, Excluding Loans to Individuals and Those Collateralized by 1-4 Family Residential Properties

     2,443      613      46      3,102
                           
     15,807      5,611      997      22,415

Foreign

     4,843      554      91      5,488
                           

Total

   $ 20,650    $ 6,165    $ 1,088    $ 27,903
                           

Loans with:

           

Predetermined Interest Rates

   $ 5,291    $ 622    $ 266    $ 6,179

Floating Interest Rates

     15,359      5,543      822      21,724
                           

Total

   $ 20,650    $ 6,165    $ 1,088    $ 27,903
                           

Deposits

Total deposits were $64.4 billion in 2005, compared with $58.7 billion in 2004 and $56.4 billion in 2003. The increase was primarily due to higher market activity levels, which resulted in a higher level of customer deposits at year-end. The rise also reflects customers’ greater use of compensating balances in a rising rate environment. Noninterest-bearing deposits were $18.2 billion in 2005, compared with $17.4 billion in 2004 and $14.8 billion in 2003. Interest-bearing deposits were $46.2 billion in 2005, compared with $41.3 billion in 2004 and $41.6 billion in 2003.

The aggregate amount of deposits by foreign customers in domestic offices was $5.6 billion, $5.2 billion, and $4.1 billion at December 31, 2005, 2004, and 2003, respectively.

 

44


Table of Contents

The following table shows the maturity breakdown of domestic time deposits of $100,000 or more at December 31, 2005.

 

(In millions)

   Certificates
of Deposits
   Other Time
Deposits
   Total

3 Months or Less

   $ 769    $ 11,337    $ 12,106

Between 3 and 6 Months

     429      —        429

Between 6 and 12 Months

     996      —        996

Over 12 Months

     1,906      —        1,906
                    

Total

   $ 4,100    $ 11,337    $ 15,437
                    

Other Borrowed Funds

Federal funds purchased and securities sold under repurchase agreements were $834 million in 2005, compared with $1,205 million in 2004 and $1,039 million in 2003. Other borrowed funds were $860 million in 2005, compared with $533 million in 2004 and $834 million in 2003.

Information related to other borrowed funds in 2005, 2004, and 2003 is presented in the table below.

 

     2005     2004     2003  

(Dollars in millions)

   Amount    Average
Rate
    Amount    Average
Rate
    Amount    Average
Rate
 

Federal Funds Purchased and Securities Sold Under Repurchase Agreements

               

At December 31

   $ 834    3.04 %   $ 1,205    0.91 %   $ 1,039    0.69 %

Average During Year

     1,284    2.73       1,551    0.99       1,542    0.85  

Maximum Month-End Balance During Year

     3,349    4.19       4,173    0.92       2,436    0.75  

Other

               

At December 31

   $ 860    3.07 %   $ 533    2.13 %   $ 834    1.15 %

Average During Year

     1,865    3.10       2,675    1.93       1,654    1.26  

Maximum Month-End Balance During Year

     1,414    2.52       2,052    2.98       1,415    0.95  

Other consists primarily of commercial paper, extended federal funds purchased, and amounts owed to the U.S. Treasury.

LIQUIDITY

The Company maintains its liquidity through the management of its assets and liabilities, utilizing worldwide financial markets. The diversification of liabilities reflects the Company’s efforts to maintain flexibility of funding sources under changing market conditions. Stable core deposits, including demand, retail time, and trust deposits from processing businesses, are generated through the Company’s diversified network and managed with the use of trend studies and deposit pricing. The use of derivative products such as interest rate swaps and financial futures enhances liquidity by enabling the Company to issue long-term liabilities with limited exposure to interest rate risk. Liquidity also results from the maintenance of a portfolio of assets which can be easily sold and the monitoring of unfunded loan commitments, thereby reducing unanticipated funding requirements. Liquidity is managed on both a consolidated basis and also at The Bank of New York Company, Inc. parent company (“Parent”).

On a consolidated basis, non-core sources of funds such as money market rate accounts, certificates of deposit greater than $100,000, federal funds purchased and other borrowings were $13.1 billion and $14.6 billion on an average basis in 2005 and 2004, respectively. Average foreign deposits, primarily from the Company’s European based securities servicing business, were $26.6 billion compared with $25.8 billion in 2004. Domestic

 

45


Table of Contents

savings and other time deposits were $10.1 billion on an average basis compared to $10.2 billion in 2004. Average payables to customers and broker-dealers declined to $6.0 billion from $6.4 billion. Long-term debt averaged $7.3 billion in 2005 and $6.2 billion in 2004.

The Company has entered into several modest securitization transactions. See “Securitizations” in the Notes to the Consolidated Financial Statements. These transactions have not had a significant impact on the Company’s liquidity or capital.

The Parent’s cash position was $791 million and $1,195 million at December 31, 2005 and 2004, respectively. The majority of these funds were deposited with the Bank of New York (“The Bank”). The Company’s policy is to maintain sufficient cash for the Parent to be able to satisfy its obligations for one year without the need to access the capital markets or take a dividend from the Bank.

The Parent has four major sources of liquidity: dividends from its subsidiaries, the commercial paper market, a revolving credit agreement with third party financial institutions, and access to the capital markets.

In 2006, the Bank can pay dividends of approximately $278 million to the Parent without the need for regulatory waiver. This dividend capacity will increase in the remainder of 2006 to the extent of the Bank’s net income less dividends. Nonbank subsidiaries of the Parent have liquid assets of approximately $264 million. These assets could be liquidated and the proceeds delivered by dividend or loan to the Parent.

Restrictions on the ability of the Company to obtain funds from its subsidiaries are discussed in more detail in the “Company Financial Information” in the Notes to the Consolidated Financial Statements.

In 2005 and 2004, the Parent’s average commercial paper borrowings were $248 million and $155 million, respectively. Commercial paper outstandings were $85 million and $253 million at December 31, 2005 and 2004, respectively. At December 31, 2005, the Parent had cash of $791 million compared with cash of $1,195 million at December 31, 2004. Net of commercial paper outstanding, the Parent’s cash position at December 31, 2005 was down $236 million to $706 million compared with December 31, 2004.

The Company has a back-up line of credit of $275 million with 14 financial institutions. This line of credit matures in October 2006. The fee on this facility depends on the Company’s credit rating and is currently eight basis points. The credit agreement requires the Company to maintain: stockholders’ equity of $5 billion; a ratio of Tier 1 capital plus the allowance for credit losses to nonperforming assets of at least 2.5; a double leverage ratio less than 1.3; and all its banks adequately capitalized for regulatory purposes. There were no borrowings under the line of credit at December 31, 2005.

The Company also has the ability to access the capital markets. Access to the capital markets is partially dependent on the Company’s credit ratings, which as of January 31, 2006 were as follows:

 

     Parent
Commercial
Paper
   Parent
Subordinated
Long-Term Debt
   Parent Senior
Long-Term Debt
  

The Bank of

New York
Long-Term
Deposits

   Outlook

Standard & Poor’s

   A-1    A    A+    AA-    Stable

Moody’s

   P-1    A1    Aa3    Aa2    Stable

Fitch

   F1+    A+    AA-    AA    Stable

Dominion Bond Rating Service

   R-1(middle)    A(high)    AA(low)    AA    Stable

The Parent’s major uses of funds are payment of dividends, principal and interest on its borrowings, acquisitions, and additional investment in its subsidiaries.

The Parent has $225 million of long-term debt that becomes due in 2006. In addition, the Parent has the option to call $229 million of subordinated debt in 2006, which it will call and refinance if market conditions are favorable. The Parent expects to refinance any debt it repays by issuing a combination of senior and subordinated debt.

 

46


Table of Contents

The Company has $800 million of preferred trust securities that are callable in 2006. These securities qualify as Tier 1 Capital. The Company has not yet decided if it will call these securities. The decision to call will be based on interest rates, the availability of cash and capital, and regulatory conditions. If the Company calls the preferred trust securities, it expects to replace them with new preferred trust securities or senior or subordinated debt. See discussion of qualification of preferred trust securities as capital in “Accounting Changes and New Accounting Pronouncements” in the Notes to the Consolidated Financial Statements.

Double leverage is the ratio of investment in subsidiaries divided by the Company’s consolidated equity plus preferred trust securities. The Company’s double leverage ratio at December 31, 2005, 2004, and 2003 was 103.90%, 92.99%, and 100.24%, respectively. The Company’s target double leverage ratio is a maximum of 120%. The double leverage ratio is monitored by regulators and rating agencies and is an important constraint on the Company’s ability to invest in its subsidiaries to expand its businesses.

Pershing LLC, an indirect subsidiary of the Company, has committed and uncommitted lines of credit in place for liquidity purposes. The committed line of credit of $500 million with five financial institutions matures in March 2006. There were no borrowings against this line of credit in 2005. Pershing LLC has three separate uncommitted lines of credit amounting to $1 billion in aggregate. In 2005, average daily borrowing under these lines was $15 million in aggregate.

Pershing Limited, an indirect subsidiary of the Company, has committed and uncommitted lines in place for liquidity purposes. The committed line of credit of $275 million with four financial institutions matures in April 2006. In 2005, the average borrowing against this line of credit was $14 million. Pershing Limited has three separate uncommitted lines of credit amounting to $300 million in aggregate. In 2005, average daily borrowing under these lines was $200 million in aggregate.

The following comments relate to the information disclosed in the Consolidated Statements of Cash Flows.

Earnings and other operating activities used $1.1 billion in cash flows in 2005, compared with $3.4 billion and $3.8 billion provided in 2004 and 2003, respectively. The cash flows from operations in 2005, 2004 and 2003 were principally the result of earnings and changes in trading activities.

In 2005, cash used for investing activities was $7.6 billion as compared to $2.2 billion used for investing activities in 2004 and $6.5 billion used for investing activities in 2003. In 2005, 2004, and 2003, cash was used to increase the Company’s investment securities portfolio, which is part of an ongoing strategy to shift the Company’s asset mix from loans towards highly-rated investment securities and short-term liquid assets. Interest-bearing deposits were a use of funds in 2005, 2004, and 2003. Federal funds sold and securities purchased under resale agreements was a source of funds in 2005 and 2003 while it was a use of funds in 2004. Payments for the Pershing transaction were a significant use of cash in 2003.

In 2005, cash provided by financing activities was $8.1 billion as compared to $0.8 billion used for financing activities in 2004 and $1.8 billion provided by financing activities in 2003. In 2005, sources of funds included deposits, issuance of long-term debt and common stock. Payables to customers and broker-dealers were a significant use of funds in 2004. In 2003, the Company issued common stock and long-term debt to fund the Pershing acquisition as well as repay maturing long-term debt.

 

47


Table of Contents

COMMITMENTS AND OBLIGATIONS

The Company has contractual obligations to make fixed and determinable payments to third parties as indicated in the table below. The table excludes certain obligations such as trade payables and trading liabilities, where the obligation is short-term or subject to valuation based on market factors.

 

      Total    Payments Due by Period

(In millions)

Contractual Obligations

      Less
Than
1 Year
   1-3
Years
   4-5
Years
   Over
5 Years

Deposits Without a Stated Maturity

   $ 9,023    $ 9,023    $ —      $ —      $ —  

Term Deposits

     37,165      35,131      1,232      752      50

Federal Funds Borrowed and Securities Sold Under Repurchase Agreements

     834      834      —        —        —  

Payables to Customer and Broker Dealers

     8,623      8,623      —        —        —  

Other Borrowed Funds

     860      860      —        —        —  

Long-Term Debt(1)

     12,297      899      2,661      1,026      7,711

Operating Leases

     1,157      183      306      196      472

Unfunded Pension and Post Retirement Benefits

     234      37      47      47      103
                                  

Total Contractual Cash Obligations

   $ 70,193    $ 55,590    $ 4,246    $ 2,021    $ 8,336
                                  

(1) Including Interest

The Company has entered into fixed and determinable commitments as indicated in the table below:

 

      Total
Amounts
Committed
  

Amount of Commitment

Expiration Per Period

(In millions)

Other Commercial Commitments

     

Less

Than
1 Year

   1-3
Years
   4-5
Years
   Over
5 Years

Lending Commitments

   $ 36,954    $ 10,391    $ 2,906    $ 5,386    $ 18,271

Standby Letters Of Credit

     10,383      6,632      1,525      2,127      99

Commercial Letters Of Credit

     1,189      1,121      33      32      3

Securities Lending Indemnifications

     310,970      310,970      —        —        —  

Contingent Acquisitions Payments

     195      126      67      2      —  

Investment Commitments(1)

     312      89      91      9      123

Purchase Obligations

     209      44      114      24      27
                                  

Total Commitments

   $ 360,212    $ 329,373    $ 4,736    $ 7,580    $ 18,523
                                  

(1) Includes venture capital, community reinvestment act, and other investment-related commitments. Commitments to venture capital limited partnerships may extend beyond expiration period shown to cover certain follow-on investments, claims and liabilities, and organizational and partnership expenses.

OFF-BALANCE SHEET ARRANGEMENTS

Off-balance sheet arrangements required by regulation to be discussed in this section are limited to guarantees, retained or contingent interests, certain derivative instruments related to the Company’s common stock, and obligations arising out of unconsolidated variable interest entities. For the Company, these items include certain credit guarantees and securitizations. Guarantees include lending-related guarantees issued as part of the Company’s corporate banking business and securities lending indemnifications issued as part of the Company’s servicing and fiduciary businesses.

 

48


Table of Contents

The Company has issued guarantees as indicated in the table below:

 

(In millions)

Guarantees

   Notional    Typical Revenue
Based on Notional
(Basis Points)

Corporate Banking

     

Standby Letters of Credit

   $ 10,383      5 - 135

Commercial Letters of Credit

     1,189    15 -   75

Credit Derivatives

     370    20 -   40

Securities Lending Indemnifications

     310,970      4 -     6

The Company expects many of these guarantees to expire without the need to advance any cash. The revenue associated with guarantees frequently depends on the credit rating of the obligor and the structure of the transaction including collateral, if any. Advances under securities lending indemnifications would be secured by collateral.

The Company provides services to 6 QSPEs as of December 31, 2005. All of the Company’s securitizations are QSPEs as defined by SFAS 140 which by design are passive investment vehicles, and are therefore not consolidated by the Company. See “Securitizations” in the Notes to the Consolidated Financial Statements.

CAPITAL RESOURCES

Shareholders’ equity was $9,876 million at December 31, 2005, compared with $9,290 million at December 31, 2004, and $8,428 million at December 31, 2003. During 2005, the Company retained $927 million of earnings. Accumulated other comprehensive income declined $128 million reflecting higher unrealized mark-to-market losses in the securities available-for-sale portfolio.

In 2005, the Company issued $285 million of callable medium-term subordinated notes bearing interest at rates from 5.00% to 5.90%. The notes are due in 2020 and 2030 and are callable by the Company after three to five years. The notes qualify as Tier II capital.

The Company also issued $500 million of non-callable subordinated notes due in 2015 and bearing interest at a rate of 4.95%. The notes qualify as Tier II capital.

In 2005, the Company issued $600 million of senior debt with an initial maturity date of April 4, 2006. The investors have the right to extend the maturity date on a monthly basis through March 10, 2015. If an investor does not extend the maturity date of the note, the note becomes payable in 13 months. The debt bears interest at a floating rate ranging from 1-month Libor minus 3 basis points at inception to 1-month Libor plus 2 basis points in 2015.

Also, in 2005, the Company issued $400 million of senior debt due in 2011 and bearing interest at a rate of 4.95%.

On February 27, 2006, indirect subsidiaries of the Company entered into a financing transaction (the “Transaction”) structured as a series of leases pursuant to which the Company’s headquarters building and another office building it occupies in New York City (collectively, the “Premises”) were leased to a foreign financial institution (the “Investor”) pursuant to the terms of a lease (the “Lease”) between the Investor and an indirect subsidiary (the “Subsidiary”) of the Company. The Investor pre-paid rent under the Lease equal to the Euro equivalent of $527 million and subleased the Premises to The Bank of New York. Repayment of the $527 million and all other financial obligations under the Transaction documents are guaranteed by the Company.

The Company recorded the Transaction as long-term debt of $527 million bearing interest at a fixed Euro rate of 3.1% per annum and amortizing on a quarterly basis through 2031, unless terminated earlier.

 

49


Table of Contents

The arrangement can be terminated early by either the Subsidiary or the Investor upon the occurrence of certain events within the first two years. After the second anniversary of the transaction date the Investor may terminate the Lease at its discretion, and the Subsidiary may, at its discretion, discontinue paying operating expenses on the Premises, which would substantially reduce the yield to the Investor and induce the Investor to terminate the Lease.

During 2005, the Company called $94 million of higher rate debt and $110 million of debt matured. In 2005, long-term debt increased to $7,817 million from $6,121 million reflecting the transfer of Pershing from the Bank to the Parent.

The Company raised its common stock dividend to 21 cents per quarter in July 2005. In January 2006, the Company declared a quarterly common stock dividend of 21 cents per share. The Company has two shelf registrations with a remaining capacity of $1,257 million of debt, preferred stock, preferred trust securities, or common stock at December 31, 2005.

In 2004, the Company retained $832 million of earnings, restoring its tangible common equity ratio to its target range. In 2004, the Company issued $206 million of callable medium-term subordinated notes qualifying as Tier 2 capital, as well as $305 million of senior debt. During 2004, the Company called $175 million of higher rate debt, and $300 million of debt matured. Long-term debt was flat at $6,121 million.

In 2003, the Company retained $594 million of earnings. In connection with the acquisition of Pershing, the Company sold 40 million common shares for $996 million. The Company also issued $400 million of non-callable subordinated notes and $239 million of callable medium-term subordinated notes qualifying as Tier 2 capital. In addition, the Company issued $1,281 million of senior debt. The increased long-term debt replaced subordinated debt ceasing to qualify as Tier 2 capital, $525 million of higher rate debt that the Company called during 2003, $710 million of debt that matured in 2003, and provided funding for the Pershing acquisition.

Regulators establish certain levels of capital for bank holding companies and banks, including the Company and the Bank, in accordance with established quantitative measurements. For the Parent to maintain its status as a financial holding company, the Bank must qualify as well capitalized. In addition, major bank holding companies such as the Parent are expected by the regulators to be well capitalized. As of December 31, 2005 and 2004, the Company and the Bank were considered well capitalized on the basis of the ratios (defined by regulation) of Total and Tier 1 capital to risk-weighted assets and leverage (Tier 1 capital to average assets), which are shown as follows:

 

     December 31, 2005     December 31, 2004     Company
Targets
    Well
Capitalized
Guidelines
    Adequately
Capitalized
Guidelines
 
     Company     Bank     Company     Bank        

Tier 1*

   8.38 %   8.88 %   8.31 %   7.07 %   7.75 %   6 %   4 %

Total Capital**

   12.48     11.84     12.21     11.41     11.75     10     8  

Leverage

   6.60     7.05     6.41     5.45       5     3-5  

Tangible Common Equity

   5.58     6.62     5.56     5.24     5.00-5.25 %   N.A.     N.A.  

* Tier 1 capital consists, generally, of common equity, preferred trust securities, and certain qualifying preferred stock, less goodwill and most other intangibles.
** Total Capital consists of Tier 1 capital plus Tier 2 capital. Tier 2 capital consists, generally, of certain qualifying preferred stock and subordinated debt and a portion of the loan loss allowance.

If a bank holding company or bank fails to qualify as “adequately capitalized”, regulatory sanctions and limitations are imposed.

 

50


Table of Contents

At December 31, 2005, the amounts of capital by which the Company and the Bank exceed the well capitalized guidelines are as follows:

 

(In millions)

   Company    Bank

Tier 1 Capital

   $ 1,886    $ 1,950

Total Capital

     1,970      1,244

Leverage

     1,610      1,749

In 2005, the Company bought back a net 5 million shares of which 1 million shares were part of the newly announced buyback program of 20 million shares, leaving 19 million shares authorized for repurchase at December 31, 2005.

In 2006, the Company will balance its acquisition initiatives with continued buyback activity. The Company is also factoring in the use of capital for completion of the Alcentra and Urdang acquisitions, growth in the balance sheet, and the proposed change in lease accounting. Currently, the Company expects a net share reduction in a comparable range to the 5 million share reduction in 2005.

In the first quarter of 2005, ownership of Pershing was transferred from The Bank of New York to the parent company, The Bank of New York Company, Inc. In connection with the transfer, the Company issued $1.1 billion of debt of which $500 million qualified as Tier 2 Capital.

The following table presents the components of the Company’s risk-based capital at December 31, 2005 and 2004:

 

(In millions)

   2005     2004  

Common Stock

   $ 9,876     $ 9,290  

Preferred Trust Securities

     1,150       1,150  

Adjustments:

 

Intangibles

     (4,426 )     (4,265 )
 

Securities Valuation Allowance

     51       (51 )
 

Merchant Banking Investments

     (8 )     (6 )
                

Tier 1 Capital

     6,643       6,118  
                

Qualifying Unrealized Equity Security Gains

     —         —    

Qualifying Subordinated Debt

     2,690       2,149  

Qualifying Allowance for Loan Losses

     565       729  
                

Tier 2 Capital

     3,255       2,878  
                

Total Risk-based Capital

   $ 9,898     $ 8,996  
                

 

51


Table of Contents

The following table presents the components of the Company’s risk-adjusted assets at December 31, 2005 and 2004:

 

     2005     2004  

(In millions)

   Balance
sheet/
notional
amount
    Risk
adjusted
balance
    Balance
sheet/
notional
amount
    Risk
adjusted
balance
 

Assets

        

Cash, Due From Banks and Interest-Bearing Deposits in Banks

   $ 12,159     $ 2,121     $ 12,078     $ 1,918  

Securities

     27,326       6,555       23,802       6,578  

Trading Assets

     5,930       —         4,627       —    

Fed Funds Sold and Securities Purchased
Under Resale Agreements

     2,425       169       5,708       752  

Loans

     40,726       33,748       35,781       30,900  

Allowance for Loan Losses

     (411 )     —         (591 )     —    

Other Assets

     13,919       10,455       13,124       8,853  
                                

Total Assets

   $ 102,074       53,048     $ 94,529       49,001  
                                

Off-Balance Sheet Exposures

        

Commitments to Extend Credit

   $ 37,005     $ 12,979     $ 36,836     $ 11,966  

Securities Lending

     310,970       222       232,184       977  

Standby Letters of Credit and Other Guarantees

     13,703       10,762       12,626       9,464  

Interest Rate Contracts

     695,874       1,271       565,908       1,149  

Foreign Exchange Contracts

     94,535       575       93,850       623  
                                

Total Off-Balance Sheet Exposures

   $ 1,152,087       25,809     $ 941,404       24,179  
                                

Market Risk Equivalent Assets

       426         488  

Allocated Transfer Risk Reserve

       (1 )       (7 )
                    

Risk-Adjusted Assets

     $ 79,282       $ 73,661  
                    

CAPITAL FRAMEWORK

The U.S. federal bank regulatory agencies’ risk capital guidelines are based upon the 1988 Capital Accord of the Basel Committee on Banking Supervision (the “Basel Committee”). The Basel Committee is a committee of central banks and bank supervisors of the major industrialized countries that develop broad policy guidelines with respect to bank supervisory policies. The Basel Committee issued, in June 2004, and updated in November 2005 a revised framework for capital adequacy commonly known as the New Accord (“New Accord”) or Basel II (“Basel II”) that would set capital requirements for operational risk and refine the existing capital requirements for credit risk. Operational risk would be defined as the risk of direct or indirect loss resulting from inadequate or failed internal processes, people and systems, or from external events. Capital measurement for credit risk under the revised framework would differentiate capital levels based upon the risk characteristics of the underlying exposures. The Basel Committee proposal outlines several alternatives for capital assessment of credit and operational risks. The Basel Committee requires two years of impact analysis and parallel testing for banks adopting the advanced approaches under the New Accord, with implementation extended until year-end 2007.

U.S. Implementation of Basel II

In the United States, U.S. regulators are mandating the adoption of the New Accord by banks, such as The Bank of New York, which are considered internationally active or critical to the U.S. payments system. The only approach available to these mandated banks under the New Accord is the Advanced Internal Ratings Based (“AIRB”) approach for credit risk and the Advanced Measurement Approach (“AMA”) for operational risk.

In June 2004 the U.S. federal bank regulatory agencies published a joint release describing proposed Basel II revisions to capital adequacy standards based on the AIRB and AMA approaches. The regulatory agencies

 

52


Table of Contents

have also published draft implementation guidance addressing a number of issues. During 2005, the U.S. federal bank regulatory agencies indicated that the publication of a formal notice of proposed rulemaking setting forth the details of the AIRB and AMA approaches for internationally active banking organizations would be delayed until the first quarter of 2006. During this interim period pending publication and ultimate adoption of new rules, banks that will adopt the new rules in the U.S. are relying upon the current proposal.

The Bank has been relying upon the current proposal—the Advanced Notice Proposed Rulemaking and draft guidance to prepare its implementation strategies. Additionally, the Bank and other mandated banks have been coordinating with international regulatory agencies responsible for supervising the implementation of Basel II at foreign subsidiaries. Jurisdictions outside of the United States are adhering to the original implementation schedule outlined in the New Accord, namely a parallel run of Basel I and Basel II capital calculations by January 2007.

Banking organizations that are not internationally active banking organizations may choose to adopt the AIRB/AMA approaches of the New Accord or they may calculate regulatory capital according to current rules based on the 1988 Accord, subject to revisions to those rules that may be implemented. In October 2005 the U.S. federal bank regulatory agencies published proposed revisions to existing capital guidelines that would apply to these banking organizations and that are based on the so-called “standardized approach” in Basel II. The comment period for these proposals expired on January 18, 2006. The regulators have indicated that the AIRB/AMA provisions for internationally active banking organizations and these provisions for others will become effective on similar time frames.

Both the terms and timing of implementation of Basel II are the subject of considerable controversy among both the bank regulators and Congress. Accordingly, it is not possible to predict the timing or ultimate terms of implementation of Basel II.

The Company’s Implementation

Since June 2004, the Company’s Basel Project Management Office (“Basel PMO”) has been managing the Company’s implementation of the AIRB and AMA approach under the New Accord. The Basel PMO’s primary responsibilities include managing the development of the systems infrastructure to facilitate the data collection and retention requirements under the New Accord and ensuring the Company satisfies the AIRB qualification requirements of the New Accord. The Company believes it is currently in compliance with the requirements of the AMA.

The Company has assigned 24 full-time staff members to the effort and has retained a team of consultants to assist with the systems infrastructure development effort. The estimated cost of implementation to the Company is approximately $30 million and is slated for completion in 2006 to meet both the U.S. and international regulatory agencies’ implementation schedules.

The Basel PMO is nearing completion of its systems infrastructure development effort. It has built the core data warehouse to store the credit risk data necessary to calculate regulatory capital. The Company will begin populating the warehouse with data in the first quarter of 2006 and will be ready to test Basel II capital calculations shortly thereafter. The Basel PMO has also completed the design of validation methodologies for its parameter estimates and has documented the development of the Company’s validation methodologies. The Company has engaged in active discussion with U.S. regulators during the design of these methodologies to help facilitate a smooth transition during the Basel II qualification process.

Basel II Impact on the Company

The Company has participated in four quantitative impact studies with banking regulators to assess the impact of the New Accord. Based on the results of the Fourth Quantitative Impact Study, which used June 30, 2004 data, the Company believes that the New Accord, as currently envisioned, like the current capital requirements under Basel I, will not constrain its current business practices.

 

53


Table of Contents

RISK MANAGEMENT

The major risks to which the Company is exposed are credit, market (primarily interest rate and foreign exchange) and operational risk. Risk management and oversight begins with the Board of Directors and two key Board committees: the Audit and Examining Committee and the Risk Committee.

The Risk Committee meets on a regular basis to review the Company’s risks, policies, and risk management activities. The delegation of policy formulation and day-to-day oversight is to the Company’s Chief Risk Policy Officer, who, together with the Chief Auditor and Chief Compliance Officer helps ensure an effective risk management structure.

The Audit & Examining Committee of the Board of Directors (the “A&E Committee”) is comprised of independent directors, all of whom have been determined by the Board to have financial expertise, as defined under SEC regulations. The A&E Committee meets on a regular basis to perform, among other things, an oversight review of the integrity of the Company’s financial statements and financial reporting process, compliance with legal and regulatory requirements, the independent public accountant’s qualifications and independence, and the performance of the independent public accountant and the Company’s internal audit function. The A&E Committee also reviews management’s assessment of the adequacy of internal controls. The functions of the A&E Committee are described in more detail in its charter, a copy of which is available on the Company’s website, www.bankofny.com.

The Company’s risk management framework is designed to:

 

    Provide that risks are identified, monitored, reported, and priced properly;

 

    Define and communicate the types and amount of risks to take;

 

    Communicate to the appropriate level within the Company the type and amount of risk taken;

 

    Maintain a risk management organization that is independent of the risk taking activities; and

 

    Promote a strong risk management culture that encourages a focus on risk-adjusted performance.

Credit Risk Management

Credit risk is the possible loss the Company would suffer if any of its borrowers or other counterparties were to default on their obligations to the Company. Credit risk arises primarily from lending, trading, and securities servicing activities. To balance the value of its activities with the credit risk incurred in pursuing them, the Company sets and monitors internal credit limits for activities that entail credit risk, most often on the size of the exposure and the maximum maturity of credit extended. For credit exposures, driven by changing market rates and prices, exposure measures include an add-on for such potential changes.

The Company manages credit risk at both the individual exposure level as well as at the portfolio level. Credit risk at the individual exposure level is managed through the Company’s credit approval system of Divisional Portfolio Managers (DPMs) and Senior Credit Officers (SCOs). The DPMs and SCOs are responsible for approving the size, terms and maturity of all credit exposures as well as the ongoing monitoring of the exposures. In addition, they are responsible for assigning and maintaining the risk ratings on each exposure. The Credit Risk Review area regularly examines the credit portfolio to determine compliance with approval policies.

Credit risk at the portfolio level is managed by the Portfolio Management Division (PMD). The PMD is responsible for calculating two fundamental credit measures. First, the Company projects a statistically expected credit loss, used to help determine the appropriate loan loss reserve and to measure customer profitability. Expected loss considers three basic components: the estimated size of the exposure whenever default might occur, the probability of default before maturity, and the severity of the loss the Company would incur, commonly called “loss given default.” For corporate banking, where most of the Company’s credit risk is

 

54


Table of Contents

created, unfunded commitments are assigned a usage given default percentage. Borrowers/Counterparties are assigned ratings by DPMs and SCOs on an 18-grade scale, which translates to a scaled probability of default. Additionally, transactions are assigned loss-given-default ratings (on a 12-grade scale) that reflect the transactions’ structure including the effects of guarantees, collateral, and relative seniority of position.

The second fundamental measurement of credit risk calculated by the PMD is called economic capital. The Company’s economic capital model estimates the capital required to support the overall credit risk portfolio. Using a Monte Carlo simulation engine and measures of correlation among borrower defaults, the economic model examines extreme and highly unlikely scenarios of portfolio credit loss in order to estimate credit related capital, and then allocates that capital to individual borrowers and exposures. Credit related capital calculation supports a second tier of policy standards and limits by serving as an input to both profitability analysis and concentration limits of capital at risk with any one borrower, country or industry.

The PMD is responsible for the calculation methodologies and the estimates of the inputs used in those methodologies for the determination of expected loss and economic capital. These methodologies and input estimates are regularly evaluated to insure their appropriateness and accuracy. As new techniques and data become available, the PMD attempts to incorporate, where appropriate, those techniques or data.

Credit risk is intrinsic to much of the banking business and necessary to its smooth functioning. However, the Company seeks to limit both on and off-balance sheet credit risk through prudent underwriting and the use of capital only where risk-adjusted returns warrant. The Company seeks to manage risk and improve its portfolio diversification through syndications, asset sales, credit enhancements, credit derivatives, and active collateralization and netting agreements. In addition, the Company has a separate Credit Risk Review group made up of experienced loan review officers who perform timely reviews of the loan files and credit ratings assigned to the loans.

Market Risk Management

Market risk is the risk of loss due to adverse changes in the financial markets. Market risk arises from derivative financial instruments, such as futures, forwards, swaps and options, and other financial instruments, including loans, securities, deposits, and other borrowings. The Company’s market risks are primarily interest rate and foreign exchange risk and, to a lesser extent, equity and credit risk.

The Company’s market risk governance structure includes two committees comprised of senior executives who review market risk activities, risk measurement methodologies, and risk limits; approve new products; and provide direction for the Company’s market risk profile. The Asset/Liability Management Committee oversees the market risk management process for interest rate risk related to asset/liability management activities. The Market Risk Management Committee oversees the market risk management process for trading activities, including foreign exchange risk. Both committees are supported by a comprehensive risk management process that is designed to help identify, measure, and manage market risk, as discussed under “Trading Activities and Risk Management” and “Asset/Liability Management” below and in “Fair Value of Financial Instruments” in the Notes to the Consolidated Financial Statements.

The information presented that follows with respect to market risk is forward looking information. As such it is subject to risks and uncertainties that could cause actual results to differ materially from projected results discussed in this Report. These include adverse changes in market conditions, the timing of such changes and the actions that management could take in response to these changes as well as the additional factors discussed under “Forward Looking Statements and Risk Factors That Could Affect Future Results”.

Trading Activities and Risk Management

The Company’s trading activities are focused on acting as a market maker for the Company’s customers. The risk from these market making activities and from the Company’s own positions is managed by the Company’s traders and limited in total exposure as described below.

 

55


Table of Contents

The Company manages trading risk through a system of position limits, a value at risk (VAR) methodology based on a Monte Carlo simulation, stop loss advisory triggers, and other market sensitivity measures. Risk is monitored and reported to senior management by a separate unit on a daily basis. Based on certain assumptions, the VAR methodology is designed to capture the potential overnight pre-tax dollar loss from adverse changes in fair values of all trading positions. The calculation assumes a one-day holding period for most instruments, utilizes a 99% confidence level, and incorporates the non-linear characteristics of options. The VAR model is used to calculate economic capital which is allocated to the business units for computing risk-adjusted performance.

As VAR methodology does not evaluate risk attributable to extraordinary financial, economic or other occurrences, the risk assessment process includes a number of stress scenarios based upon the risk factors in the portfolio and management’s assessment of market conditions. Additional stress scenarios based upon historic market events are also tested. Stress tests by their design incorporate the impact of reduced liquidity and the breakdown of observed correlations. The results of these stress tests are reviewed weekly with senior management.

The following table indicates the calculated VAR amounts for the trading portfolio for the years ending December 31, 2005 and 2004.

 

(In millions)    2005     2004  

Market Risk

   Average     Minimum    Maximum    12/31/05     Average     Minimum    Maximum    12/31/04  

Interest Rate

   $ 2.7     $ 1.8    $ 4.6    $ 2.8     $ 3.8     $ 1.4    $ 7.8    $ 4.0  

Foreign Exchange

     1.5       0.4      4.1      0.9       0.9       0.2      3.1      0.9  

Equity

     0.6       0.3      1.1      0.8       1.1       0.5      2.8      0.7  

Credit Derivatives

     1.4       0.7      2.1      0.9       1.9       1.4      2.3      2.0  

Diversification

     (1.2 )     NM      NM      (1.1 )     (1.4 )     NM      NM      (1.3 )

Overall Portfolio

     5.0       3.1      9.1      4.3       6.3       3.6      12.8      6.3  

NM  – Because the minimum and maximum may occur on different days for different risk components, it is not meaningful to compute a portfolio diversification effect.

During the year 2005, interest rate risk generated 41% of average VAR, credit derivatives generated 28% of average VAR, foreign exchange accounted for 22% of average VAR, and equity generated 9% of average VAR. During 2005, the Company’s daily trading loss did not exceed the Company’s calculated VAR amounts on any given day.

Asset/Liability Management

The Company’s asset/liability management activities include lending, investing in securities, accepting deposits, raising money as needed to fund assets, and processing securities and other transactions. The market risks that arise from these activities are interest rate risk and, to a lesser degree, foreign exchange risk. The Company’s primary market risk is exposure to movements in U.S. dollar interest rates. Exposure to movements in foreign currency interest rates also exists but to a significantly lower degree. The Company actively manages interest rate sensitivity. In addition to gap analysis, the Company uses earnings simulation and discounted cash flow models to identify interest rate exposures.

An earnings simulation model is the primary tool used to assess changes in pre-tax net interest income. The model incorporates management’s assumptions regarding interest rates, balance changes on core deposits, changes in the prepayment behavior of loans and securities, and the impact of derivative financial instruments used for interest rate risk management purposes. These assumptions have been developed through a combination of historical analysis and future expected pricing behavior. These assumptions are inherently uncertain, and, as a result, the earnings simulation model cannot precisely estimate net interest income or the impact of higher or lower interest rates on net interest income. Actual results may differ from projected results due to timing, magnitude and frequency of interest rate changes and changes in market conditions and management’s strategies, among other factors.

 

56


Table of Contents

The Company evaluates the effect on earnings by running various interest rate ramp scenarios up and down from a baseline scenario, which assumes no changes in interest rates. These scenarios are reviewed to examine the impact of large interest rate movements. Interest rate sensitivity is quantified by calculating the change in pre-tax net interest income between the scenarios over a 12 month measurement period. The measurement of interest rate sensitivity is the percentage change in net interest income as shown in the following table:

 

     Estimated Changes in
Net Interest Income
December 31, 2005
 
     (In millions)     %  

+200 basis point Ramp vs. Stable Rate

   $ (65 )   (3.2 )%

+100 basis point Ramp vs. Stable Rate

     (29 )   (1.4 )

-100 basis point Ramp vs. Stable Rate

     (8 )   (0.4 )

-200 basis point Ramp vs. Stable Rate

     (32 )   (1.6 )

The base case scenario fed funds rate in the December 31, 2005 analysis was 4.25%. The 100+ basis point ramp scenario assumes short-term rates rise 25 basis points in each of the next four quarters, while the 200+ ramp scenario assumes a 50 basis point per quarter increase. The 100+ basis point December 31, 2005 scenario assumes a steepening of the yield curve with 10-year rates rising 114 basis points. The 200+ basis point December 31, 2005 scenario assumes a slight steepening of the yield curve with 10-year rates rising 214 basis points. These scenarios do not reflect strategies that management could employ to limit the impact as interest rate expectations change.

The above table relies on certain critical assumptions, including depositors’ behavior related to interest rate fluctuations and the prepayment and extension risk in certain of the Company’s assets. In addition, if interest rates decline, the Company’s portfolio of mortgage-related assets would have reduced returns if the borrowers pay off their mortgages earlier than anticipated. To the extent that actual behavior is different from that assumed in the models, there could be a change in interest rate sensitivity.

The Company also projects future cash flows from its assets and liabilities over a long-term horizon and then discounts these cash flows using the same assumptions noted above. The aggregation of these discounted cash flows is the Economic Value of Equity (“EVE”). The following table shows how the EVE would change in response to changes in interest rates:

 

Rate Change

   Estimated Change in EVE
December 31, 2005
 
     (In millions)  

+200 basis point Ramp vs. Stable Rate

   $ 42  

+100 basis point Ramp vs. Stable Rate

     56  

-100 basis point Ramp vs. Stable Rate

     (56 )

-200 basis point Ramp vs. Stable Rate

     (176 )

These results do not reflect strategies that management could employ to limit the impact as interest rate expectations change.

The asymmetrical accounting treatment of the impact of a change in interest rates on the Company’s balance sheet may create a situation in which an increase in interest rates can adversely affect reported equity and regulatory capital, even though economically there may be no impact on the economic capital position of the Company. For example, an increase in rates will result in a decline in the value of the Company’s fixed income investment portfolio, which will be reflected through a reduction in other comprehensive income in the Company’s shareholders equity, thereby affecting the tangible common equity (“TCE”) ratio. Under current accounting rules, there is no corresponding change on the Company’s fixed liabilities, even though economically these liabilities are more valuable as rates rise.

 

57


Table of Contents

The Company projects the impact of this change using the same interest rate ramp up assumptions described earlier and comparing the projected mark-to-market on the investment securities portfolio at December 31, 2005, under the higher rate environments versus a stable rate scenario. The table below shows the impact of a change in interest rates on the TCE ratio:

 

Rate Change

  

Estimated Change in TCE ratio
December 31, 2005

(In basis points)

 

+200 basis point Ramp vs. Stable Rate

   (40 )

+100 basis point Ramp vs. Stable Rate

   (19 )

-100 basis point Ramp vs. Stable Rate

   13  

-200 basis point Ramp vs. Stable Rate

   19  

These results do not reflect strategies that management could employ to limit the impact as interest rate expectations change.

To manage foreign exchange risk, the Company funds foreign currency-denominated assets with liability instruments denominated in the same currency. The Company utilizes various foreign exchange contracts if a liability denominated in the same currency is not available or desired, and to minimize the earnings impact of translation gains or losses created by investments in overseas markets. The foreign exchange risk related to the interest rate spread on foreign currency-denominated asset/liability positions is managed as part of the Company’s trading activities. The Company uses forward foreign exchange contracts to protect the value of its net investment in foreign operations. At December 31, 2005, net investments in foreign operations totaled approximately $1,589 million and were spread across 13 foreign currencies.

Operational Risk

Overview

Operational risk is the risk of loss resulting from inadequate or failed internal processes, human factors and systems, or from external events.

In providing securities servicing, global payment services, asset management, and traditional banking and trust services, the Company is exposed to operational risk. Operational risk may result from, but is not limited to, errors related to transaction processing, breaches of the internal control system and compliance requirements, and the risk of fraud by employees or persons outside the corporation or business interruption due to system failures or other events. The risk of loss from operational risk also includes potential legal or regulatory actions that could arise as a result of noncompliance with applicable laws and/or regulatory requirements. As discussed in “Certain Regulatory Considerations”, the Company is subject to a very comprehensive and frequently changing regulatory scheme.

In the event of an operational event, the Company could suffer financial loss, face regulatory or law enforcement action and/or suffer damage to its reputation.

To address this risk, the Company maintains comprehensive policies and procedures and an internal control framework designed to provide a sound operational environment. These controls have been designed to manage operational risk at appropriate levels given the Company’s financial strength, the business environment and markets in which it operates, the nature of its businesses, and considering factors such as competition and regulation. The Company’s internal auditors monitor and test the overall effectiveness of the internal control and financial reporting systems on an ongoing basis.

The Company has also established procedures that are designed to ensure that policies relating to conduct, ethics and business practices are followed on a uniform basis. Among the procedures designed to ensure effectiveness are the Company’s “Code of Conduct”, “Know Your Customer”, and compliance training programs.

 

58


Table of Contents

Operational Risk Management

The Company has established operational risk management as an independent risk discipline. The Operational Risk Management (“ORM”) group reports to the Chief Risk Policy Officer. The organizational framework for operational risk is based upon a strong risk culture that incorporates both governance and risk management activities comprising:

 

    Board Oversight and Governance—The Company has established a Risk Committee of the Board that approves and oversees the Company’s operational risk management strategy in addition to credit and market risk. The Committee meets regularly to review and approve operational risk management initiatives, discuss key risk issues, and review the effectiveness of the risk management systems.

 

    Business Line Accountability—Business managers are responsible for maintaining an effective system of internal controls commensurate with their risk profiles and in accordance with Company policies and procedures.

 

    ORM group—The ORM group is responsible for developing risk management policies and tools for assessing, monitoring, and measuring operational risk for the Company. The primary objectives of the ORM group are to promote effective risk management, create incentives for generating continuous improvement in controls, optimize capital, and improve shareholder value.

Key elements of the operational risk management function include systems to measure, monitor, and allocate economic capital to the business units for operational risks.

Global Compliance

The Company’s global compliance function provides leadership, guidance, and oversight to help business units identify applicable laws and regulations and implement effective measures to meet the specific requirements. Compliance attempts to take a proactive approach by anticipating evolving regulatory standards and remaining aware of industry best practices, legislative initiatives, competitive issues, and public expectations and perceptions. The function uses its global reach to disseminate information about compliance-related matters throughout the Company. The Chief Compliance Officer reports to the General Counsel, is a member of all critical Corporate committees, and provides routine updates to the Audit and Examining Committee of the Board.

Internal Audit

The Company’s internal audit function employs over 190 professionals globally. The group reports directly to the Audit & Examining Committee of the Company. Internal Audit utilizes a risk based approach to its audit approach covering the risks in the operational, compliance, regulatory, technology, fraud, processing and other key risks areas of the Company. Internal Audit has unrestricted access to the Company and regularly participates in all key committees of the Company. In addition, Internal Audit has established an active monitoring program to ensure that the risk based audit program is continually being enhanced for current issues and events.

Business Continuity

The Company has prepared for events that could damage the Company’s physical facilities, cause delay or disruptions to operational functions, including telecommunications networks, or impair the Company’s clients, vendors, and counterparties. Key elements of the Company’s business continuity strategies are extensive planning and testing, and diversity of business operations, data centers and telecommunications infrastructure.

The Company has established multiple geographically diverse locations for its funds transfer and broker-dealer services operations, which have redundant full functionality to assure uninterrupted processing. The Company’s mutual fund accounting and custody, securities operations, securities lending, corporate trust, master trust, UIT, stock transfer, and treasury have common functionality in multiple sites designed to facilitate recovery within 24 hours. In addition, the Company has recovery positions outside downtown Manhattan for over 5,000 employees.

 

59


Table of Contents

The Company has continued to develop geographic diversity outside Manhattan by moving additional personnel to growth centers outside New York City, and by establishing its primary data center in the U.S. mid-South region in late 2005.

The Company replicates 100% of its critical production computer data to its recovery data center, which is at a distance of well over 500 miles from its primary data center.

In the telecommunications area, the Company uses multiple central office sites, with a fiber optic relay network backed up by T-3 lines to ensure the continuity of its voice and data communications. In addition, primary customer connectivity has been moved outside of New York City and back-up lines are generally leased rather than dial-up. The Company has an active program to test customer back-up connections.

In May 2003, the Federal Reserve published the Interagency Paper, “Sound Practices to Strengthen the Resilience of the U.S. Financial System” (“Interagency Paper”). The purpose of the document was to define the guidelines for the financial services industry and other interested parties regarding “best practices” related to business continuity planning. The Interagency Paper identified the Company as a core clearing and settlement organization required to meet a higher standard for business continuity. Significant areas impacting the Company include the proximity of production to contingency sites for technology processing and business operations, technology recovery, recovery timeframes, regional diversification, definition of critical functions in financial services, and timetables for implementing best practices.

The Company is committed to meeting or exceeding all of the requirements. As a core clearing and settlement organization, the Company believes that it is at the forefront of the industry in improving its business continuity practices. Acceleration of the implementation of this plan resulted in overlap costs of $26 million which will phase out over 2006 and 2007. With the Company’s new primary data center having become operational in late 2005, the Company believes it has met substantially all of the requirements.

The Company is committed to ensuring that requirements for business continuity are met not just within its own data centers, but also within the facilities of those vendors and service providers whose operation is critical to the Company’s safety and soundness. To that end, the Company has a Service Provider Management Office whose function is to ensure that new and existing service providers and vendors meet the Company’s standards for business continuity, as well as information security, financial stability, personnel practices, etc.

Although the Company is committed to observing best practices as well as meeting regulatory requirements, geopolitical uncertainties and other external factors will continue to create risk that cannot always be identified and anticipated.

 

60


Table of Contents

STATISTICAL INFORMATION

Average Balances and Rates on a Tax Equivalent Basis

 

    2005     2004     2003  
(Dollars in millions)   Average
Balance
    Interest     Average
Rate
    Average
Balance
    Interest     Average
Rate
    Average
Balance
    Interest     Average
Rate
 

Assets

                 

Interest-Bearing Deposits in Banks (Primarily Foreign)

  $ 8,996     $ 274     3.04 %   $ 11,675     $ 305     2.62 %   $ 6,690     $ 150     2.24 %

Federal Funds Sold and Securities Purchased Under Resale Agreements

    4,685       142     3.03       6,562       80     1.22       7,326       79     1.07  

Margin Loans

    6,403       267     4.17       6,342       156     2.46       3,795       86     2.27  

Non-Margin Loans
Domestic Offices

                 

Consumer

    5,648       347     6.15       4,598       233     5.06       4,069       223     5.47  

Commercial

    17,157       704     4.10       17,255       566     3.28       16,389       632     3.86  

Foreign Offices

    10,474       454     4.33       9,583       283     2.95       11,370       332     2.93  
                                                     

Non-Margin Loans

    33,279       1,505 *   4.52       31,436       1,082 *   3.44       31,828       1,187 *   3.73  
                                                     

Securities

                 

U.S. Government Obligations

    273       9     3.43       415       11     2.58       323       11     3.12  

U.S. Government Agency Obligations

    3,766       153     4.05       3,853       128     3.33       3,516       128     3.66  

Obligations of States and Political Subdivisions

    215       15     6.95       229       17     7.41       329       23     6.94  

Other Securities
Domestic Offices

    19,066       784     4.11       17,101       593     3.47       14,597       529     3.62  

Foreign Offices

    1,882       83     4.44       1,354       59     4.36       1,085       42     3.91  
                                                     

Total Other Securities

    20,948       867     4.14       18,455       652     3.53       15,682       571     3.64  
                                                     

Trading Securities

                 

Domestic Offices

    593       22     3.77       584       16     2.72       587       15     2.55  

Foreign Offices

    2,956       131     4.45       1,510       36     2.41       4,018       115     2.85  
                                                     

Total Trading Securities

    3,549       153     4.34       2,094       52     2.50       4,605       130     2.81  
                                                     

Total Securities

    28,751       1,197     4.16       25,046       860     3.43       24,455       863     3.53  
                                                     

Total Interest-Earning Assets

    82,114     $ 3,385     4.12 %     81,061     $ 2,483     3.06 %     74,094     $ 2,365     3.19 %
                                   

Allowance for Credit Losses

    (574 )         (623 )         (672 )    

Cash and Due from Banks

    3,357           3,151           2,834      

Other Assets

    16,538           15,751           15,211      
                                   

Total Assets

  $ 101,435         $ 99,340         $ 91,467      
                                   

Assets Attributable to Foreign Offices **

    26.27 %         26.47 %         29.09 %    
                                   

Tax equivalent adjustments were $29 million in 2005, $30 million in 2004, and $35 million in 2003, and are based on the federal statutory tax rate (35%) and applicable state and local taxes.

 

* Includes fees of $69 million in 2005, $95 million in 2004, and $88 million in 2003. Nonaccrual loans are included in the average loan balance; the associated income, recognized on the cash basis, is included in interest.
** Includes Cayman Islands branch office.

 

61


Table of Contents

Average Balances and Rates on a Tax Equivalent Basis

 

    2005     2004     2003  
(Dollars in millions)   Average
Balance
    Interest   Average
Rate
    Average
Balance
    Interest   Average
Rate
    Average
Balance
    Interest   Average
Rate
 

Liabilities and Shareholders’ Equity

                 

Interest-Bearing Deposits
Domestic Offices

                 

Money Market Rate Accounts

  $ 6,767     $ 109   1.62 %   $ 6,648     $ 54   0.81 %   $ 7,381     $ 60   0.82 %

Savings

    8,695       103   1.18       9,224       65   0.71       9,014       71   0.78  

Certificates of Deposit of $100,000 or More

    3,167       108   3.40       3,706       55   1.49       4,179       65   1.56  

Other Time Deposits

    1,378       35   2.57       955       15   1.57       1,257       20   1.55  
                                               

Total Domestic Offices

    20,007       355   1.77       20,533       189   0.92       21,831       216   0.99  
                                               

Foreign Offices

                 

Banks in Foreign Countries

    6,050       129   2.13       5,705       60   1.05       5,765       56   0.98  

Government & Official Institutions

    581       14   2.44       419       8   1.84       422       8   1.92  

Other Time and Savings

    19,930       459   2.30       19,633       291   1.49       17,927       227   1.26  
                                               

Total Foreign Offices

    26,561       602   2.26       25,757       359   1.39       24,114       291   1.21  
                                               

Total Interest-Bearing Deposits

    46,568       957   2.05       46,290       548   1.18       45,945       507   1.10  
                                               

Federal Funds Purchased and Securities Sold Under Repurchase Agreements

    1,284       35   2.73       1,551       15   0.99       1,542       13   0.85  

Other Borrowed Funds

                 

Domestic Offices

    1,480       55   3.68       2,025       40   1.95       1,580       20   1.27  

Foreign Offices

    385       3   0.84       650       12   1.88       74       1   0.88  
                                               

Total Other Borrowed Funds

    1,865       58   3.10       2,675       52   1.93       1,654       21   1.26  

Payables to Customers and Broker-Dealers

    6,014       128   2.12       6,361       57   0.89       3,945       30   0.75  

Long-Term Debt

    7,312       269   3.68       6,152       136   2.19       6,103       150   2.45  
                                               

Total Interest-Bearing Liabilities

    63,043       1,447   2.29 %     63,029       808   1.28 %     59,189       721   1.22 %
                                               

Noninterest-Bearing Deposits (Primarily Domestic)

    15,647           14,766           12,670      

Other Liabilities

    13,272           12,748           11,954      

Common Shareholders’ Equity

    9,473           8,797           7,654      
                                   

Total Liabilities and Shareholders’ Equity

  $ 101,435         $ 99,340         $ 91,467      
                                   

Net Interest Earnings and Interest Rate Spread

    $ 1,938   1.83 %     $ 1,675   1.78 %     $ 1,644   1.97 %
                                         

Net Yield on Interest-Earning Assets

      2.36 %       2.07 %       2.22 %
                             

Liabilities Attributable to Foreign Offices

    28.06 %         28.40 %         28.78 %    
                                   

 

62


Table of Contents

Rate/Volume Analysis on a Tax Equivalent Basis

 

     2005 vs. 2004     2004 vs. 2003  
(In millions)   

Increase (Decrease)

due to change in:

   

Increase (Decrease)

due to change in:

 
     Average
Balance
    Average
Rate
    Total
Increase
(Decrease)
    Average
Balance
    Average
Rate
    Total
Increase
(Decrease)
 

Interest Income

            

Interest-Bearing Deposits in Banks

   $ (76 )   $ 45     $ (31 )   $ 127     $ 28     $ 155  

Federal Funds Sold and Securities Purchased Under Resale Agreements

     (28 )     90       62       (9 )     10       1  

Margin Loans

     2       109       111       62       8       70  

Non-Margin Loans

            

Domestic Offices

            

Consumer

     58       56       114       27       (17 )     10  

Commercial

     (3 )     141       138       33       (99 )     (66 )

Foreign Offices

     28       143       171       (52 )     3       (49 )
                                                

Non-Margin Loans

     83       340       423       8       (113 )     (105 )
                                                

Securities

            

U.S. Government Obligations

     (5 )     3       (2 )     2       (2 )     —    

U.S. Government Agency Obligations

     (3 )     28       25       12       (12 )     —    

Obligations of States and Political Subdivisions

     (1 )     (1 )     (2 )     (7 )     1       (6 )

Other Securities:

            

Domestic Offices

     74       117       191       88       (24 )     64  

Foreign Offices

     23       1       24       11       6       17  
                                                

Total Other Securities

     97       118       215       99       (18 )     81  
                                                

Trading Securities:

            

Domestic Offices

     —         6       6       —         1       1  

Foreign Offices

     50       45       95       (63 )     (16 )     (79 )
                                                

Total Trading Securities

     50       51       101       (63 )     (15 )     (78 )
                                                

Total Securities

     138       199       337       43       (46 )     (3 )
                                                

Total Interest Income

     119       783       902       231       (113 )     118  
                                                

Interest Expense

            

Interest-Bearing Deposits

            

Domestic Offices:

            

Money Market Rate Accounts

     1       54       55       (5 )     (1 )     (6 )

Savings

     (4 )     42       38       1       (7 )     (6 )

Certificate of Deposits of $100,000 or More

     (9 )     62       53       (7 )     (3 )     (10 )

Other Time Deposits

     8       12       20       (5 )     —         (5 )
                                                

Total Domestic Offices

     (4 )     170       166       (16 )     (11 )     (27 )
                                                

Foreign Offices:

            

Banks in Foreign Countries

     4       65       69       —         4       4  

Government and Official Institutions

     3       3       6       —         —         —    

Other Time and Savings

     5       163       168       22       42       64  
                                                

Total Foreign Offices

     12       231       243       22       46       68  
                                                

Total Interest-Bearing Deposits

     8       401       409       6       35       41  

Federal Funds Purchased and Securities Sold Under Repurchase Agreements

     (3 )     23       20       —         2       2  

Other Borrowed Funds

            

Domestic Offices

     (13 )     28       15       7       13       20  

Foreign Offices

     (4 )     (5 )     (9 )     10       1       11  
                                                

Total Other Borrowed Funds

     (17 )     23       6       17       14       31  
                                                

Payables to Customers and Broker-Dealers

     (3 )     74       71       21       6       27  

Long-Term Debt

     30       103       133       1       (15 )     (14 )
                                                

Total Interest Expense

     15       624       639       45       42       87  
                                                

Change in Net Interest Income

   $ 104     $ 159     $ 263     $ 186     $ (155 )   $ 31  
                                                

Changes which are not solely due to balance changes or rate changes are allocated to such categories on the basis of the respective percentage changes in average balances and average rates.

 

63


Table of Contents

Operating Leverage

 

     2005    2004   

% Change

Reported

   

% Change

Core

 

(In millions)

   Reported    Adj     Core    Reported    Adj     Core     

Noninterest Income

   $ 4,956    $ —       $ 4,956    $ 4,650    $ (70 )   $ 4,580    6.6 %   8.2 %

Net Interest Income

     1,909      —         1,909      1,645      66       1,711    16.0     11.6  

Total Revenue

     6,865      —         6,865      6,295      (4 )     6,291    9.1     9.1  

Total Expense

     4,483      —         4,483      4,122      (48 )     4,074    8.8     10.0  

Operating Leverage

                   0.3 %   (0.9 )%
                            
     2004    2003   

% Change

Reported

   

% Change

Core

 
      Reported    Adj     Core    Reported    Adj     Core     

Noninterest Income

   $ 4,650    $ (70 )   $ 4,580    $ 3,996    $ —       $ 3,996    16.4 %   14.6 %

Net Interest Income

     1,645      66       1,711      1,609      —         1,609    2.2     6.3  

Total Revenue

     6,295      (4 )     6,291      5,605      —         5,605    12.3     12.2  

Total Expense

     4,122      (48 )     4,074      3,698      —         3,698    11.5     10.2  

Operating Leverage

                   0.8 %   2.0 %
                            

UNAUDITED QUARTERLY DATA

 

(Dollars in millions,

except per share amounts)

   2005     2004  
   Fourth     Third     Second     First     Fourth     Third     Second     First  

Total Revenue (tax equivalent basis)

   $ 2,237     $ 2,126     $ 2,077     $ 1,917     $ 1,967     $ 1,736     $ 1,765     $ 1,667  

Interest Income

     956       870       814       732       782       629       601       441  

Interest Expense

     464       378       344       277       255       201       180       173  
                                                                

Net Interest Income

     492       492       470       455       527       428       421       268  
                                                                

Provision for Credit Losses

     10       10       5       (10 )     (7 )     —         10       12  

Noninterest Income

     1,274       1,248       1,256       1,178       1,176       1,099       1,156       1,220  

Noninterest Expense

     1,148       1,135       1,123       1,077       1,097       999       1,012       1,013  
                                                                

Income Before Income Taxes

     608       595       598       566       613       528       555       463  

Income Taxes

     203       206       200       187       262       174       184       99  
                                                                

Net Income

   $ 405     $ 389     $ 398     $ 379     $ 351     $ 354     $ 371     $ 364  
                                                                

Per Common Share Data:

                

Basic Earnings

   $ 0.53     $ 0.51     $ 0.52     $ 0.49     $ 0.45     $ 0.46     $ 0.48     $ 0.47  

Diluted Earnings

     0.53       0.51       0.52       0.49       0.45       0.46       0.48       0.47  

Cash Dividend

     0.21       0.21       0.20       0.20       0.20       0.20       0.20       0.19  

Stock Price

                

High

     32.96       31.25       29.58       33.31       33.92       30.26       33.01       34.71  

Low

     28.83       28.69       27.25       28.74       29.65       27.55       28.69       30.58  

Ratios:

                

Return on Average Common Shareholders’ Equity

     16.57 %     16.15 %     17.12 %     16.52 %     15.34 %     15.90 %     17.14 %     17.17 %

Return on Average Assets

     1.53       1.53       1.59       1.55       1.40       1.45       1.49       1.47  

 

64


Table of Contents

The Company’s securities that are listed on the New York Stock Exchange® (NYSE) are Common Stock, 5.95% Preferred Trust Securities Series F, and 6.88% Preferred Trust Securities Series E. The NYSE symbol for the Company’s Common Stock is BK. All of the Company’s other securities are not currently listed. The Company had 25,186 common shareholders of record at January 31, 2006.

New York Stock Exchange Annual Certification

Because the Company’s common stock is listed on the NYSE, the Company’s Chief Executive Officer is required to make, and has made, an annual certification to the NYSE stating that he was not aware of any violation by the Company of the corporate governance listing standards of the NYSE. The Company’s chief executive officer submitted his annual certification to that effect to the NYSE as of May 11, 2005.

The Company has filed with the SEC the certification required to be made by the Company’s Chief Executive Officer and Chief Financial Officer under Section 302 of the Sarbanes Oxley Act of 2002, as an exhibit to this Annual Report on Form 10-K for the year ending December 31, 2005.

Market for Registrant’s Common Equity, Related Stockholder Matters and Issuer Purchases of Equity Securities

On October 10, 2005, 2,400 shares of common stock were issued to a new non-employee director as part of his annual retainer. This transaction was exempt from registration under the Securities Act of 1933 pursuant to Section 4(2).

Under its stock repurchase program, the Company buys back shares from time to time. The following table discloses the Company’s repurchases of its common stock made during the fourth quarter of 2005.

 

Period

  

Total

Number

of Shares

Purchased

  

Average

Price

Paid

Per Share

  

Total Number

of Shares

Purchased as

Part of Publicly

Announced Plans

or Programs

  

Maximum

Number of Shares

That May Yet be

Repurchased

Under the Plans

or Programs

October 1-31

   51,407    $ 31.12    51,407    19,255,175

November 1-30

   3,723      31.49    3,723    19,251,452

December 1-31

   250,172      32.25    250,172    19,001,280
               

Total

   305,302       305,302   

All shares were repurchased through the Company’s 20 million share stock repurchase program, which was announced on July 12, 2005. All the shares repurchased in the fourth quarter were from employee benefit plans.

 

65


Table of Contents

OTHER 2004 DEVELOPMENTS

(1) In 2004 the Company recorded several gains and charges that in the aggregate reduced reported earnings by 3 cents per share. These items were recorded in the first and fourth quarters of 2004 and are summarized in the table below.

 

(In millions)
Item

  

Applicable
Quarter

  

Income Statement
Caption

   Pre-Tax
Income
    Tax     After-Tax
Income
 

Net Interest Income(a)

            

SFAS 13 cumulative
lease adjustment—(leasing portfolio)

    

First

    

Net Interest Income

   $ (145 )   $ 113     $ (32 )

lease adjustment—(cross-border
rail equipment leases)

    

Fourth

    

Net Interest Income

     89       (37 )     52  

lease adjustment—(aircraft leases)

   Fourth    Net Interest Income      (10 )     4       (6 )
                              

Subtotal—Net Interest Income

           (66 )     80       14  

Aircraft leases/other

   Fourth    Provision for Credit Losses      7       (3 )     4  
                              

Subtotal—Net Interest Income After
Provision for Credit Losses

           (59 )     77       18  

Noninterest Income(b)

            

Gain on sale of Wing Hang

   First    Other Income      48       (21 )     27  

Gain on sponsor fund investments

   First    Securities Gains      19       (7 )     12  

Aircraft leases

   Fourth    Other Income      3       (1 )     2  
                              

Subtotal—Noninterest Income

           70       (29 )     41  

Noninterest Expense(c)

            

Severance tied to relocations

   First    Salaries and Employee Benefits      (10 )     4       (6 )

Lease terminations

   First    Net Occupancy      (8 )     3       (5 )

Charge for the RW Matter

   Fourth    Other Expense      (30 )     8       (22 )
                              

Subtotal—Noninterest Expense

           (48 )     15       (33 )

Federal tax reserve adjustment related to
LILO exposure

    

Fourth

    

Income Tax

     —         (50 )     (50 )
                              

Total

         $ (37 )   $ 13     $ (24 )
                              

(a) An after-tax charge of $32 million resulting from a cumulative adjustment to the leasing portfolio was triggered under Statement of Financial Accounting Standards No. 13 “Accounting for Leases” (“SFAS 13”) by the combination of a reduction in state and local taxes and a restructuring of the lease portfolio completed in the first quarter. The SFAS 13 adjustment impacts the timing of lease income reported by the Company, and resulted in a reduction in net interest income of $145 million, offset by tax benefits of $113 million.

An after-tax benefit of $52 million resulted from a SFAS 13 cumulative adjustment to the leasing portfolio for customers exercising their early buy-out (“EBO”) options. The Company’s leasing portfolio contains a number of large cross-border leveraged leases where the lessee has an early buy-out option to purchase the leased assets, generally railcars and related assets. Given a confluence of economic factors, the value of the leased equipment currently exceeds the exercise price of the early buy-out option. The Company offered financial incentives to these lessees to accelerate the exercise of their early buy-out options. As a result, several lessees agreed to this proposal, triggering the after-tax $52 million gain. The gain results from the recognition of lease income over a shorter time frame, since the term of the lease has been shortened to the early buy-out date.

 

66


Table of Contents

Net investment in aircraft leases was impacted by a $6 million after-tax adjustment related to aircraft leased to two airlines. The Company recorded a $7 million reduction in the provision for credit losses which largely reflects release of reserves on the aircraft leases.

(b) A $27 million after-tax gain on the sale of a portion of the Company’s interest in Wing Hang Bank Limited (“Wing Hang”), a Hong Kong based bank, which was recorded in other income, and $19 million ($12 million after-tax) of higher than anticipated securities gains in the first quarter resulting from realized gains on sponsor fund investments in Kinkos, Inc., Bristol West Holdings, Inc., Willis Group Holdings, Ltd., and True Temper Sports, Inc.

The Company also had an after-tax gain of $2 million on the sale of a leased aircraft.

(c) The Company also took several actions associated with its long-term cost reduction initiatives. These actions included an after-tax severance charge of $6 million related to staff reductions tied to job relocations and a $5 million after-tax charge for terminating high cost leases associated with the staff redeployments.

The Company recorded an after-tax expense of $22 million in connection with the anticipated settlement of the RW Professional Leasing Services Corp. matter (“RW Matter”). This expense is only partially tax deductible.

The Company had several appellate conferences with the IRS related to the Company’s cross-border leveraged lease transactions in December of 2004 and January 2005. Based on a revision to the probabilities and costs assigned to litigation and settlement outcomes, the Company recorded a $50 million expense associated with increasing the tax reserve on these transactions.

 

67


Table of Contents

GLOSSARY

Alternative investments: Usually refers to investments in hedge funds, leveraged loans, subordinated and distressed debt, real estate and foreign currency overlay. Many hedge funds pursue strategies that are uncommon relative to mutual funds. Examples of alternative investment strategies are: long-short equity, event driven, statistical arbitrage, fixed income arbitrage, convertible arbitrage, short bias, global macro, and equity market neutral.

Assets Under Custody: The financial institution has legal responsibility for the customer’s assets. This includes management, administration and safekeeping.

Assets Under Management: Usually refers to the market value of assets an investment company manages on behalf of investors. The Company includes in its assets under management funds managed by its foreign exchange overlay business and short term investment funds managed as part of its securities lending business.

Collateral Management: Collateral management is a comprehensive program designed to simplify collateralization and expedite securities transfers for buyers and sellers. The Company acting as an independent collateral manager is positioned between the buyer and seller to provide a convenient, flexible, and efficient service to ensure proper collateralization throughout the term of the transaction. The service includes verification of securities eligibility and maintenance of margin requirements.

Credit derivatives are contractual agreements that provide insurance against a credit event of one or more referenced credits. The nature of the credit event is established by the buyer and seller at the inception of the transaction, such events include bankruptcy, insolvency and failure to meet payment obligations when due. The buyer of the credit derivative pays a periodic fee in return for a contingent payment by the seller (insurer) following a credit event.

Credit risk: The risk of loss due to borrower or counterparty default.

Cross-currency swaps are contracts that generally involve the exchange of both interest and principal amounts in two different currencies. Also see interest rate swaps in this glossary.

Depositary receipts (“DR”): A negotiable security that generally represents a non-U.S. company’s publicly traded equity. Although typically denominated in U.S. dollars, depositary receipts can also be denominated in Euros. Depositary receipts are eligible to trade on all U.S. stock exchanges and many European stock exchanges. American depositary receipts (“ADR”) trade only in the U.S.

Economic Value of Equity (“EVE”): An aggregation of discounted future cash flows of assets and liabilities over a long-term horizon.

Exchange traded fund (“ETF”): Each share of an ETF tracks a basket of stocks in some index or benchmark, providing investors with a vehicle that closely parallels the performance of these benchmarks while allowing for intraday trading.

Foreign currency options are similar to interest rate options except they are based on foreign exchange rates. Also see interest rate options in this glossary.

Foreign currency swaps: An agreement to exchange stipulated amounts of one currency for another currency at one or more future dates.

Foreign exchange contracts are contracts that provide for the future receipt or delivery of foreign currency at previously agreed-upon terms.

Foreign exchange overlay: The Company’s specialist currency management group, BNY Overlay Associates, provides foreign exchange risk management solutions and alternative investment products. The

 

68


Table of Contents

currency programs can be structured as independent investment vehicles or as value-enhancing overlays on another asset class. The Company provides complete management service, from initial consultation to strategy execution and electronic reporting.

Forward rate agreements are contracts to exchange payments on a specified future date, based on a market change in interest rates from trade date to contract settlement date.

Granularity refers to the amount of concentration in the credit portfolio due to large individual exposures. One measure of granularity is the amount of economic capital an exposure uses. As the average economic capital per exposure declines, the portfolio is considered to be more granular.

Hedge fund: A fund, usually used by wealthy individuals and institutions, which is allowed to use aggressive strategies that are unavailable to mutual funds, including selling short, leverage, program trading, swaps, arbitrage, and derivatives. Hedge funds are exempt from many of the rules and regulations governing mutual funds, which allow them to accomplish aggressive investing goals. Legal requirements in many countries allow only certain sophisticated investors to participate in hedge funds.

Interest rate options, including caps and floors, are contracts to modify interest rate risk in exchange for the payment of a premium when the contract is initiated. As a writer of interest rate options, the Company receives a premium in exchange for bearing the risk of unfavorable changes in interest rates. Conversely, as a purchaser of an option, the Company pays a premium for the right, but not the obligation, to buy or sell a financial instrument or currency at predetermined terms in the future.

Interest rate sensitivity: The exposure of net interest income to interest rate movements.

Interest rate swaps are contracts in which a series of interest rate flows in a single currency is exchanged over a prescribed period. Interest rate swaps are the most common type of derivative contract that the Company uses in its asset/liability management activities. An example of a situation in which the Company would utilize an interest rate swap would be to convert its fixed-rate debt to a variable rate. By entering into the swap, the principal amount of the debt would remain unchanged, but the interest streams would change.

Investment grade equivalent: The Company’s internal risk assessment which generally represents a risk profile similar to that of a BBB-/Baa3 or better rating as defined by independent rating agencies, such as Standard & Poor’s or Moody’s.

Invoiced services are services provided by global payment services that are paid for by fees or by leaving a compensating balance.

Liquidity risk: The risk of being unable to fund the Company’s portfolio of assets at appropriate maturities and rates, and the risk of being unable to liquidate a position in a timely manner at a reasonable price.

Mark-to-market exposure: Mark-to market exposure is a measure, at a point in time, of the value of a derivative or foreign exchange contract in the open market. When the mark-to-market is positive, it indicates the counterparty owes the Company and, therefore, creates a repayment risk for the Company. When the mark-to-market is negative, the Company owes the counterparty. In this situation, the Company does not have repayment risk.

Market risk: The potential loss in value of portfolios and financial instruments caused by movements in market variables, such as interest and foreign-exchange rates, credit spreads, and equity and commodity prices.

Net yield on interest-earning assets: The average rate for interest-earning assets less the average rate paid for all sources of funds.

 

69


Table of Contents

Operating leverage is measured by comparing the rate of increase in revenue to the rate of increase in expenses.

Operational risk: The risk of loss resulting from inadequate or failed processes or systems, human factors, or external events.

Securities lending short-term investment fund: For some of its securities lending clients, the Company invests the cash collateral received in the customer’s securities lending transactions in a short-term highly liquid commingled investment fund. The fund is rated AAA by Standard & Poor’s and started operation in 2003.

SFAS: Statement of Financial Accounting Standard.

Sub-custodian: A local provider (e.g., a bank) contracted by the Company to provide specific custodial related services in a selected country or geographic area. Services generally include holding foreign securities in safekeeping, facilitating settlements and reporting holdings to the custodian.

Tangible common equity (“TCE”) ratio: The percentage computed by dividing common shareholders’ equity less intangibles and goodwill by period end assets less intangibles and goodwill.

Unit investment trust (“UIT”): A sponsor-created portfolio of securities. Like mutual funds, these securities portfolios are designed to meet specific investment objectives. However, unlike a mutual fund, a UIT is an unmanaged portfolio consisting of securities that are fixed at the UIT’s initiation and generally remain unchanged over the security’s life.

Value at risk (“VAR”): A measure of the dollar amount of potential loss from adverse market moves in an everyday market environment.

 

70


Table of Contents

T HE BANK OF NEW YORK COMPANY, INC.

CONSOLIDATED BALANCE SHEETS

 

     December 31,  

(Dollars in millions, except per share amounts)

   2005     2004  

Assets

    

Cash and Due from Banks

   $ 3,515     $ 3,886  

Interest-Bearing Deposits in Banks

     8,644       8,192  

Securities

    

Held-to-Maturity (fair value of $1,951 in 2005 and $1,873 in 2004)

     1,977       1,886  

Available-for-Sale

     25,349       21,916  
                

Total Securities

     27,326       23,802  

Trading Assets

     5,930       4,627  

Federal Funds Sold and Securities Purchased Under Resale Agreements

     2,425       5,708  

Loans (less allowance for loan losses of $411 in 2005 and $591 in 2004)

     40,315       35,190  

Premises and Equipment

     1,060       1,097  

Due from Customers on Acceptances

     233       137  

Accrued Interest Receivable

     391       285  

Goodwill

     3,619       3,477  

Intangible Assets

     811       793  

Other Assets

     7,805       7,335  
                

Total Assets

   $ 102,074     $ 94,529  
                

Liabilities and Shareholders’ Equity

    

Deposits

    

Noninterest-Bearing (principally domestic offices)

   $ 18,236     $ 17,442  

Interest-Bearing

    

Domestic Offices

     19,522       18,692  

Foreign Offices

     26,666       22,587  
                

Total Deposits

     64,424       58,721  

Federal Funds Purchased and Securities Sold Under Repurchase Agreements

     834       1,205  

Trading Liabilities

     2,401       2,873  

Payables to Customers and Broker-Dealers

     8,623       8,664  

Other Borrowed Funds

     860       533  

Acceptances Outstanding

     235       139  

Accrued Taxes and Other Expenses

     4,124       4,452  

Accrued Interest Payable

     172       113  

Other Liabilities (including allowance for lending-related commitments of $154 in 2005 and $145 in 2004)

     2,708       2,418  

Long-Term Debt

     7,817       6,121  
                

Total Liabilities

     92,198       85,239  
                

Shareholders’ Equity

    

Common Stock-par value $7.50 per share, authorized 2,400,000,000 shares, issued 1,044,994,517 shares in 2005 and 1,041,495,972 shares in 2004

     7,838       7,811  

Additional Capital

     1,826       1,734  

Retained Earnings

     7,089       6,162  

Accumulated Other Comprehensive Income

     (134 )     (6 )
                
     16,619       15,701  

Less:    Treasury Stock (273,662,218 shares in 2005 and     263,374,998 shares in 2004), at cost

     6,736       6,411  

Loan to ESOP (203,507 shares in 2005), at cost

     7       —    
                

Total Shareholders’ Equity

     9,876       9,290  
                

Total Liabilities and Shareholders’ Equity

   $ 102,074     $ 94,529  
                

See accompanying Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements.

 

71


Table of Contents

THE BANK OF NEW YORK COMPANY, INC.

CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS OF INCOME

 

      For the years ended
December 31,
   Percent Inc/(Dec)  
(In millions, except per share amounts)    2005    2004    2003    2005 vs. 2004     2004 vs. 2003  

Interest Income

             

Loans

   $ 1,505    $ 1,080    $ 1,187    39 %   (9 )%

Margin Loans

     267      156      86    71     81  

Securities

             

Taxable

     976      741      651    32     14  

Exempt from Federal Income Taxes

     40      40      48    —       (17 )
                         
     1,016      781      699    30     12  

Deposits in Banks

     274      305      150    (10 )   103  

Federal Funds Sold and Securities

             

Purchased Under Resale Agreements

     142      80      79    78     1  

Trading Assets

     152      51      129    198     (60 )
                         

Total Interest Income

     3,356      2,453      2,330    37     5  
                         

Interest Expense

             

Deposits

     957      548      507    75     8  

Federal Funds Purchased and Securities Sold Under
Repurchase Agreements

     35      15      13    133     15  

Other Borrowed Funds

     58      52      21    12     148  

Customer Payables

     128      57      30    125     90  

Long-Term Debt

     269      136      150    98     (9 )
                         

Total Interest Expense

     1,447      808      721    79     12  
                         

Net Interest Income

     1,909      1,645      1,609    16     2  

Provision for Credit Losses

     15      15      155    —       (90 )
                         

Net Interest Income After Provision for Credit Losses

     1,894      1,630      1,454    16     12  
                         

Noninterest Income

             

Servicing Fees

             

Securities

     3,148      2,857      2,412    10     18  

Global Payment Services

     294      319      314    (8 )   2  
                         
     3,442      3,176      2,726    8     17  

Private Client Services and Asset Management Fees

     490      448      384    9     17  

Service Charges and Fees

     382      384      375    (1 )   2  

Foreign Exchange and Other Trading Activities

     391      364      327    7     11  

Securities Gains

     68      78      35    (13 )   123  

Other

     183      200      149    (9 )   34  
                         

Total Noninterest Income

     4,956      4,650      3,996    7     16  
                         

Noninterest Expense

             

Salaries and Employee Benefits

     2,549      2,324      2,002    10     16  

Net Occupancy

     323      305      261    6     17  

Furniture and Equipment

     208      204      185    2     10  

Clearing

     187      176      154    6     14  

Sub-custodian Expenses

     96      87      74    10     18  

Software

     215      193      170    11     14  

Communications

     95      93      92    2     1  

Amortization of Intangibles

     40      34      25    18     36  

Merger and Integration Costs

     —        —        96    —       —    

Other

     770      706      639    9     10  
                         

Total Noninterest Expense

     4,483      4,122      3,698    9     11  
                         

Income Before Income Taxes

     2,367      2,158      1,752    10     23  

Income Taxes

     796      718      595    11     21  
                         

Net Income

   $ 1,571    $ 1,440    $ 1,157    9     24  
                         

Per Common Share:

             

Basic Earnings

   $ 2.05    $ 1.87    $ 1.54    10     21  

Diluted Earnings

     2.03      1.85      1.52    10     22  

Cash Dividends Paid

     0.82      0.79      0.76    4     4  

Diluted Shares

     773      778      759    (1 )   3  

See accompanying Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements.

 

72


Table of Contents

THE BANK OF NEW YORK COMPANY, INC.

CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS OF CHANGES IN SHAREHOLDERS’ EQUITY

 

     For the years ended December 31,  
            2005           2004           2003  
(In millions)       

Common Stock

            

Balance, January 1

     $ 7,811       $ 7,794       $ 7,453  

Common Stock Issued in Connection with Pershing Acquisition (Shares: 40,000,000 in 2003)

       —           —           300  

Common Stock Issued in Connection with Employee Benefit Plans (shares: 3,498,545 in 2005 2,273,840 in 2004, and 5,524,835 in 2003)

       27         17         41  
                              

Balance, December 31

       7,838         7,811         7,794  
                              

Additional Capital

            

Balance, January 1

       1,734         1,635         847  

Common Stock Issued in Connection with Pershing Acquisition

       —           —           696  

Common Stock Issued in Connection with Employee Benefit Plans

       131         99         92  

Stock Rights Redemption

       (39 )       —           —    
                              

Balance, December 31

       1,826         1,734         1,635  
                              

Retained Earnings

Balance, January 1

       6,162         5,330         4,736  

Net Income

   $ 1,571       1,571     $ 1,440       1,440     $ 1,157       1,157  

Cash Dividends on Common Stock

       (644 )       (608 )       (563 )
                              

Balance, December 31

       7,089         6,162         5,330  
                              

Accumulated Other Comprehensive Income
    Balance, January 1

       (6 )       72         134  

Change in Fair Value of Securities Available-for-Sale, Net of Taxes of ($74) in 2005, ($49) in 2004, and ($68) in 2003

     (114 )     (114 )     (79 )     (79 )     (90 )     (90 )

Reclassification Adjustment, Net of Taxes of $7 in 2005, $1 in 2004, and $23 in 2003

     10       10       2       2       31       31  

Foreign Currency Translation Adjustment, Net of Taxes of ($4) in 2005, $4 in 2004, and ($13) in 2003

     (16 )     (16 )     5       5       (1 )     (1 )

Net Unrealized Derivative Loss on Cash Flow Hedges, Net of Taxes ($5) in 2005, $1 in 2004, and ($3) in 2003

     (5 )     (5 )     3       3       (2 )     (2 )

Minimum Pension Liability Adjustment, Net of Taxes of ($2) in 2005 and ($6) in 2004

     (3 )     (3 )     (9 )     (9 )     —         —    
                              

Balance, December 31

       (134 )       (6 )       72  
                                                

Total Comprehensive Income

   $ 1,443       $ 1,362       $ 1,095    
                              

Less Treasury Stock

Balance, January 1

       6,411         6,402         6,483  

Issued (shares: 3,341,804 in 2005, 4,529,465 in 2004, and 4,068,345 in 2003)

       (82 )       (110 )       (99 )

Acquired (shares: 13,629,024 in 2005, 4,000,986 in 2004, and 730,968 in 2003)

       407         119         18  
                              

Balance, December 31

       6,736         6,411         6,402  
                              

Less Loan to ESOP

Balance, January 1

       —           1         3  

Issued (shares: 305,261 in 2005)

       10          

Released (shares: 101,754 in 2005, 126,960 in 2004, and 358,573 in 2003)

       (3 )       (1 )       (2 )
                              

Balance, December 31

       7         —           1  
                              

Total Shareholders’ Equity, December 31

     $ 9,876       $ 9,290       $ 8,428  
                              

See accompanying Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements.

 

73


Table of Contents

THE BANK OF NEW YORK COMPANY, INC.

CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS OF CASH FLOWS

 

     For the years ended December 31,  
      2005     2004     2003  
(In millions)       

Operating Activities

      

Net Income

   $ 1,571     $ 1,440     $ 1,157  

Adjustments to Determine Net Cash Attributable to Operating Activities:

      

Provision for Credit Losses and Losses on Other Real Estate

     15       15       155  

Depreciation and Amortization

     526       480       430  

Deferred Income Taxes

     (55 )     383       488  

Securities (Gains) Losses

     (68 )     (78 )     (35 )

Change in Trading Activities

     (2,216 )     1,288       1,961  

Change in Accruals and Other, Net

     (885 )     (170 )     (341 )
                        

Net Cash Provided (Used) by Operating Activities

     (1,112 )     3,358       3,815  
                        

Investing Activities

      

Change in Interest-Bearing Deposits in Banks

     (946 )     (172 )     (2,689 )

Change in Margin Loans

     (30 )     (347 )     (973 )

Purchases of Securities Held-to-Maturity

     (544 )     (1,494 )     (27 )

Paydowns of Securities Held-to-Maturity

     373       217       706  

Maturities of Securities Held-to-Maturity

     70       19       10  

Purchases of Securities Available-for-Sale

     (17,969 )     (14,344 )     (28,034 )

Sales of Securities Available-for-Sale

     4,941       4,257       7,397  

Paydowns of Securities Available-for-Sale

     6,759       7,791       9,375  

Maturities of Securities Available-for-Sale

     2,437       2,448       5,812  

Net Principal Received (Disbursed) on Loans to Customers

     (5,819 )     514       1,367  

Sales of Loans and Other Real Estate

     263       21       953  

Change in Federal Funds Sold and Securities Purchased Under Resale Agreements

     3,283       (879 )     754  

Purchases of Premises and Equipment

     (131 )     (262 )     (129 )

Acquisitions, Net of Cash Acquired

     (265 )     (137 )     (1,844 )

Proceeds from the Sale of Premises and Equipment

     —         11       11  

Other, Net

     (44 )     112       805  
                        

Net Cash Provided (Used) by Investing Activities

     (7,622 )     (2,245 )     (6,506 )
                        

Financing Activities

      

Change in Deposits

     7,139       1,562       (201 )

Change in Federal Funds Purchased and Securities Sold Under Repurchase Agreements

     (371 )     166       (229 )

Change in Payables to Customers and Broker-Dealers

     (41 )     (1,528 )     1,702  

Change in Other Borrowed Funds

     366       (238 )     (814 )

Proceeds from the Issuance of Long-Term Debt

     2,033       209       2,276  

Repayments of Long-Term Debt

     (215 )     (476 )     (1,534 )

Issuance of Common Stock

     243       227       1,230  

Stock Rights Redemption

     (39 )     —         —    

Treasury Stock Acquired

     (417 )     (119 )     (18 )

Cash Dividends Paid

     (644 )     (608 )     (563 )
                        

Net Cash Provided (Used) by Financing Activities

     8,054       (805 )     1,849  
                        

Effect of Exchange Rate Changes on Cash

     309       (265 )     (63 )
                        

Change in Cash and Due From Banks

     (371 )     43       (905 )

Cash and Due from Banks at Beginning of Year

     3,886       3,843       4,748  
                        

Cash and Due from Banks at End of Year

   $ 3,515     $ 3,886     $ 3,843  
                        

Supplemental Disclosure of Cash Flow Information Cash Paid During the Year for:

      

Interest

   $ 1,389     $ 777     $ 739  

Income Taxes

     876       384       449  

Noncash Investing Activity (Primarily Foreclosure of Real Estate)

     —         1       —    

See accompanying Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements.

 

74


Table of Contents

THE BANK OF NEW YORK COMPANY, INC.

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

1. Summary of Significant Accounting and Reporting Policies

The Bank of New York Company, Inc. (the “Company”) provides a complete range of banking and other financial services to corporations and individuals worldwide through its business segments: Institutional Services, Private Bank and BNY Asset Management, Retail and Middle Market, and Corporate and Other. Segment Data and Foreign Operations are incorporated from the Business Segment Review section of Management’s Discussion and Analysis of the Company’s Financial Condition and Results of Operations. There were no major customers from whom revenues were individually material to the Company’s performance.

Use of Estimates

The preparation of financial statements in conformity with generally accepted accounting principles requires management to make estimates and assumptions that affect the reported amounts in the consolidated financial statements. Amounts subject to significant estimates and assumptions are items such as the allowance for loan losses and lending-related commitments, goodwill and intangibles, pension and post-retirement obligations, and the fair value of financial instruments. Actual results could differ from these estimates.

Consolidation

The consolidated financial statements include the accounts of the Company and its subsidiaries. Qualified special-purpose entities (QSPEs) are not consolidated. Revenue is recognized when earned based on contractual terms, or as transactions or services are provided. Revenue on interest-earning assets is recognized based on the effective yield of the financial instrument. All intercompany balances and transactions have been eliminated upon consolidation. The results of operations of businesses purchased are included from the date of acquisition. Equity investments of less than a majority but at least 20% ownership are accounted for by the equity method and classified as other assets. The Company’s most significant equity method investment is a 20.2% share in Wing Hang, with a carrying value of $215 million.

Securities

Debt and equity securities classified as available-for-sale are carried at fair value, except for those equity securities whose fair value cannot be readily determined. These securities are carried at cost. For securities carried at fair value, the after-tax effect of net unrealized gains and losses is reported as a separate component of shareholders’ equity.

Securities classified as trading assets are carried at fair value, with net unrealized holding gains and losses recognized currently in income. Debt securities, which the Company has the ability and intent to hold until maturity, are classified as held-to-maturity and stated at cost, adjusted for discount accreted and premium amortized. Realized gains and losses on the sale of debt and equity securities are determined by the specific identification and average cost methods, respectively.

The Company conducts quarterly reviews to identify and evaluate investments that have indications of possible impairment. An investment in a debt or equity security is impaired if its fair value falls below its cost and the decline is considered other-than-temporary. The Company examines various factors when determining whether an impairment is other-than-temporary. Examples of factors that may indicate that an other-than-temporary impairment has occurred include:

 

    Fair value is below cost;

 

    The decline in fair value has existed for an extended period of time;

 

75


Table of Contents

THE BANK OF NEW YORK COMPANY, INC.

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS—(Continued)

 

    Management does not possess both the intent and the ability to hold the investment for a period of time sufficient to allow for any anticipated recovery in fair value;

 

    The decline in fair value is attributable to specific adverse conditions affecting a particular investment;

 

    The decline in fair value is attributable to specific conditions, such as conditions in an industry or in a geographic area; and

 

    A debt security has been downgraded by a rating agency.

Allowance for Credit Losses

The allowance for credit losses is maintained at a level that, in management’s judgment, is adequate to absorb probable losses associated with specifically identified loans, as well as estimated probable credit losses inherent in the remainder of the loan portfolio at the balance sheet date. Management’s judgment includes the following factors, among others: risks of individual credits; past experience; the volume, composition, and growth of the loan portfolio; and economic conditions.

The Company conducts a quarterly portfolio review to determine the adequacy of its allowance for credit losses. All commercial exposures over $1 million are assigned to specific risk categories. Smaller commercial and consumer exposures are evaluated on a pooled basis and assigned to specific risk categories. Following this review, senior management of the Company analyzes the results and determines the allowance for credit losses. The Company’s Board of Directors reviews the allowance at the end of each quarter.

The portion of the allowance for credit losses allocated to impaired loans (nonaccrual commercial loans over $1 million) is measured by the difference between their recorded value and fair value. Fair value is determined by one of the following: present value of the expected future cash flows from borrowers, the market value of the loan, or the fair value of the collateral. See “Asset Quality and Allowance for Credit Losses” and “Critical Accounting Policies” in MD&A for additional information.

Nonperforming Assets

Commercial loans are placed on nonaccrual status when collateral is insufficient and principal or interest is past due 90 days or more, or when there is reasonable doubt that interest or principal will be collected. Accrued interest is usually reversed when a loan is placed on nonaccrual status. Interest payments received on nonaccrual loans may be recognized as income or applied to principal depending upon management’s judgment. Nonaccrual loans are restored to accrual status when principal and interest are current or they become fully collateralized. Consumer loans are not classified as nonperforming assets, but are charged off and interest accrued is suspended based upon an established delinquency schedule determined by product. Real estate acquired in satisfaction of loans is carried in other assets at the lower of the recorded investment in the property or fair value minus estimated costs to sell.

Leveraged Leases

Significant assumptions involving cash flows, residual values and income tax rates affect the level of revenue associated with leases. Gains and losses on residual values of leased equipment sold are included in other income. Considering the nature of these leases and the number of significant assumptions, there is risk associated with the income recognition on these leases should any of the assumptions change materially in future periods.

 

76


Table of Contents

THE BANK OF NEW YORK COMPANY, INC.

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS—(Continued)

 

Derivative Financial Instruments

Derivative contracts, such as futures contracts, forwards, interest rate swaps, foreign currency swaps and options and similar products used in trading activities, are recorded at fair value. The Company does not recognize gains or losses at the inception of derivative transactions if the fair value is not determined based upon observable market transactions and market data. Gains and losses are included in foreign exchange and other trading activities in non-interest income. Unrealized gains and losses are reported on a gross basis in trading account assets and trading liabilities, after taking into consideration master netting agreements.

The Company enters into various derivative financial instruments for non-trading purposes primarily as part of its asset/liability management (“ALM”) process. These derivatives are designated as fair value and cash flow hedges of certain assets and liabilities when the Company enters into the derivative contracts. Gains and losses associated with fair value hedges are recorded in income as well as any change in the value of the related hedged item. Gains and losses on cash flow hedges are recorded in other comprehensive income. If a derivative used in ALM does not qualify as a hedge it is marked to market and the gain or loss is included in net interest income.

The Company utilizes interest rate swap agreements to manage its exposure to interest rate fluctuations. Interest rate swaps are used to convert fixed rate loans, deposits and long-term debt to floating rates, and to hedge interest rate resets of variable rate cash flows. Basis swaps are used to convert various variable rate borrowings to LIBOR which better matches the assets funded by the borrowings. Cross-currency swaps are used to hedge exposure to exchange rate fluctuations on principal and interest payments for borrowings denominated in foreign currencies.

The Company formally documents all relationships between hedging instruments and hedged items, as well as its risk-management objective and strategy for undertaking various hedge transactions. This process includes linking all derivatives that are designated as fair-value hedges to specific assets or liabilities on the balance sheet. The Company also formally assesses (both at the hedge’s inception and on an ongoing basis) whether the derivatives that are used in hedging transactions have been highly effective in offsetting changes in the fair value of hedged items and whether those derivatives may be expected to remain highly effective in future periods. The Company will discontinue hedge accounting prospectively when it determines that the derivative is no longer an effective hedge, the derivative expires or is sold, or management discontinues the derivative’s hedge designation.

For the years ended December 31, 2005, 2004, and 2003, the Company recorded ineffectiveness of $1.1 million, zero and $(0.4) million related to fair value and cash flow hedges. Ineffectiveness is generally recorded in interest income or interest expense related to the hedged item. The Company recorded a debit of $5 million in 2005, a credit of $3 million in 2004, and a debit of $1 million in 2003 to other comprehensive income arising from the change in value of cash flow hedges.

The Company also utilizes foreign exchange forward contracts to manage currency exposure relating to its net investments in non-U.S. dollar functional currency operations. The change in fair market value of these contracts is deferred and reported within cumulative translation adjustments in shareholders’ equity, net of tax effects. Interest elements (forward points) on these foreign exchange forward contracts are recorded in other comprehensive income, net of tax effects.

The amounts recognized as other comprehensive income for cash flow hedges are reclassified to net interest income as interest is realized on the hedging derivative. Assuming interest rates remain stable, a minimal amount is expected to be reclassified to income over the next twelve months.

 

77


Table of Contents

THE BANK OF NEW YORK COMPANY, INC.

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS—(Continued)

 

Tax

The Company records current tax liabilities or assets through charges or credits to the current tax provision for the estimated taxes payable or refundable for the current year. Deferred tax assets and liabilities are recorded for future tax consequences attributable to differences between the financial statement carrying amounts of assets and liabilities and their respective tax bases. Deferred tax assets and liabilities are measured using enacted tax rates expected to apply to taxable income in the years in which those temporary differences are expected to be recovered or settled. A deferred tax valuation allowance is established if it is more likely than not that all or a portion of the deferred tax assets will not be realized.

Premises, Equipment, and Internal-Use Software

Premises and equipment are carried at cost less accumulated depreciation and amortization. Depreciation and amortization is computed using the straight-line method over the estimated useful life of the owned asset and, for leasehold improvements, over the lesser of the remaining term of the leased facility or the estimated economic life of the improvement. For owned and capitalized assets, estimated useful lives range from 3 to 50 years. Maintenance and repairs are charged to expense as incurred, while major improvements are capitalized and amortized to operating expense over their identified useful life. For internal-use computer software, the Company capitalizes qualifying costs incurred during the application development stage. The resulting asset is amortized using the straight-line method over the expected life, which is generally 5 years. All other costs incurred in connection with an internal-use software project are expensed as incurred.

Goodwill and other Intangible Assets

Goodwill represents the excess of the cost of an acquisition over the fair value of the net assets acquired. Other intangible assets represent purchased assets that also lack physical substance but can be distinguished from goodwill because of contractual or other legal rights or because the asset is capable of being sold or exchanged either on its own or in combination with a related contract, asset, or liability. Goodwill is tested at least annually for impairment. All other intangible assets which have finite useful lives are amortized over those periods, which range from 3 to 18 years.

Stock Options

On January 1, 2003, the Company adopted the fair value method of accounting for its options under SFAS 123 as amended by SFAS 148, “Accounting for Stock-Based Compensation- Transition and Disclosure.” SFAS 148 permits three different methods of adopting fair value: (1) the prospective method, (2) the modified prospective method, and (3) the retroactive restatement method. Under the prospective method, options issued after January 1, 2003 are expensed while all options granted prior to January 1, 2003 are accounted for under APB 25 using the intrinsic value method. Consistent with industry practice, the Company elected the prospective method of adopting fair value accounting. See footnote “Stock Option Plans” for more information regarding stock options.

 

78


Table of Contents

THE BANK OF NEW YORK COMPANY, INC.

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS—(Continued)

 

The retroactive restatement method requires the Company’s financial statements to be restated as if fair value accounting had been adopted in 1995. The following table discloses the pro forma effects on the Company’s net income and earnings per share as if the retroactive restatement method had been adopted.

 

(Dollars in millions, except per share amounts)

   2005      2004      2003  

Reported net income

   $ 1,571      $ 1,440      $ 1,157  

Stock based employee compensation costs, using prospective method, net of tax

     29        23        16  

Stock based employee compensation costs, using retroactive restatement method, net of tax

     (37 )      (57 )      (81 )
                          

Pro forma net income

   $ 1,563      $ 1,406      $ 1,092  
                          

Reported diluted earnings per share

   $ 2.03      $ 1.85      $ 1.52  

Impact on diluted earnings per share

     (0.01 )      (0.04 )      (0.07 )
                          

Pro forma diluted earnings per share

   $ 2.02      $ 1.81      $ 1.45  
                          

Pension

At September 30, the measurement date, plan assets were determined based on fair value generally representing observable market prices. The projected benefit obligation is determined based on the present value of projected benefit distributions at an assumed discount rate. The discount rate utilized is based on the yield of high quality corporate bonds available in the marketplace. Periodic pension expense includes service costs, interest costs based on an assumed discount rate, an expected return on plan assets based on an actuarially derived market-related value and amortization of actuarial gains and losses.

Actuarial gains and losses include the impact of plan amendments and various unrecognized gains and losses which are deferred and amortized over the future service periods of active employees. The market-related value utilized to determine the expected return on plan assets is based on fair value adjusted for the difference between expected returns and actual performance of plan assets. The unrealized difference between actual experience and expected returns is included in the market-related value over a five-year period. The Company’s stock price used by the ESOP is also smoothed to reduce volatility.

Any unrecognized gains or losses related to changes in the amount of the projected benefit obligation or plan assets resulting from experience different from the assumed discount rate or expected returns and from changes in assumptions are deferred. To the extent an unrecognized gain or loss, excluding the unrecognized asset gain or loss, exceeds 10 percent of the greater of the projected benefit obligation or the market-related value of plan assets, the excess is recognized over the future service periods of active employees.

2. Accounting Changes and New Accounting Pronouncements

On July 1, 2003, the Company adopted SFAS No. 149, “Amendment of Statement 133 on Derivative Instruments and Hedging Activities” (SFAS 149). SFAS 149 amends and clarifies accounting for derivative instruments. The adoption of SFAS 149 did not have an impact on the Company’s results of operations or financial condition.

On July 1, 2003, the Company adopted SFAS 150, “Accounting for Certain Financial Instruments with Characteristics of both Liabilities and Equity”. The provisions of SFAS 150 were effective for financial instruments entered into or modified after May 31, 2003, and otherwise were effective after June 30, 2003. The adoption of SFAS 150 did not have an impact on the Company’s results of operations or financial condition.

 

79


Table of Contents

THE BANK OF NEW YORK COMPANY, INC.

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS—(Continued)

 

On February 1, 2003, the Company adopted FASB Interpretation No. 46 (FIN 46), “Consolidation of Variable Interest Entities”. This interpretation requires a company that holds a variable interest in an entity to consolidate the entity if the company’s interest in the variable interest entities (VIE) is such that the company will absorb a majority of the VIE’s expected losses and/or receives a majority of the entity’s expected residual returns. The consolidation requirements of FIN 46 applied immediately to VIEs created after January 31, 2003. Various amendments to FIN 46, including FIN 46(R), delayed the effective date for certain previously established entities until the first quarter of 2004. The adoption of FIN 46 and FIN 46(R) did not have a significant impact on the Company’s results of operations or financial condition.

As of December 31, 2005, the Company had variable interests in 6 securitization trusts. These trusts are qualifying special-purpose entities, which are exempt from the consolidation requirements of FIN 46. See “Securitizations” note.

The most significant impact of FIN 46 and FIN 46(R) was to require that the trusts used to issue trust preferred securities be deconsolidated. As a result, the trust preferred securities no longer represent a minority interest. Under regulatory capital rules, minority interests count as Tier 1 Capital. The Company has $1,150 million of trust preferred securities outstanding. On March 1, 2005, the Board of Governors of the Federal Reserve System (the “FRB”) adopted a final rule that allows the continued limited inclusion of trust preferred securities in the Tier 1 capital of bank holding companies (BHCs). Under the final rule, the Company will be subject to a 15 percent limit in the amount of trust preferred securities that can be included in Tier 1 capital, net of goodwill, less any deferred tax liability. Amounts in excess of these limits will continue to be included in Tier 2 capital. The final rule provides a five-year transition period, ending March 31, 2009, for application of quantitative limits. Under the transition rules, the Company expects all its trust preferred securities to continue to qualify as Tier 1 capital. Both the Company and the Bank are expected to remain “well capitalized” under the final rule. At the end of the transition period, the Company expects all its current trust preferred securities will continue to qualify as Tier 1 capital.

In May 2004, FASB issued FASB Staff Position (FSP) No. 106-2, “Accounting and Disclosure Requirements Related to the Medicare Prescription Drug, Improvement and Modernization Act of 2003” (“FSP FAS 106-2”), which supersedes FSP FAS 106-1, in response to the December 2003 enactment of the Medicare Prescription Drug, Improvement and Modernization Act of 2003 (“the Act”). FSP FAS 106-2 provides guidance on the accounting for the effects of the Act for employers that sponsor postretirement health care plans that provide prescription drug benefits. The Company believes that its plans are eligible for the subsidy provided by the Act and adopted FSP FAS 106-2 in the third quarter of 2004 retroactive to January 1, 2004. The adoption of FSP FAS 106-2 did not have a significant impact on the Company’s results of operations or financial position.

In November 2005, the FASB issued FASB Staff Position (FSP) FAS 115-1 and FAS 124-1 “The Meaning of Other-Than-Temporary Impairment and Its Application to Certain Investments”. The FSP addresses the determination as to when an investment is considered impaired, whether that impairment is other than temporary, and the measurement of an impairment loss. The Company adopted the FSP on January 1, 2006. The Company does not expect the adoption of the standard will have a significant impact on its financial condition or results of operations.

In July 2005, the FASB issued an exposure draft, FSP FAS 13-a, revising the accounting guidance under SFAS 13 for leveraged leases. The exposure draft modifies existing interpretations of SFAS 13 and associated industry practice. As a result, if the revised FSP becomes effective by year-end 2006 the Company expects to recognize a material one-time after-tax charge to earnings or capital of $340 - $385 million related to a change in the timing of its lease cash flows. However, an amount approximating this one-time charge would be taken into income over the remaining term of the affected leases.

 

80


Table of Contents

THE BANK OF NEW YORK COMPANY, INC.

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS—(Continued)

 

In December 2004, the FASB issued FASB Statement No. 123 (revised 2004) (“SFAS 123(R)”), “Share-Based Payment”, which is a revision of FASB Statement No. 123, “Accounting for Stock-Based Compensation.” FASB 123(R) eliminates the ability to account for share-based compensation transactions using Accounting Principles Board Opinion No. 25 and requires that such transactions be accounted for using a fair value-based method. Statement 123(R) covers a wide range of share-based compensation arrangements including share options, restricted share plans, performance-based awards, share appreciation rights, and employee share purchase plans. The Company adopted SFAS 123(R) on January 1, 2006 using the “modified prospective” method. Under this method, compensation cost is recognized beginning with the effective date (a) based on the requirements of Statement 123(R) for all share-based payments granted after the effective date and (b) based on the requirements of Statement 123 for all awards granted to employees prior to the effective date of SFAS 123(R) that remain unvested on the effective date.

The Company adopted the fair value method of accounting for stock-based compensation prospectively as of January 1, 2003. As of January 1, 2006, the Company was amortizing all of its unvested stock option grants.

Certain of the Company’s stock compensation grants vest when the employee retires. SFAS 123(R) will require the completion of expensing of new grants with this feature by the first date the employee is eligible to retire. For grants prior to January 1, 2006, the Company will continue to expense them over their stated vesting period. The Company expects the adoption of FAS 123(R) to increase pre-tax expense in 2006 by $3 million due to the vesting on retirement feature.

In June 2005, the FASB ratified the consensus in EITF Issue No. 04-5, “Determining Whether a General Partner, or the General Partners as a Group, Controls a Limited Partnership or Similar Entity When the Limited Partners Have Certain Rights” (“EITF 04-5”), which provides guidance in determining whether a general partner controls a limited partnership. The adoption of EITF 04-5 did not have a significant impact on the Company’s financial condition or results of operation.

In July 2005, the FASB issued an Exposure Draft of a proposed Interpretation, “Accounting for Uncertain Tax Positions”. The proposed Interpretation clarifies the accounting for uncertain tax positions in accordance with FASB Statement No. 109, “Accounting for Income Taxes”. The proposed Interpretation requires that a tax position meet a “probable recognition threshold” for the benefit of the uncertain tax position to be recognized in the financial statements. A tax position that fails to meet the probable recognition threshold will result in either reduction of current or deferred tax asset or receivable, or recording a current or deferred tax liability. The proposed Interpretation also provides guidance on measurement, derecognition of tax benefits, classification, interim period accounting disclosure, and transition requirements in accounting for uncertain tax positions. A final standard is expected to be issued in 2006. The Company is assessing the impact of adopting the new pronouncement and is currently unable to estimate its impact on the Company’s consolidated financial statements.

The Company participates in unconsolidated investments that own real estate qualifying for low income housing tax credits based on Section 42 of the Internal Revenue Code. The Company’s share of operating losses generated by these investments is recorded as other income. The Company has historically netted the tax credits generated by these investments against the related operating losses. In the first quarter of 2005, the Company reviewed this accounting method and determined it was more appropriate to record these tax credits as a reduction of income tax expense. Prior period results for other income and income tax expense have been reclassified and did not have an impact on net income.

Certain other prior year information has been reclassified to conform its presentation to the 2005 financial statements.

 

81


Table of Contents

THE BANK OF NEW YORK COMPANY, INC.

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS—(Continued)

 

3. Acquisitions

The Company continues to be an active acquirer of securities servicing and asset management businesses. The Company frequently structures its acquisitions with both an initial payment and a later contingent payment tied to post-closing revenue or income growth. The Company records the fair value of contingent payments as an additional cost of the entity acquired in the period that the payment becomes probable.

At December 31, 2005, the Company was liable for potential contingent payments related to acquisitions in the amount of $195 million. During 2005, the Company paid or accrued $44 million for contingent payments related to acquisitions made in prior years, and $240 million of potential contingent payments lapsed.

2006

In January 2006, the Company acquired Alcentra Group Limited, an international asset management group focused on managing funds that invest in non-investment grade debt. Alcentra’s management team will retain a 20 percent interest. Alcentra has operations in London and Los Angeles and currently manages 15 different investment funds with over $6.2 billion of assets.

In January 2006, the Company announced a definitive agreement to acquire Urdang Capital Management, Inc., a real estate investment management firm that manages approximately $3.0 billion in direct investments and portfolios of REIT securities. The transaction is expected to close by the end of the first quarter, pending regulatory approval and other customary conditions of closing.

2005

During 2005, four businesses were acquired for a total cost of $188 million. Potential contingent payments related to 2005 acquisitions are $8 million. Goodwill and the tax-deductible portion of goodwill related to 2005 acquisitions transactions was $124 million. All of the goodwill was assigned to the Company’s Institutional Services segment. The pro forma effect of the 2005 acquisitions is not material to the 2005 results. The revenue impact is included in the “Business Segment Review”.

In January 2005, the Company acquired certain of the assets and liabilities of Standard & Poor’s Securities, Inc. (“SPSI”), the institutional brokerage subsidiary of Standard & Poor’s. The Company will assume SPSI’s client relationships and Standard & Poor’s research clients will have access to BNY Securities Group’s diverse set of execution management platforms and commission management services. The acquisition demonstrates the Company’s strategy to work with leading independent providers of research and other financial services.

In March 2005, the Company acquired the execution and commission management services of Boston Institutional Services (“BIS”). Under the terms of the agreement, the Company will assume BIS’s client relationships for its execution and commission management business.

In July 2005, the Company acquired Lynch, Jones & Ryan, Inc. (“LJR”), a subsidiary of Instinet Group. LJR is the pioneer and premier provider of commission recapture programs, with over 30 years experience in providing value-added trading services to institutional investors who comprise 1,400 plan sponsor funds, with more than $2.2 trillion in assets. The Company’s headquarters are in New York, with regional offices in Chicago, Dallas, and San Francisco and a presence in London, Tokyo and Sydney. The acquisition of LJR bolsters the Company’s position as a leading provider of agency brokerage and commission management services, and reinforces its long-standing commitment to the plan sponsor and institutional fund community around the world.

 

82


Table of Contents

THE BANK OF NEW YORK COMPANY, INC.

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS—(Continued)

 

In June 2005, the Company and Trust Company of Australia Ltd. (“Trust”) formed a joint venture that will provide securitization trustee and other agency-related services to Australian-based issuers of debt. The new company will combine Trust’s strong local infrastructure and market presence with the Company’s global experience and expertise to provide a wide range of trustee and agency services. The joint venture, based in Sydney, began operating in early June 2005. The joint venture presents the Company with a significant opportunity to expand its footprint in Australia and to capitalize on the sizeable growth potential in the securitization market across a variety of asset classes.

In July 2005, the Bank of New York and BHF-BANK established BHF BNY Securities Services GmbH as a jointly held subsidiary. Based in Frankfurt am Main, the new company will market Global Custody (Depotbank) services for German investment companies, and securities custody and settlement services for the national and international direct investments of institutional investors.

In July 2005, the Company acquired the bond administration business of Marshall & Ilsley Trust Company N.A., and M&I Marshall & Ilsley Bank, where they act as bond trustee, paying/fiscal agent, master trustee, transfer agent and/or registrar. The transaction involves the acquisition of approximately 560 bond trusteeships and agency appointments, representing $4.8 billion of principal debt outstanding for an estimated 225 clients.

In August 2005, the Company and Nordea, the leading financial services provider in the Nordic region, have entered into a strategic agreement to provide global custody and selected related services to Nordea’s institutional clients in the Nordic and Baltic Sea regions. The scope of the agreement involves approximately €240 billion of assets which represent about half of Nordea’s €500 billion assets under custody.

In August 2005, the Company announced a strategic arrangement with IL&FS Trust Company Limited (“ITCL”), a leading provider of trust and fiduciary services in India. The arrangement between the two organizations will provide Indian issuers with access to the Company’s global network, a comprehensive array of services to the international capital markets, and leading-edge technology capabilities. Under the arrangement, ITCL will perform corporate trust services in India, and the Company will provide offshore services.

In October 2005, the Company announced a marketing alliance with National Australia Bank (“National”). The arrangement will enable the Company to offer commission recapture services to National’s custody clients in Australia and New Zealand. The alliance continues the strategic international build-out of the Company’s transition management and commission recapture capabilities, which has included the opening of its Sydney, Australia office and acquisition of LJR.

2004

During 2004, nine businesses were acquired for a total cost of approximately $68 million, primarily paid in cash. Potential contingent payments related to 2004 acquisitions were $66 million. Goodwill related to 2004 acquisition transactions was $46 million. The tax-deductible portion of goodwill was $46 million. All of the goodwill was assigned to the Company’s Institutional Services segment.

In February 2004, the Company signed an agreement with Thomson Institutional Services Inc. (“TISI”), a unit of Thomason Financial, to transfer its commission services client base to Westminster Research Associates, Inc. (“WAR”), a subsidiary of The Bank of New York. In March 2004, the Company acquired software and other assets of Sonic Financial Technologies LLC, a leading provider of direct access electronic trading solutions.

 

83


Table of Contents

THE BANK OF NEW YORK COMPANY, INC.

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS—(Continued)

 

In May 2004, the Company made a strategic investment in London-based Netik, LLC. Late in the second quarter of 2004, the Company acquired a unit investment trust business that services approximately $20 billion in assets for over 4,200 different series of unit investment trusts.

In July 2004, the Company reached an agreement with National Australia Bank, following their strategic decision to close the National Custodian Services UK operation, to transfer its clients to The Bank of New York. In October 2004, the Company acquired Osprey Partners LLC’s portfolio accounting technology to broaden its managed account services offering. In November 2004, the Company acquired the execution and commission management assets of Wilshire Associates. In December 2004, the Company acquired Continental Fund Services (CFS), a Luxembourg PSF (Professional of the Financial Sector).

2003

During 2003, six businesses were acquired for a total cost of $2,126 million, primarily paid in cash. Potential contingent payments related to 2003 acquisitions were $56 million. Goodwill related to 2003 acquisition transactions was $716 million. The tax-deductible portion of goodwill was $709 million. The goodwill was primarily assigned to the Company’s Institutional Services segment.

The principal acquisition in 2003 was Credit Suisse First Boston’s Pershing unit, headquartered in Jersey City, New Jersey. Pershing is a leading global provider of correspondent clearing services and outsourcing solutions for broker-dealers, asset managers and other financial intermediaries. At acquisition, Pershing had approximately 3,700 employees worldwide at 13 locations in the U.S., Europe, and Asia.

The Company paid a purchase price of $2 billion in cash, with the premium to book value of $1.3 billion. The Company financed the purchase price through settlement of its forward sale of 40 million common shares in exchange for approximately $1 billion. The remainder of the purchase price was financed using long-term debt.

The acquisition was accounted for under the purchase method of accounting in accordance with SFAS 141, “Business Combinations.” The purchase price of $2 billion was allocated as follows: goodwill $0.6 billion, customer relationships $0.4 billion, trademarks $0.4 billion, and other tangible assets $0.6 billion. The results of Pershing are included in the accompanying statements of income after May 1, 2003.

The details of the other 2003 acquisitions are as follows:

 

    The back-office clearance and settlement capabilities of England-based Tilney Investment Management.

 

    International Fund Administration Ltd. (IFA), a Bermuda-based, alternative investment fund administrator.

 

    Capital Resource Financial Services, LLC (CRFS), a Chicago-based provider of commission recapture, transition management and third-party services to plan sponsors and investment managers.

 

    The corporate trust business of INTRUST Bank, N.A., headquartered in Wichita, Kansas.

 

    Fifth Third Bank’s corporate trust business located in Cincinnati, Ohio.

 

84


Table of Contents

THE BANK OF NEW YORK COMPANY, INC.

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS—(Continued)

 

4. Goodwill and Intangibles

Goodwill by reporting unit for the year ended December 31, 2005 and 2004 is as follows:

 

(In millions)

  

December 31,

2005

  

December 31,

2004

Institutional Services

   $ 3,121    $ 2,998

Private Bank & BNY Asset Management

     389      370

Retail & Middle Market Banking

     109      109

Corporate and Other

     —        —  
             

Consolidated Total

   $ 3,619    $ 3,477
             

The Company’s business segments are tested annually for goodwill impairment. No impairment loss was recorded in 2005 or 2004.

Intangible Assets

 

     December 31, 2005    December 31, 2004

(Dollars in millions)

  

Gross

Carrying

Amount

  

Accumulated

Amortization

   

Net

Carrying

Amount

  

Weighted

Average

Amortization

Period in Years

  

Gross

Carrying

Amount

  

Accumulated

Amortization

   

Net

Carrying

Amount

Trade Names

   $ 370    $ —       $ 370    Indefinite Life    $ 370    $ —       $ 370

Customer Relationships

     531      (99 )     432    16      474      (65 )     409

Other Intangible Assets

     28      (19 )     9    6      41      (27 )     14

The aggregate amortization expense of intangibles was $40 million, $34 million and $25 million for 2005, 2004, and 2003. Estimated amortization expense for the next five years is as follows:

 

     

For the year ended

December 31,

   Amortization
Expense
          (In millions)
   2006    $ 46
   2007      42
   2008      41
   2009      39
   2010      37

 

85


Table of Contents

THE BANK OF NEW YORK COMPANY, INC.

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS—(Continued)

 

5. Securities

The following table sets forth the amortized cost and the fair values of securities at the end of the last two years:

 

    2005   2004
   

Amortized

Cost

  Gross
Unrealized
 

Fair

Value

 

Amortized

Cost

  Gross
Unrealized
 

Fair

Value

(In millions)

    Gains   Losses       Gains   Losses  

Securities Held-to-Maturity:

               

US Government Obligations

  $ 48   $ 1   $ —     $ 49   $ 48   $ 1   $ —     $ 49

US Government Agency Obligations

    245     —       6     239     245     —       2     243

Obligations of States & Political Subdivisions

    105     —       1     104     30     —       —       30

Mortgage-Backed Securities

    1,451     3     24     1,430     1,432     5     7     1,430

Emerging Markets

    117     1     —       118     117     —       10     107

Other Debt Securities

    11     —       —       11     14     —       —       14
                                               

Total Securities Held-to-Maturity

    1,977     5     31     1,951     1,886     6     19     1,873
                                               

Securities Available-for-Sale:

               

US Government Obligations

    178     —       1     177     354     —       —       354

US Government Agency Obligations

    384     —       3     381     263     —       1     262

Obligations of States & Political Subdivisions

    115     5     —       120     157     9     —       166

Mortgage-Backed Securities

    21,162     50     159     21,053     17,915     109     61     17,963

Asset-Backed Securities

    307     —       2     305     —       —       —       —  

Equity Securities

    957     —       4     953     398     —       —       398

Other Debt Securities

    2,354     6     —       2,360     2,754     19     —       2,773
                                               

Total Securities Available-for-Sale

    25,457     61     169     25,349     21,841     137     62     21,916
                                               

Total Securities

  $ 27,434   $ 66   $ 200   $ 27,300   $ 23,727   $ 143   $ 81   $ 23,789
                                               

At December 31, 2005, almost all of the unrealized losses are attributable to changes in interest rates on investment grade securities. The Company has the ability and intent to hold these securities until their value recovers. The Company believes that all of its unrealized losses are temporary in nature.

 

86


Table of Contents

THE BANK OF NEW YORK COMPANY, INC.

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS—(Continued)

 

The following tables show the aggregate related fair value of investments with a continuous unrealized loss position for less than 12 months and those that have been in a continuous unrealized loss position for greater than twelve months.

December 31, 2005

 

     Less than 1 Year    1 Year or More    Total

(In millions)

   Market
Value
   Unrealized
Loss
   Market
Value
   Unrealized
Loss
   Market
Value
   Unrealized
Loss

Securities Held-to-Maturity

                 

U.S. Government Obligations

   $ —      $ —      $ —      $ —      $ —      $ —  

U.S. Government Agency Obligations

     98      2      141      4      239      6

Obligations of States &
Political Subdivisions

     104      1      —        —        104      1

Mortgage-Backed Securities

     646      9      591      15      1,237      24

Emerging Market

     —        —        —        —        —        —  

Equity Securities

     —        —        —        —        —        —  

Other Debt Securities

     —        —        —        —        —        —  
                                         

Total Securities Held-to-Maturity

     848      12      732      19      1,580      31
                                         

Securities Available-for-Sale

                 

U.S. Government Obligations

     —        —        74      1      74      1

U.S. Government Agency Obligations

     254      1      120      2      374      3

Obligations of States &
Political Subdivisions

     —        —        —        —        —        —  

Mortgage-Backed Securities

     8,916      74      5,431      85      14,347      159

Asset Backed Securities

     200      2      —        —        200      2

Emerging Markets

     —        —        —        —        —        —  

Equity Securities

     8      4      —        —        8      4

Other Debt Securities

     —        —        —        —        —        —  
                                         

Total Securities Available-for-Sale

     9,378      81      5,625      88      15,003      169
                                         

Total

   $ 10,226    $ 93    $ 6,357    $ 107    $ 16,583    $ 200
                                         

 

87


Table of Contents

THE BANK OF NEW YORK COMPANY, INC.

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS—(Continued)

 

December 31, 2004

 

     Less than 1 Year    1 Year or More    Total

(In millions)

   Market
Value
   Unrealized
Loss
   Market
Value
   Unrealized
Loss
   Market
Value
   Unrealized
Loss

Securities Held-to-Maturity

                 

U.S. Government Obligations

   $ —      $ —      $ —      $ —      $ —      $ —  

U.S. Government Agency Obligations

     118      2      —        —        118      2

Obligations of States & Political Subdivisions

     —        —        —        —        —        —  

Mortgage-Backed Securities

     1,046      7      —        —        1,046      7

Emerging Markets

     —        —        107      10      107      10

Equity Securities

     —        —        —        —        —        —  

Other Debt Securities

     —        —        —        —        —        —  
                                         

Total Securities Held-to-Maturity

     1,164      9      107      10      1,271      19
                                         

Securities Available-for-Sale

                 

U.S. Government Obligations

     —        —        —        —        —        —  

U.S. Government Agency Obligations

     230      1      —        —        230      1

Obligations of States & Political Subdivisions

     —        —        —        —        —        —  

Mortgage-Backed Securities

     9,869      52      585      9      10,454      61

Asset-Backed Securities

     —        —        —        —        —        —  

Emerging Markets

     —        —        —        —        —        —  

Equity Securities

     —        —        —        —        —        —  

Other Debt Securities

     —        —        —        —        —        —  
                                         

Total Securities Available-for-Sale

     10,099      53      585      9      10,684      62
                                         

Total

   $ 11,263    $ 62    $ 692    $ 19    $ 11,955    $ 81
                                         

The amortized cost and fair values of securities at December 31, 2005, by contractual maturity, are as follows:

 

     Held-to-Maturity    Available-for-Sale

(In millions)

   Amortized
Cost
   Fair
Value
   Amortized
Cost
   Fair
Value

Due in One Year or Less

   $ 112    $ 111    $ 2,206    $ 2,204

Due After One Year Through Five Years

     260      254      203      203

Due After Five Years Through Ten Years

     33      34      47      50

Due After Ten Years

     121      122      575      581

Mortgage-Backed Securities

     1,451      1,430      21,162      21,053

Asset-Backed Securities

     —        —        307      305

Equity Securities

     —        —        957      953
                           

Total

   $ 1,977    $ 1,951    $ 25,457    $ 25,349
                           

Realized gross gains on the sale of securities available-for-sale were $26 million in each of 2005 and 2004. There were $5 million of realized gross losses in 2005 and $21 million of realized gross losses in 2004.

 

88


Table of Contents

THE BANK OF NEW YORK COMPANY, INC.

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS—(Continued)

 

At December 31, 2005, assets amounting to $24.0 billion were pledged primarily for potential borrowing at the Federal Reserve Discount Window. The significant components of pledged assets were as follows: $20.2 billion were securities and $3.8 billion were loans. Included in these pledged assets was securities available-for-sale of $893 million which were pledged as collateral for actual borrowings. The lenders in these borrowings have the right to repledge or sell these securities. The Company obtains securities under resale, securities borrowed and custody agreements on terms which permit it to repledge or resell the securities to others. As of December 31, 2005, the market value of the securities received that can be sold or repledged was $20.2 billion. The Company routinely repledges or lends these securities to third parties. As of December 31, 2005, the market value of collateral repledged and sold was $295 million.

6. Loans

The Company’s loan distribution and industry concentrations of credit risk at December 31, 2005 and 2004 are incorporated by reference from “Loans” in the Management’s Discussion and Analysis Section of this report. The Company’s retail, community, and regional commercial banking operations in the New York metropolitan area create a significant geographic concentration.

In the ordinary course of business, the Company and its banking subsidiaries have made loans at prevailing interest rates and terms to directors and executive officers of the Company and to certain entities which these individuals are affiliated. The aggregate dollar amount of these loans was $244 million, $229 million, and $475 million at December 31, 2005, 2004, and 2003. These loans are primarily extensions of credit under revolving lines of credit established for the affiliated entities. During 2005, these loans averaged $260 million, and ranged from $222 million to $328 million. A total of $0.4 million of these loans was classified by the Company as nonperforming at year-end 2005.

The composition of the Company’s loan portfolio at December 31 is shown in the following table:

 

(In millions)

   2005     2004  

Commercial

   $ 7,727     $ 6,961  

Real Estate

     7,908       6,917  

Consumer Loans

     1,372       1,293  

Lease Financings

     5,525       5,663  

Banks and Other Financial Institutions

     6,080       5,262  

Loans for Purchasing or Carrying Securities

     4,935       3,028  

Margin Loans

     6,089       6,059  

Government and Official Institutions

     101       42  

Other

     989       556  

Less: Allowance for Loan Losses

     (411 )     (591 )
                

Total

   $ 40,315     $ 35,190  
                

 

89


Table of Contents

THE BANK OF NEW YORK COMPANY, INC.

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS—(Continued)

 

Transactions in the allowance for credit losses, which represents the allowance for loan losses plus the allowance for lending-related commitments are summarized as follows:

 

     2005  

(In millions)

  

Allowance for

Loan Losses

   

Allowance for

Lending-Related
Commitments

  

Allowance for

Credit Losses

 

Balance, Beginning of Period

   $ 591     $ 145    $ 736  

Charge-Offs

     (195 )     —        (195 )

Recoveries

     9       —        9  
                       

Net Charge-Offs

     (186 )     —        (186 )

Provision

     6       9      15  
                       

Balance, End of Period

   $ 411     $ 154    $ 565  
                       

 

     2004     2003  

(In millions)

  

Allowance for

Loan Losses

   

Allowance for

Lending-Related

Commitments

  

Allowance for

Credit Losses

   

Allowance for

Credit Losses

 

Balance, Beginning of Period

   $ 668     $ 136    $ 804     $ 831  

Charge-Offs

     (93 )     —        (93 )     (198 )

Recoveries

     10       —        10       16  
                               

Net Charge-Offs

     (83 )     —        (83 )     (182 )

Provision

     6       9      15       155  
                               

Balance, End of Period

   $ 591     $ 145    $ 736     $ 804  
                               

The table below sets forth information about the Company’s nonperforming assets and impaired loans at December 31:

 

(In millions)

       2005            2004            2003    

Domestic Nonperforming Loans

   $ 52    $ 185    $ 270

Foreign Nonperforming Loans

     14      28      79
                    

Total Nonperforming Loans

     66      213      349

Other Assets Owned

     13      1      —  
                    

Total Nonperforming Assets

   $ 79    $ 214    $ 349
                    

Impaired Loans with an Allowance

   $ 42    $ 128    $ 287

Impaired Loans without an Allowance(1)

     —        65      41
                    

Total Impaired Loans

   $ 42    $ 193    $ 328
                    

Allowance for Impaired Loans(2)

   $ 16    $ 52    $ 106

Average Balance of Impaired Loans during the Year

     137      297      394

Interest Income Recognized on Impaired Loans during the Year

     5      6      2

(1) When the discounted cash flows, collateral value or market price equals or exceeds the carrying value of the loan, then the loan does not require an allowance under the accounting standard related to impaired loans.
(2) The allowance for impaired loans is included in the Company’s allowance for loan losses.

 

90


Table of Contents

THE BANK OF NEW YORK COMPANY, INC.

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS—(Continued)

 

Lost Interest

 

(In millions)

       2005            2004            2003    

Amount by which interest income recognized on
nonperforming loans exceeded reversals:

        

Total

   $ 1    $ 4    $ 1

Foreign

     —        —        —  

Amount by which interest income would have increased if nonperforming loans at year-end had been performing for the entire year:

        

Total

     3      5      12

Foreign

     —        1      1

At December 31, 2005, commitments to borrowers whose loans were classified as nonaccrual or reduced rate were not material. The Company uses the discounted cash flow method as its primary method for valuing its impaired loans.

7. Long-Term Debt

The following is a summary of the contractual maturity of long-term debt at December 31, 2005 and totals for 2004:

 

     2005    2004

(In millions)

   Under
5 Years
   After 5 Years
Through
10 Years
   After
10 Years
   Total    Total

Senior Debt

              

Fixed Rate

   $ 1,665    $ 412    $ —      $ 2,077    $ 1,436

Floating Rate

     1,049      600      31      1,680      1,190

Subordinated Debt(1)

     273      1,516      1,087      2,876      2,309

Junior Subordinated Debt(1)

     —        —        1,184      1,184      1,186
                                  

Total

   $ 2,987    $ 2,528    $ 2,302    $ 7,817    $ 6,121
                                  

(1) Fixed rate

The Company has $493 million of debt maturing in 2006. At December 31, 2005, subordinated debt aggregating $838 million is redeemable at the option of the Company as follows: $229 million in 2006; $119 million in 2007; $490 million after 2007. The Company has $250 million of subordinated debt that is fixed at 4.25% until 2007 when it becomes variable. The Company has the option to call this debt at that time. The Company has $400 million of subordinated debt that is fixed at 3.40% until 2008 when it becomes variable. The Company has the option to call this debt at that time.

 

Weighted Average Interest Rates

       2005             2004      

Fixed Rate Senior Debt

   4.12 %   3.88 %

Floating Rate Senior Debt

   4.37     2.37  

Fixed Rate Subordinated Debt

   5.44     5.31  

Preferred Trust Securities

   7.12     7.12  

Range of Fixed Interest Rates at December 31, 2005

    
     From     To  

Senior Debt

   2.20 %   5.20 %

Subordinated Debt

   3.40     7.40  

Junior Subordinated Debt

   5.95     7.97  

 

91


Table of Contents

THE BANK OF NEW YORK COMPANY, INC.

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS—(Continued)

 

Exposure to interest rate movements is reduced by interest rate swap agreements. As a result of these agreements, the effective interest rates differ from those stated.

Wholly owned subsidiaries of the Company (the “Trusts”) have issued cumulative Company-Obligated Mandatory Redeemable Trust Preferred Securities of Subsidiary Trust Holding Solely Junior Subordinated Debentures (“Preferred Trust Securities”). The sole assets of each trust are junior subordinated deferrable interest debentures of the Company, whose maturities and interest rates match the Preferred Trust Securities. The Company’s obligations under the agreements that relate to the Preferred Trust Securities, the Trusts and the debentures constitute a full and unconditional guarantee by the Company of the Trusts’ obligations under the Preferred Trust Securities.

The following table sets forth a summary of the Junior Subordinated Debt issued by the Company as of December 31, 2005:

Preferred Trust Securities

 

(Dollars in millions)

   Amount    Interest
Rate
    Assets
of Trust(1)
   Due
Date
   Call
Date
   Call
Price
 

BNY Institutional Capital Trust A

   $ 300    7.78 %   $ 309    2026    2006    103.89 %

BNY Capital I

     300    7.97       309    2026    2006    103.99  

BNY Capital IV

     200    6.88       206    2028    2004    Par  

BNY Capital V

     350    5.95       362    2033    2008    Par  
                        
   $ 1,150      $ 1,186         
                        

(1) Junior Subordinated Debt

The Company has the option to shorten the maturity of BNY Capital IV to 2013 or extend the maturity to 2047.

8. Securitizations

The Company provides services to 6 QSPEs as of December 31, 2005. All of the Company’s securitizations are QSPEs as defined in SFAS 140, which by design are passive investment vehicles. Total rate of return swaps entered into in connection with the securitization transactions are recorded in the trading account at fair value with the gain or loss included in net income.

Asset-Backed Commercial Paper Securitization

Since 2000, the Company sells and distributes securities for an asset backed commercial paper securitization program. The Company services the program and receives a market-based fee of approximately five basis points that is just adequate to compensate the Company for its servicing responsibilities. As a result, there is no servicing asset or liability.

The Company provides liquidity and credit enhancement to the commercial paper securitization program through total rate of return swaps. The swaps are constructed to allow reset dates to occur at the maturity of any beneficial interest issued to fund an asset purchase. To the extent there is a liquidity issue impacting the paying ability of the underlying assets or if the underlying assets undergo a credit default, the swaps ensure the timely payments to the beneficial interest holder. Under the terms of the swaps, the Company pays the funding cost of the program plus the expenses and receives the return on the assets.

 

92


Table of Contents

THE BANK OF NEW YORK COMPANY, INC.

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS—(Continued)

 

The $50 million of program assets at December 31, 2005 consist of securities that are 100% rated Aa2. The authorized size of the program is $5 billion. The Company has not recognized any gain on the sale of assets to this program due to the short time period between the origination or purchase of the transferred assets and their sale to the program. The purpose of the securitization is to hold highly rated low-risk medium-term customer obligations in a capital efficient manner.

Money Fund Securitization

In 2000, the Company purchased BNY Hamilton Money Fund shares with a market value of $400 million. The Company then sold the right to receive the principal value of the shares in 2021 in a securitization transaction and retained the rights to receive on-going dividends from the shares. The Company did not recognize a gain on the sale. The purpose of this securitization is to achieve a favorable after-tax risk-adjusted investment return. The Company sponsors the BNY Hamilton Money Fund and receives an administrative fee for servicing the fund. The Company hedged a portion of the interest rate risk of the transaction by entering into a $200 million interest rate swap with a third party. The retained interest is recorded in available-for-sale securities in the consolidated balance sheet.

Municipal Bond Securitizations

The Company also sponsored $71 million of municipal bond securitizations for which no gain was recognized. The municipal bonds that were transferred were weekly variable rate demand bonds that are designed to trade at par. Therefore, the book value of the bonds was equal to par and they were sold at par, resulting in no gain or loss on sale. All of the bonds in the program are credit enhanced by a third party letter of credit provider rated at least A3/BBB. The Company provides additional liquidity and credit enhancement through total rate of return swaps, letters of credit, and/or, standby bond purchase agreements. The program’s purpose is to achieve a favorable after-tax risk-adjusted investment return.

Impact of Programs

The impact of these securitizations on the Company’s fully diluted earnings per share is less than 1 cent. Furthermore, if these transactions were consolidated on the balance sheet, there would have been virtually no impact on the Company’s liquidity, and the Tier 1 and Total Capital ratios at December 31, 2005 would have been 8.36% and 12.46%, respectively vs. 8.38% and 12.48% as reported.

9. Shareholders’ Equity

The Company has 5 million authorized shares of Class A preferred stock having a par value of $2.00 per share. At December 31, 2005 and 2004, 3,000 shares were outstanding.

In addition to the Class A preferred stock, the Company has 5 million authorized shares of preferred stock having no par value, with no shares outstanding at December 31, 2005 and 2004, respectively.

In February 2005, the Company’s board of directors voted unanimously to terminate the Company’s Rights Plan and to impose conditions on its ability to adopt a shareholder rights plan in the future.

Each share of the Company’s common stock represented one right under the Rights Plan. On March 25, 2005, the Company paid 5 cents per right to redeem them.

 

93


Table of Contents

THE BANK OF NEW YORK COMPANY, INC.

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS—(Continued)

 

The Company has reserved the right of its Board, by a majority vote of its independent directors in their exercise of their fiduciary duties, to determine in light of the circumstances then existing if it would be in the best interest of the Company and its shareholders to adopt a new shareholder rights plan without prior shareholder approval. If a shareholder rights plan is adopted by the Board without prior shareholder approval, the plan must provide that it will expire within 12 months from its effective date unless ratified by the Company’s shareholders.

At December 31, 2005, the Company had reserved for issuance approximately 76 million common shares pursuant to the terms of employee benefit plans.

Basic and diluted earnings per share are calculated as follows:

 

(In millions, except per share amounts)

   2005    2004    2003

Net Income(1)

   $ 1,571    $ 1,440    $ 1,157

Basic Weighted Average Shares Outstanding

     765      772      752

Shares Issuable upon Conversion:

        

Employee Stock Options

     8      6      7
                    

Diluted Weighted Average Shares Outstanding

     773      778      759
                    

Basic Earnings per Share

   $ 2.05    $ 1.87    $ 1.54

Diluted Earnings per Share

   $ 2.03    $ 1.85    $ 1.52

(1) Net income, net income available to common shareholders and diluted net income are the same for all years presented.

10. Stock Option Plans

The Company’s stock option plans (“the Option Plans”) provide for the issuance of stock options at fair market value at the date of grant to officers and employees of the Company and its subsidiaries. At December 31, 2005, under the Option Plans, the Company may issue 31,504,480 new options. In addition, the Company may reissue any options cancelled under its 1999 and 2003 Long-Term Incentive Plans. Generally, each option granted under the Option Plans is exercisable between one and ten years from the date of grant.

The compensation cost that has been charged against income was $49 million, $39 million, and $24 million for 2005, 2004 and 2003, respectively. The total income tax benefit recognized in the income statement was $20 million, $16 million, and $10 million for 2005, 2004 and 2003, respectively.

In 2005, the Company switched to a lattice-based binomial method to calculate the fair value on the date of grant. In 2004 and 2003 the Company used a Black-Scholes model. The fair value of each option award is estimated on the date of grant using the following weighted-average assumptions noted in the following table.

 

         2005             2004             2003      

Dividend yield

   2.6 %   2.5 %   3.0 %

Expected volatility

   24     25     31  

Risk free interest rate

   4.17     2.61     2.82  

Expected option lives

   5     5     5  

For 2005 assumptions were determined as follows:

 

    Expected volatilities are based on implied volatilities from traded options on the Company’s stock, historical volatility of the Company’s stock, and other factors.

 

94


Table of Contents

THE BANK OF NEW YORK COMPANY, INC.

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS—(Continued)

 

    The Company uses historical data to estimate option exercise and employee termination within the valuation model.

 

    The risk-free rate for periods within the contractual life of the option is based on the U.S. Treasury yield curve at the time of grant.

 

    The expected term of options granted is derived from the output of the option valuation model and represents the period of time that options granted are expected to be outstanding.

A summary of the status of the Company’s Option Plans as of December 31, 2005, 2004, and 2003, and changes during the years ending on those dates is presented below:

 

     2005    2004    2003

Options

   Shares     Weighted
Average
Exercise
Price
   Shares     Weighted
Average
Exercise
Price
   Shares     Weighted
Average
Exercise
Price

Outstanding at
Beginning of Year

     68,809,804     $ 34.89      66,185,011     $ 34.44      51,425,347     $ 37.52

Granted

     6,249,675       30.37      7,215,950       33.06      18,041,155       23.12

Exercised

     (3,370,085 )     18.22      (2,614,568 )     17.08      (1,949,374 )     10.24

Canceled

     (2,226,170 )     38.45      (1,976,589 )     36.39      (1,332,117 )     34.98
                                

Outstanding at End of Year

     69,463,224       35.18      68,809,804       34.89      66,185,011       34.44
                                

Options Exercisable
at End of Year

     54,918,181       36.79      47,337,115       37.49      36,444,541       36.47

Weighted Average Fair Value of Options At Grate Date

   $ 6.13        $ 6.24        $ 4.84    

Aggregate Intrinsic Value (In millions)

    —Outstanding at 12/31

     189          270          307    

    —Exercisable at 12/31

     144          152          131    

The following table summarizes information about stock options outstanding at December 31, 2005:

 

     Options Outstanding    Options Exercisable

Range of

Exercise Prices

  

Number

Outstanding at

12/31/05

  

Weighted Average

Remaining

Contractual Life

  

Weighted Average

Exercise Price

  

Number

Exercisable at

12/31/05

  

Weighted Average

Exercise Price

$  11 to 20

   2,453,781    0.9 Years    $ 16.75    2,453,781    $ 16.75

    20 to 26

   14,125,165    7.1                23.09    10,013,339      23.07

    26 to 31

   10,528,998    6.3                29.19    4,348,880      27.53

    31 to 43

   31,512,180    5.5                38.16    27,259,081      38.95

    43 to 57

   10,843,100    5.2                52.26    10,843,100      52.26
                  

$    7 to 57

   69,463,224    5.7                35.18    54,918,181      36.79
                  

The total intrinsic value of options exercised during the years ended December 31, 2005, 2004 and 2003 was $31 million, $27 million, and $25 million.

As of December 31, 2005, there was $49 million of total unrecognized compensation cost related to nonvested shares granted under the Option Plans. The unrecognized compensation cost is expected to be recognized over a weighted-average period of 1.7 years.

 

95


Table of Contents

THE BANK OF NEW YORK COMPANY, INC.

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS—(Continued)

 

Cash received from option exercise under the option plans for the years ended December 31, 2005, 2004, and 2003, was $61 million, $45 million, and $20 million, respectively. The actual tax benefit realized for the tax deductions from option exercised totaled $11 million, $9 million, and $9 million, respectively, for the years ended December 31, 2005, 2004, and 2003.

11. Income Taxes

Income taxes included in the consolidated statements of income consist of the following:

 

     2005    2004    2003

(In millions)

   Current    Deferred     Total    Current    Deferred     Total    Current     Deferred    Total

Federal

   $ 574    $ (96 )   $ 478    $ 183    $ 400     $ 583    $ 6     $ 377    $ 383

Foreign

     198      —         198      112      —         112      104       —        104

State and Local

     79      41       120      40      (17 )     23      (3 )     111      108
                                                                 

Income Taxes

   $ 851    $ (55 )   $ 796    $ 335    $ 383     $ 718    $ 107     $ 488    $ 595
                                                                 

The components of income before taxes are as follows:

 

(In millions)

   2005    2004    2003

Domestic

   $ 2,101    $ 2,043    $ 1,629

Foreign

     266      115      123
                    

Income Before Taxes

   $ 2,367    $ 2,158    $ 1,752
                    

The Company’s net deferred tax liability (included in accrued taxes) at December 31 consisted of the following:

 

(In millions)

   2005      2004      2003  

Lease Financings

   $ 3,255      $ 3,427      $ 3,196  

Depreciation and Amortization

     549        441        394  

Pension

     373        382        382  

Discount on Money Market Investment

     121        126        125  

Securities Valuation

     31        105        125  

Credit Losses on Loans

     (304 )      (299 )      (334 )

Tax Credit Carryovers

     (390 )      (375 )      (248 )

NOL Carryover

     (285 )      (140 )      (15 )

Liabilities not Deducted for Tax

     (119 )      (111 )      (133 )

Other Assets

     (236 )      (268 )      (311 )

Other Liabilities

     66        99        69  
                          

Net Deferred Tax Liability

   $ 3,061      $ 3,387      $ 3,250  
                          

The Company has recorded foreign tax credit carryovers of $223 million, a portion of which will begin to expire in 2012, general business credit carryovers of $107 million which begin to expire in 2023, and a $60 million AMT carryover which does not expire. The Company has Federal and State NOL carryovers of $736 million (for which it has recorded a $285 million tax benefit) related to a separate filing of a group of certain leasing subsidiaries which begin to expire in 2023. In addition, the Company has elected to permanently reinvest the earnings of certain foreign subsidiaries in accordance with APB 23. The related unrecognized deferred tax liability is $10 million. The Company has not recorded a valuation allowance because it expects to realize all of its deferred tax assets including these carryovers.

 

96


Table of Contents

THE BANK OF NEW YORK COMPANY, INC.

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS—(Continued)

 

The statutory federal income tax rate is reconciled to the Company’s effective income tax rate below:

 

         2005             2004             2003      

Federal Rate

   35.0 %   35.0 %   35.0 %

State and Local Income Taxes, Net of Federal Income Tax Benefit

   3.3     0.7     3.9  

Nondeductible Expenses

   0.4     0.4     0.2  

Credit for Synthetic Fuel Investments

   (2.1 )   (0.9 )   (0.8 )

Credit for Low-Income Housing Investments

   (1.5 )   (1.9 )   (0.8 )

Tax-Exempt Income from Municipal Securities

   (0.1 )   (0.2 )   (0.3 )

Other Tax-Exempt Income

   (1.1 )   (1.2 )   (1.5 )

Foreign Operations

   (0.3 )   0.2     (0.1 )

Leveraged Lease Portfolio

   (0.2 )   (0.5 )   (0.3 )

Tax Reserve—LILO Exposure

   0.4     2.3     —    

Other—Net

   (0.2 )   (0.6 )   (1.3 )
                  

Effective Rate

   33.6 %   33.3 %   34.0 %
                  

 

97


Table of Contents

THE BANK OF NEW YORK COMPANY, INC.

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS—(Continued)

 

12. Employee Benefit Plans

The Company has defined benefit and contribution retirement plans covering substantially all full-time and eligible part-time employees and also provides health care benefits for certain retired employees. The Company uses September 30 as the measurement date for plan assets and obligations.

Defined Benefit Plans

The following table provides a reconciliation of the changes in the benefit obligation, fair value of plan assets, and funded status for 2005 and 2004:

 

     Pension Benefits     Healthcare Benefits  
     Domestic     Foreign     Domestic     Foreign  

(In millions)

   2005     2004     2005     2004     2005     2004     2005  

Change in Benefit Obligation

              

Obligation at Beginning of Period

   $ (969 )   $ (826 )   $ (159 )   $ (133 )   $ (153 )   $ (170 )   $ (6 )

Plan Amendments

     114       —         —         —         —         —         —    

Service Cost

     (64 )     (47 )     (9 )     (9 )     —         (1 )     —    

Interest Cost

     (55 )     (50 )     (9 )     (9 )     (9 )     (8 )     (1 )

Employee Contributions

     —         —         (1 )     (1 )     —         —         —    

Actuarial Gain/(Loss)

     (30 )     (91 )     (44 )     (10 )     (37 )     13       (1 )

Benefits Paid

     41       45       4       3       14       13       —    
                                                        

Obligation at End of Period

     (963 )     (969 )     (218 )     (159 )     (185 )     (153 )     (8 )
                                                        

Change in Plan Assets

              

Fair Value at Beginning of Period

     1,240       1,171       142       96       62       59       —    

Actual Return on Plan Assets

     132       109       23       10       3       3       —    

Employer Contributions

     2       6       53       37       —         —         —    

Employee Contributions

     —         —         1       1       —         —         —    

Benefit Payments

     (41 )     (46 )     (4 )     (2 )     —         —         —    
                                                        

Fair Value at End of Period

     1,333       1,240       215       142       65       62       —    
                                                        

Funded Status

     370       271       (3 )     (17 )     (120 )     (91 )     (8 )

Unrecognized Net Transition (Asset) Obligation

     —         —         —         —         38       44       —    

Unrecognized Prior Service Cost

     (113 )     2       —         —         —         —         —    

Unrecognized Net (Gain)/Loss

     587       586       73       43       95       58       —    

Additional Liability

     —         —         (2 )     (2 )     —         —         —    
                                                        

Prepaid Benefit Cost

   $ 844     $ 859     $ 68     $ 24     $ 13     $ 11     $ (8 )
                                                        

Unrecognized actuarial gains and losses are amortized over the future service period (11 years) of active employees if they exceed a threshold amount. The Company currently has unrecognized losses which are being amortized.

Amounts recognized in the Company’s balance sheet at September 30, 2005 and 2004 consist of:

 

     Pension Benefits     Healthcare Benefits  
     Domestic     Foreign     Domestic    Foreign  

(In millions)

     2005         2004         2005         2004         2005        2004        2005    

Prepaid Benefit Cost

   $ 903     $ 905     $ 77     $ 32     $ 13    $ 11    $ —    

Accrued Benefit Cost

     (59 )     (46 )     (9 )     (8 )     —        —        (8 )
                                                      
   $ 844     $ 859     $ 68     $ 24     $ 13    $ 11    $ (8 )
                                                      

 

98


Table of Contents

THE BANK OF NEW YORK COMPANY, INC.

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS—(Continued)

 

The accumulated benefit obligation for all defined benefit plans was $1,080 million at September 30, 2005 and $964 million at September 30, 2004.

The following table contains information for pension plans with an accumulated benefit obligation in excess of plan assets at December 31:

 

(In millions)

   Domestic    Foreign
     2005        2004        2005        2004  

Projected Benefit Obligation

   $ 61    $ 58    $ 13    $ 10

Accumulated Benefit Obligation

     59      46      11      8

Fair Value of Plan Assets

     —        —        1      1

Net Periodic Benefit Cost

Net periodic benefit cost included the following components:

 

     Pension Benefits     Healthcare Benefits
     Domestic     Foreign     Domestic     Foreign

(In millions)

   2005     2004     2003     2005     2004     2003     2005     2004     2003     2005

Net Periodic Cost (Income):

                    

Service Cost

   $ 64     $ 47     $ 39     $ 9     $ 9     $ 4     $ —       $ 1     $ 1     $ —  

Interest Cost

     55       50       44       9       9       5       9       8       10       1

Expected Return on Asset

     (120 )     (132 )     (132 )     (11 )     (11 )     (2 )     (5 )     (6 )     (6 )     —  

Other

     18       4       3       2       —         —         8       7       7       —  
                                                                              

Net Periodic Cost (Income)

   $ 17     $ (31 )   $ (46 )   $ 9     $ 7     $ 7     $ 12     $ 10     $ 12     $ 1
                                                                              

Plan Assumptions

 

     Pension Benefits     Healthcare Benefits  
     Domestic     Foreign     Domestic     Foreign  

(Dollars in millions)

   2005     2004     2005     2004     2005     2004     2005  

Market-Related Value of
Plan Assets at Beginning Period

   $ 1,502     $ 1,523     $ 215     $ 142     $ 70     $ 71     N/A  

Discount Rate

     5.88 %     6.00 %     4.90 %     5.50 %     5.88 %     6.00 %   5.00 %

Expected Rate of Return on Plan Assets

     7.88       8.25       6.70       7.10       7.25       7.25     N/A  

Rate of Compensation Increase

     3.75       3.75       4.20       4.20        

The Company’s expected long-term rate of return on plan assets is based on anticipated returns for each asset class. Anticipated returns are weighted for the target allocation for each asset class. Anticipated returns are based on forecasts for prospective returns in the equity and fixed income markets, which should track the long-term historical returns for these markets. The Company also considers the growth outlook for U.S. and global economies, as well as current and prospective interest rates.

For additional information on pension assumptions see “Critical Accounting Policies” in MD&A.

Assumed Healthcare Cost Trend

Domestic Healthcare Benefits

The assumed health care cost trend rate used in determining benefit expense for 2005 is 10.5% decreasing to 5.0% in 2013. This projection is based on various economic models that forecast a decreasing growth rate of

 

99


Table of Contents

THE BANK OF NEW YORK COMPANY, INC.

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS—(Continued)

 

health care expenses overtime. The underlying assumption is that health care expense growth cannot outpace gross national product (“GNP”) growth indefinitely, and over time a lower equilibrium growth rate will be achieved. Further, the growth rate assumed in 2013 bears a reasonable relationship to the discount rate.

An increase in the health care cost trend rate of one percentage point for each year would increase the post-retirement benefit obligation by $15.7 million, or 8.4%, and the sum of the service and interest costs by $1.0 million, or 10.8%. Conversely, a decrease in this rate of one percentage point for each year would decrease the benefit obligation by $13.5 million, or 7.3%, and the sum of the service and interest costs by $0.8 million, or 9.3%.

Foreign Healthcare Benefits

An increase in the health care cost trend rate of one percentage point for each year would increase the post-retirement benefit obligation by $2 million, or 25%, and the sum of the service and interest costs by $0.2 million, or 27%. Conversely, a decrease in this rate of one percentage point for each year would decrease the benefit obligation by $1.6 million, or 19%, and the sum of the service and interest costs by $0.1 million, or 20%.

Investment Strategy and Asset Allocation

The Company’s investment objective for its U.S. and foreign plans is to maximize total return while maintaining a broadly diversified plan. Equities are the main holding including the Company’s common stock as well as private equities. The Company has committed to fund additional private equities, which, when the commitments are drawn upon, will bring the Company’s actual allocation for private equities closer to its target of 5%. Alternative investments and fixed income securities provide diversification and lower the volatility of returns.

The Company’s pension assets were invested as follows at September 30:

 

     Actual Allocation     Target Allocation  
     2005     2004     Domestic     Foreign  
     Domestic     Foreign     Domestic     Foreign      

Equities

   69 %   60 %   66 %   61 %   60 %   60 %

Fixed Income

   22     40     24     38     30     40  

Alternative Investment

   5     —       5     —       5     —    

Private Equities

   2     —       1     —       5     —    

Cash

   2     —       4     1     —       —    
                                    

Total Plan Assets

   100 %   100 %   100 %   100 %   100 %   100 %
                                    

Included in the domestic plan assets above were 4.2 million shares of the Company’s common stock with a fair value of $125 million and $124 million on September 30, 2005 and 2004, respectively, representing 9% of 2005 plan assets and 10% of 2004 plan assets. Assets of the postretirement health care plan are invested in an insurance contract.

Expected Contributions for the Fiscal Year Ending December 31, 2005

The Company estimates that the contributions it will make in 2006 to fund its pension plans will be $19 million for the domestic plans and $9 million for the foreign plans.

 

100


Table of Contents

THE BANK OF NEW YORK COMPANY, INC.

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS—(Continued)

 

Estimated Future Benefit Payments

The following table shows the expected future benefit payments for the next 10 years:

 

(In millions)    Pension Benefits    Healthcare Benefits

Year

   Domestic    Foreign    Domestic    Foreign

2006

   $ 104    $ 3    $ 18    $ —  

2007

     96      3      17      —  

2008

     99      5      18      —  

2009

     107      5      18      —  

2010

     111      6      18      —  

2011-2015

     634      41      75      1
                           
   $ 1,151    $ 63    $ 164    $ 1
                           

Defined Contribution Plans

The Company has an Employee Stock Ownership Plan (“ESOP”) covering certain domestic full-time employees with more than one year of service. The ESOP works in conjunction with the Company’s defined benefit pension plan. Employees are entitled to the higher of their benefit under the ESOP or the defined benefit pension plan. If the benefit under the pension plan is higher, the employee’s share of the ESOP is contributed to the pension plan. Contributions are made equal to required principal and interest payments on borrowings by the ESOP. At September 30, 2005 and 2004, the ESOP owned 11 million shares of the Company’s stock. The fair value of total ESOP assets were $326 million and $324 million at September 30, 2005 and 2004. Contributions were approximately $2.1 million in 2005, $0.2 million in 2004 and $1.9 million in 2003. ESOP related expense was $2 million, $3 million and $10 million in 2005, 2004 and 2003.

The Company has defined contribution plans, excluding the ESOP, for which it recognized a cost of $67 million in 2005, $65 million in 2004, and $48 million in 2003.

13. Company Financial Information

The Bank of New York (the “Bank”), the Company’s primary banking subsidiary, is subject to dividend limitations under the Federal Reserve Act and state banking laws. Under these statutes, prior regulatory approval is required for dividends in any year that would exceed the Bank’s net profits for such year combined with retained net profits for the prior two years. The Bank is also prohibited from paying a dividend in excess of undivided profits.

Under the first and more significant of these limitations, the Bank could declare dividends of approximately $278 million in 2006 plus net profits earned in the remainder of 2006.

The Federal Reserve Board can also prohibit a dividend if payment would constitute an unsafe or unsound banking practice. The Federal Reserve Board generally considers that a bank’s dividends should not exceed earnings from continuing operations.

The Company’s capital ratios and discussion of related regulatory requirements are incorporated by reference from the “Capital Resources” section of Management’s Discussion & Analysis.

The Federal Reserve Act limits and requires collateral for extensions of credit by the Company’s insured subsidiary banks to the Company and certain of its non-bank affiliates. Also, there are restrictions on the amounts

 

101


Table of Contents

THE BANK OF NEW YORK COMPANY, INC.

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS—(Continued)

 

of investments by such banks in stock and other securities of the Company and such affiliates, and restrictions on the acceptance of their securities as collateral for loans by such banks. Extensions of credit by the banks to each of the Company and such affiliates are limited to 10% of such bank’s regulatory capital, and in the aggregate for the Company and all such affiliates to 20%, and collateral must be between 100% and 130% of the amount of the credit, depending on the type of collateral.

The insured subsidiary banks of the Company are required to maintain reserve balances with Federal Reserve Banks under the Federal Reserve Act and Regulation D. Required balances averaged $119 million and $188 million for the years 2005 and 2004.

The Company’s condensed financial statements are as follows:

Balance Sheets

 

     December 31,
(In millions)    2005    2004

Assets

     

Cash and Due from Banks

   $ 791    $ 1,195

Securities

     18      3

Loans

     91      33

Investment in and Advances to Subsidiaries and Associated Companies

     

Banks

     10,846      11,444

Other

     8,395      5,182
             
     19,241      16,626

Other Assets

     170      270
             

Total Assets

   $ 20,311    $ 18,127
             

Liabilities and Shareholders’ Equity

     

Other Borrowed Funds

   $ 85    $ 253

Due to Non-Bank Subsidiaries

     2,723      2,487

Due to Bank Subsidiaries

     —        —  

Other Liabilities

     383      317

Long-Term Debt

     7,244      5,780
             

Total Liabilities

     10,435      8,837
             

Shareholders’ Equity*

     

Preferred

     —        —  

Common

     9,876      9,290
             

Total Liabilities and Shareholders’ Equity

   $ 20,311    $ 18,127
             

* See Consolidated Statements of Changes in Shareholders’ Equity.

 

102


Table of Contents

THE BANK OF NEW YORK COMPANY, INC.

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS—(Continued)

 

Statements of Income

 

      For the years ended December 31,  
(In millions)    2005     2004     2003  

Operating Income

      

Dividends from Subsidiaries

      

Banks

   $ 862     $ 1,189     $ 188  

Other

     108       73       230  

Interest from Subsidiaries

      

Banks

     104       154       149  

Other

     142       81       81  

Other

     24       23       21  
                        

Total

     1,240       1,520       669  
                        

Operating Expenses

      

Interest (including $81 in 2005, $34 in 2004, and $19 in 2003 to Subsidiaries)

     340       169       172  

Other

     63       5       22  
                        

Total

     403       174       194  
                        

Income Before Income Taxes and
Equity in Undistributed Earnings of Subsidiaries

     837       1,346       475  

Income Tax Expense/(Benefit)

     (58 )     29       (16 )
                        

Income Before Equity in Undistributed Earnings of Subsidiaries

     895       1,317       491  
                        

Equity in Undistributed Earnings of Subsidiaries

      

Banks

     411       (15 )     780  

Other

     265       138       (114 )
                        

Total

     676       123       666  
                        

Net Income

   $ 1,571     $ 1,440     $ 1,157  
                        

 

103


Table of Contents

THE BANK OF NEW YORK COMPANY, INC.

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS—(Continued)

 

Statements of Cash Flows

 

     For the years ended December 31,  
(In millions)    2005     2004     2003  

Operating Activities

  

Net Income

   $ 1,571     $ 1,440     $ 1,157  

Adjustments to Determine Net Cash Attributable to Operating Activities:

      

Amortization

     30       15       15  

Equity in Undistributed Earnings of Subsidiaries

     (676 )     (123 )     (666 )

Change in Interest Payable

     25       5       2  

Change in Taxes Payable

     23       (53 )     (73 )

Other, Net

     (7 )     58       (108 )
                        

Net Cash Provided by Operating Activities

     966       1,342       327  
                        

Investing Activities

      

Purchases of Securities

     (18 )     (3 )     (49 )

Sales of Securities

     —         3       —    

Maturities of Securities

     —         —         49  

Change in Loans

     (61 )     9       (11 )

Acquisition of, Investment in, and Advances to Subsidiaries

     (2,093 )     (232 )     (1,737 )

Other, Net

     15       4       10  
                        

Net Cash Used by Investing Activities

     (2,157 )     (219 )     (1,738 )
                        

Financing Activities

      

Change in Other Borrowed Funds

     (168 )     180       (63 )

Proceeds from the Issuance of Long-Term Debt

     1,778       209       1,916  

Repayments of Long-Term Debt

     (202 )     (476 )     (1,234 )

Change in Advances from Subsidiaries

     236       225       179  

Issuance of Common Stock

     243       227       1,230  

Treasury Stock Acquired

     (417 )     (119 )     (18 )

Cash Dividends Paid

     (644 )     (608 )     (563 )

Stock Rights Redemption

     (39 )     —         —    
                        

Net Cash Provided (Used) by Financing Activities

     787       (362 )     1,447  
                        

Change in Cash and Due from Banks

     (404 )     761       36  

Cash and Due from Banks at Beginning of Year

     1,195       434       398  
                        

Cash and Due from Banks at End of Year

   $ 791     $ 1,195     $ 434  
                        

Supplemental Disclosure of Cash Flow Information

Cash Paid During the Year for:

      

Interest

   $ 314     $ 168     $ 236  

Income Taxes

     658       96       186  

 

104


Table of Contents

THE BANK OF NEW YORK COMPANY, INC.

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS—(Continued)

 

14. Other Noninterest Income and Expense

In 2004, other noninterest income included a pre-tax gain of $48 million from the sale of a portion of the Company’s investment in Wing Hang Bank Limited. In 2003, other noninterest income included $32 million of insurance recoveries. This was offset by an equal amount of expenses related to the WTC disaster in 2003.

Other noninterest income includes equity in earnings of unconsolidated subsidiaries of $44 million, $43 million, and $34 million in 2005, 2004, and 2003.

15. Fair Value of Financial Instruments

The carrying amounts of the Company’s financial instruments (i.e., monetary assets and liabilities) are determined under different accounting methods - see “Summary of Significant Accounting and Reporting Policies” in the Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements. The following disclosure discusses these instruments on a uniform basis - fair value. However, active markets do not exist for a significant portion of these instruments, principally loans and commitments. As a result, fair value determinations require significant subjective judgments regarding future cash flows. Other judgments would result in different fair values. Among the assumptions used by the Company are discount rates ranging principally from 4% to 7% at December 31, 2005 and 2% to 6% at December 31, 2004. The fair value information supplements the basic financial statements and other traditional financial data presented throughout this report.

A summary of the practices used for determining fair value is as follows.

Securities, Trading Activities, and Derivatives Used for ALM

The fair value of securities and trading assets and liabilities is based on quoted market prices, dealer quotes, or pricing models. Fair value amounts for derivative instruments, such as options, futures and forward rate contracts, commitments to purchase and sell foreign exchange, and foreign currency swaps, are similarly determined. The fair value of interest rate swaps is the amount that would be received or paid to terminate the agreement.

Loans and Commitments

For certain categories of consumer loans, fair value includes consideration of the quoted market prices for securities backed by similar loans. Discounted future cash flows and secondary market values are used to determine the fair value of other types of loans. The fair value of commitments to extend credit, standby letters of credit, and commercial letters of credit is based upon the cost to settle the commitment.

Other Financial Assets

Fair value is assumed to equal carrying value for these assets due to their short maturity.

Deposits, Borrowings, and Long-Term Debt

The fair value of noninterest-bearing deposits is assumed to be their carrying amount. The fair value of interest-bearing deposits, borrowings, and long-term debt is based upon current rates for instruments of the same remaining maturity or quoted market prices for the same or similar issues.

 

105


Table of Contents

THE BANK OF NEW YORK COMPANY, INC.

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS—(Continued)

 

The carrying amount and estimated fair value of the Company’s financial instruments are as follows:

 

     December 31,
      2005    2004
(In millions)    Carrying
Amount
   Fair
Value
   Carrying
Amount
   Fair
Value

Assets

           

Securities

   $ 28,134    $ 28,352    $ 24,730    $ 24,945

Trading Assets

     5,930      5,930      4,627      4,627

Loans and Commitments

     34,780      34,884      29,523      29,952

Derivatives Used for ALM

     116      180      192      242

Other Financial Assets

     15,738      15,738      18,745      18,745
                           

Total Financial Assets

     84,698    $ 85,084      77,817    $ 78,511
                   

Non-Financial Assets

     17,376         16,712   
                   

Total Assets

   $ 102,074       $ 94,529   
                   

Liabilities

           

Noninterest-Bearing Deposits

   $ 18,236    $ 18,236    $ 17,442    $ 17,442

Interest-Bearing Deposits

     46,188      46,188      41,279      41,280

Payables to Customers and Broker-Dealers

     8,623      8,623      8,664      8,664

Borrowings

     1,741      1,741      1,769      1,769

Long-Term Debt

     7,817      7,820      6,121      6,307

Trading Liabilities

     2,401      2,401      2,873      2,873

Derivatives Used for ALM

     125      101      83      70
                           

Total Financial Liabilities

     85,131    $ 85,110      78,231    $ 78,405
                   

Non-Financial Liabilities

     7,067         7,008   
                   

Total Liabilities

   $ 92,198       $ 85,239   
                   

The table below summarizes the carrying amount of the hedged financial instruments and the related notional amount of the hedge and estimated fair value (unrealized gain/(loss)) of the derivatives that were linked to these items:

 

     Carrying
Amount
   Notional
Amount
   Unrealized  

(In millions)

         Gain    (Loss)  

At December 31, 2005

           

Loans

   $ 581    $ 579    $ 6    $ (10 )

Securities Held-for-Sale

     514      434      42      (8 )

Deposits

     1,232      1,238      7      —    

Long-Term Debt

     5,068      5,102      125      (83 )

At December 31, 2004

           

Loans

   $ 292    $ 280    $ —      $ (13 )

Securities Held-for-Sale

     750      714      45      (23 )

Deposits

     173      175      —        (1 )

Long-Term Debt

     4,183      4,082      197      (33 )

 

106


Table of Contents

THE BANK OF NEW YORK COMPANY, INC.

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS—(Continued)

 

The following table illustrates the notional amount, remaining contracts outstanding, and weighted average rates for derivative hedging contracts:

 

    

Total(2)

12/31/05

    Remaining Contracts Outstanding at December 31,  

(Dollars in millions)

     2006     2007     2008     2009     2010  

Receive Fixed Interest Rate Swaps:

            

Notional Amount

   $ 6,540     $ 5,201     $ 4,391     $ 3,856     $ 3,373     $ 3,391  

Weighted Average Rate

     5.31 %     5.60 %     5.83 %     6.13 %     6.18 %     6.18 %

Pay Fixed Interest Rate Swaps:

            

Notional Amount

   $ 488     $ 400     $ 375     $ 331     $ 259     $ 208  

Weighted Average Rate

     6.05 %     6.31 %     6.30 %     6.33 %     6.43 %     6.35 %

Forward LIBOR Rate(1)

     4.53 %     4.78 %     4.72 %     4.78 %     4.86 %     4.84 %

(1) The forward LIBOR rate shown above reflects the implied forward yield curve for that index at December 31, 2005. However, actual repricings for ALM interest rate swaps are generally based on 3-month LIBOR.
(2) In addition, the Company has $325 million of foreign exchange contracts that expire in 2006.

The Company’s financial assets and liabilities are primarily variable rate instruments except for investment securities. Fixed rate loans and deposits are issued to satisfy customer and investor needs. Derivative financial instruments are utilized to manage exposure to the effect of interest rate changes on fixed rate assets and liabilities, and to enhance liquidity. The Company matches the duration of derivatives to that of the assets and liabilities being hedged, so that changes in fair value resulting from changes in interest rates will be offset.

The Company uses interest rate swaps, futures contracts, and forward rate agreements to convert fixed rate loans, deposits, and long-term debt to floating rates. Basis swaps are used to convert various variable rate borrowings to LIBOR which better matches the assets funded by the borrowings.

The Company uses forward foreign exchange contracts to protect the value of its investments in foreign subsidiaries. The after-tax effects are shown in the cumulative translation adjustment included in shareholders’ equity. At December 31, 2005 and 2004, foreign exchange contracts in a net notional amount of $1,636 million and $1,449 million with fair values of $24 million and $(32) million, hedged corresponding amounts of foreign investments. These foreign exchange contracts had a maturity of less than six months at December 31, 2005. In 2005, the Company hedged its $33 million net investment in an affiliate with a non-derivative financial instrument. In addition, at December 31, 2005, foreign exchange contracts with notional amounts of $89 million and maturities of less than one year hedged corresponding amounts of foreign currency denominated forecasted transactions; the fair value of these contracts was $(2) million.

Deferred net gains or losses on ALM derivative financial instruments at December 31, 2005 and 2004 were $9 million credit and a $12 million credit, respectively.

Net interest income increased by $86 million in 2005, $147 million in 2004, and $142 million in 2003 as a result of ALM derivative financial instruments.

A discussion of the credit, market, and liquidity risks inherent in financial instruments is presented under “Liquidity”, “Market Risk Management”, “Trading Activities and Risk Management”, and “Asset/Liability

 

107


Table of Contents

THE BANK OF NEW YORK COMPANY, INC.

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS—(Continued)

 

Management” in the unaudited MD&A section of this report and in the “Trading Activities” and “Commitments and Contingent Liabilities” Notes to the Consolidated Financial Statements.

16. Trading Activities

The following table shows the fair value of the Company’s financial instruments that are held for trading purposes:

 

     2005    2004
(In millions)    Assets    Liabilities    Assets    Liabilities

Trading Account

   12/31    Average    12/31    Average    12/31    Average    12/31    Average

Interest Rate Contracts:

                       

Futures and Forward Contracts

   $ —      $ —      $ —      $ —      $ —      $ 27    $ —      $ —  

Swaps

     1,438      1,635      635      843      1,787      1,493      741      425

Written Options

     —        —        1,184      1,253      —        —        1,322      1,269

Purchased Options

     191      187      —        —        175      161      —        —  

Foreign Exchange Contracts:

                       

Written Options

     —        —        51      64      —        —        33      41

Purchased Options

     68      113      —        —        117      81      —        —  

Commitments to Purchase and Sell Foreign Exchange

     294      385      316      399      533      478      586      517

Debt Securities

     3,846      3,512      164      171      1,894      2,076      76      96

Credit Derivatives

     1      1      6      7      2      2      6      8

Equities

     92      174      45      129      119      167      109      123
                                                       

Total Trading Account

   $ 5,930    $ 6,007    $ 2,401    $ 2,866    $ 4,627    $ 4,485    $ 2,873    $ 2,479
                                                       

 

108


Table of Contents

THE BANK OF NEW YORK COMPANY, INC.

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS—(Continued)

 

Foreign exchange and other trading income included the following:

 

(In millions)

       2005             2004            2003      

Foreign Exchange

   $ 274     $ 255    $ 193  

Interest Rate Contracts

     25       6      41  

Debt Securities

     68       66      74  

Credit Derivatives

     (2 )     2      (7 )

Equities

     26       35      26  
                       

Total

   $ 391     $ 364    $ 327  
                       

Foreign exchange includes income from purchasing and selling foreign exchange, futures, and options. Interest rate contracts reflect results from futures and forward contracts, interest rate swaps, foreign currency swaps, and options. Debt and other securities primarily reflect income from debt securities. Credit derivatives include revenue from credit default swaps. Equities include income from equity securities and equity derivatives.

The following table of total daily revenue or loss captures trading volatility and shows the number of days in which the Company’s trading revenues fell within particular ranges during the past year.

Distribution of Revenues*

 

     For the Quarter Ended
(Dollars in millions)        12/31/05            9/30/05            6/30/05            3/31/05            12/31/04    

Revenue Range

   Number of Occurrences

Less than $(2.5)

   0    0    0    0    0

$(2.5)~ $ 0

   3    3    6    1    6

$    0  ~ $ 2.5

   44    51    40    50    49

$ 2.5  ~ $ 5.0

   14    8    16    11    8

More than $5.0

   0    2    2    0    0

* Based on revenues before share with joint venture partner, Susquehanna Trading.

17. Commitments and Contingent Liabilities

In the normal course of business, various commitments and contingent liabilities are outstanding which are not reflected in the accompanying consolidated balance sheets. Management does not expect any material losses to result from these matters.

The Company’s significant trading and off-balance-sheet risks are securities, foreign currency and interest rate risk management products, commercial lending commitments, letters of credit, and securities lending indemnifications. The Company assumes these risks to reduce interest rate and foreign currency risks, to provide customers with the ability to meet credit and liquidity needs, to hedge foreign currency and interest rate risks, and to trade for its own account. These items involve, to varying degrees, credit, foreign exchange, and interest rate risk not recognized in the balance sheet. The Company’s off-balance-sheet risks are managed and monitored in manners similar to those used for on-balance-sheet risks. There are no significant industry concentrations of such risks.

 

109


Table of Contents

THE BANK OF NEW YORK COMPANY, INC.

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS—(Continued)

 

A summary of the notional amount of the Company’s off-balance-sheet credit transactions, net of participations, at December 31, 2005 and 2004 follows:

Off-Balance-Sheet Credit Risks

 

(In millions)

   2005    2004

Lending Commitments

   $ 36,954    $ 36,755

Standby Letters of Credit

     10,383      9,507

Commercial Letters of Credit

     1,189      1,264

Securities Lending Indemnifications

     310,970      232,025

The total potential loss on undrawn commitments, standby and commercial letters of credit, and securities lending indemnifications is equal to the total notional amount if drawn upon, which does not consider the value of any collateral. Since many of the commitments are expected to expire without being drawn upon, the amount does not necessarily represent future cash requirements. The allowance for lending-related commitments at December 31, 2005 and 2004 was $154 million and $145 million.

A securities lending transaction is a fully collateralized transaction in which the owner of a security agrees to lend the security through an agent (the Company) to a borrower, usually a broker/dealer or bank, on an open, overnight or term basis, under the terms of a prearranged contract, which generally matures in less than 90 days. The Company generally lends securities with indemnification against broker default. The Company generally requires the borrower to provide 102% cash collateral which is monitored on a daily basis, thus reducing credit risk. Security lending transactions are generally entered into only with highly-rated counterparties. At December 31, 2005 and 2004, securities lending indemnifications were secured by collateral of $317.4 billion and $233.0 billion.

Standby letters of credit principally support corporate obligations and include $0.9 billion and $0.5 billion that were collateralized with cash and securities at December 31, 2005 and 2004. At December 31, 2005, approximately $6.6 billion of the standbys will expire within one year, and the balance between one to five years.

The notional amounts for other off-balance-sheet risks express the dollar volume of the transactions; however, credit risk is much smaller. The Company performs credit reviews and enters into netting agreements to minimize the credit risk of foreign currency and interest rate risk management products. The Company enters into offsetting positions to reduce exposure to foreign exchange and interest rate risk.

At December 31, 2005, approximately $218 billion of interest rate contracts will mature within one year, $352 billion between one and five years, and the balance after five years. At December 31, 2005, approximately $91 billion of foreign exchange contracts will mature within one year and $3 billion between one and five years. Derivative financial instruments with a carrying value of $3 million were on nonperforming status at year-end 2005.

Use of derivative financial instruments involves reliance on counterparties. Failure of a counterparty to honor its obligation under a derivative contract is a risk the Company assumes whenever it engages in a derivative contract.

 

110


Table of Contents

THE BANK OF NEW YORK COMPANY, INC.

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS—(Continued)

 

A summary of the notional amount and credit exposure of the Company’s derivative financial instruments at December 31, 2005 and 2004 follows:

 

     Notional Amount    Credit Exposure  

(In millions)

   2005    2004    2005     2004  

Interest Rate Contracts:

          

Futures and Forward Contracts

   $ 40,163    $ 36,603    $ 5     $ —    

Swaps

     256,750      232,523      3,907       4,615  

Written Options

     218,997      171,949      8       9  

Purchased Options

     179,964      124,833      837       1,077  

Foreign Exchange Contracts:

          

Swaps

     3,130      3,808      156       245  

Written Options

     6,042      6,698      1       —    

Purchased Options

     7,723      9,430      100       164  

Commitments to Purchase and Sell Foreign Exchange

     77,640      73,914      648       957  

Equity Derivatives:

          

Futures and Forwards

     339      70      2       —    

Written Options

     2,073      1,205      14       1  

Purchased Options

     2,011      1,117      97       35  

Credit Derivatives:

          

Beneficiary

     1,099      1,184      —         —    

Guarantor

     370      440      —         2  
                      
           5,775       7,105  

Effect of Master Netting Agreements

           (4,843 )     (5,390 )
                      

Total Credit Exposure

         $ 932     $ 1,715  
                      

Operating Leases

Net rent expense for premises and equipment was $219 million in 2005, $199 million in 2004, and $154 million in 2003.

At December 31, 2005 and 2004, the Company was obligated under various noncancelable lease agreements, some of which provide for additional rents based upon real estate taxes, insurance, and maintenance and for various renewal options. The minimum rental commitments under noncancelable operating leases for premises and equipment having a term of more than one year from December 31, 2005 and December 31, 2004 are as follows:

 

(In millions)     

Year After December 31,

   2005    2004

First

   $ 183    $ 171

Second

     172      165

Third

     134      127

Fourth

     104      107

Fifth

     92      92

Thereafter

     472      485
             

Total Minimum Lease Payments

   $ 1,157    $ 1,147
             

 

111


Table of Contents

THE BANK OF NEW YORK COMPANY, INC.

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS—(Continued)

 

Other

The Company has provided standard representations for underwriting agreements, acquisition and divestiture agreements, sales of loans and commitments, and other similar types of arrangements and customary indemnification for claims and legal proceedings related to its provision of financial services. Insurance has been purchased to mitigate certain of these risks. The Company is a minority equity investor in, and member of, several industry clearing or settlement exchanges through which foreign exchange, securities or other transactions settle. Certain of these industry clearing or settlement exchanges require their members to guarantee their obligations and liabilities or to provide financial support in the event other partners do not honor their obligations. It is not possible to estimate a maximum potential amount of payments that could be required with such agreements.

In the ordinary course of business, the Company makes certain investments that have tax consequences. From time to time, the IRS may question or challenge the tax position taken by the Company. The Company engaged in certain types of structured cross-border leveraged leasing investments, referred to as “LILOs”, prior to mid-1999 that the IRS has challenged. In 2004, the IRS proposed adjustments to the Company’s tax treatment of these transactions. As previously disclosed, beginning in the fourth quarter of 2004, the Company had several appellate conferences with the IRS in an attempt to settle the proposed adjustments related to these LILO transactions.

On February 28, 2006, the Company settled this matter with the IRS relating to LILO transactions closed in 1996 and 1997. The settlement will not affect first quarter 2006 net income, as the impact of the settlement was fully reserved.

The Company’s 1998 leveraged lease transactions are in a subsequent audit cycle and were not part of the settlement. The Company believes that a comparable settlement for 1998 will ultimately be possible, given the similarity between these leases and the settled leases. However, negotiations are not complete and the treatment of the 1998 leases may still be litigated. Under current generally accepted accounting principles, if the 1998 leases are settled on a basis comparable to the 1996 and 1997 leases, the Company would not expect the settlement of the 1998 leases to have an impact on net income, based on existing reserves.

In the fourth quarter of 2005 the Company deposited funds with the IRS in anticipation of reaching a settlement on all of its LILO investments.

On February 11, 2005, the IRS released Notice 2005-13, which identified certain lease investments known as “SILOs” as potentially subject to IRS challenge. The Company believes that certain of its lease investments entered into prior to 2004 may be consistent with transactions described in the notice. In response, the Company is reviewing its lease portfolio and evaluating the technical merits of the IRS’ position. Although it is likely the IRS will challenge the tax benefits associated with these leases, the Company remains confident that its tax treatment of the leases complied with statutory, administrative and judicial authority existing at the time they were entered into.

The Company currently believes it has adequate tax reserves to cover its LILO exposure and any other potential tax exposures, based on a probability assessment of various potential outcomes. Probabilities and outcomes are reviewed as events unfold, and adjustments to the reserves are made when appropriate.

In the ordinary course of business, the Company and its subsidiaries are routinely defendants in or parties to a number of pending and potential legal actions, including actions brought on behalf of various classes of claimants, and regulatory matters. Claims for significant monetary damages are asserted in certain of these actions and proceedings. Due to the inherent difficulty of predicting the outcome of such matters, the Company

 

112


Table of Contents

THE BANK OF NEW YORK COMPANY, INC.

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS—(Continued)

 

cannot ascertain what the eventual outcome of these matters will be; however, based on current knowledge and after consultation with legal counsel, the Company does not believe that judgments or settlements, if any, arising from pending or potential legal actions or regulatory matters, either individually or in the aggregate, after giving effect to applicable reserves, will have a material adverse effect on the consolidated financial position or liquidity of the Company although they could have a material effect on net income for a given period. The Company intends to defend itself vigorously against all of the claims asserted in these legal actions.

See discussion of contingent legal matters in the “Legal and Regulatory Proceedings” section.

 

113


Table of Contents

Report of Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm

To The Board of Directors and Shareholders

of The Bank of New York Company, Inc.

We have audited the accompanying consolidated balance sheets of The Bank of New York Company, Inc. and subsidiaries (the “Company”) as of December 31, 2005 and 2004, and the related consolidated statements of income, shareholders’ equity, and cash flows for each of the three years in the period ended December 31, 2005. These financial statements are the responsibility of the Company’s management. Our responsibility is to express an opinion on these financial statements based on our audits.

We conducted our audits in accordance with the standards of the Public Company Accounting Oversight Board (United States). Those standards require that we plan and perform the audit to obtain reasonable assurance about whether the financial statements are free of material misstatement. An audit includes examining, on a test basis, evidence supporting the amounts and disclosures in the financial statements. An audit also includes assessing the accounting principles used and significant estimates made by management, as well as evaluating the overall financial statement presentation. We believe that our audits provide a reasonable basis for our opinion.

In our opinion, the financial statements referred to above present fairly, in all material respects, the consolidated financial position of The Bank of New York Company, Inc. and subsidiaries at December 31, 2005 and 2004, and the consolidated results of their operations and their cash flows for each of the three years in the period ended December 31, 2005, in conformity with U.S. generally accepted accounting principles.

We also have audited, in accordance with the standards of the Public Company Accounting Oversight Board (United States), the effectiveness of The Bank of New York Company Inc.’s internal control over financial reporting as of December 31, 2005, based on criteria established in Internal Control-Integrated Framework issued by the Committee of Sponsoring Organizations of the Treadway Commission and our report dated February 22, 2006 expressed an unqualified opinion thereon.

/s/    ERNST & YOUNG LLP        

NEW YORK, NEW YORK

February 22, 2006

 

114


Table of Contents

UNITED STATES

SECURITIES AND EXCHANGE COMMISSION

Washington, D.C. 20549

 


Form 10-K

FOR ANNUAL AND TRANSITION REPORTS PURSUANT TO SECTION 13 OR 15(d) OF THE

SECURITIES EXCHANGE ACT OF 1934

 


(Mark One)

x Annual report pursuant to Section 13 or 15(d) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934

For the fiscal year ended December 31, 2005

 

¨ Transition report pursuant to Section 13 or 15(d) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934

For the transition period from                  to             

Commission file number 001-06152

 


THE BANK OF NEW YORK COMPANY, INC.

(Exact Name of Registrant as Specified in Its Charter)

 


 

 

New York   13-2614959

(State or Other Jurisdiction of

Incorporation or Organization)

  (I.R.S. Employer
Identification No.)
One Wall Street, New York, NY   10286
(Address of Principal Executive Offices)   (Zip Code)
(Registrant’s Telephone number, Including Area Code)   (212) 495-1784

Securities Registered Pursuant to Section 12(b) of the Act:

 

Title of Each Class   Name of Each Exchange of Which Registered
Common Stock   New York Stock Exchange
6.88% Preferred Trust Securities, Series E   New York Stock Exchange
5.95% Preferred Trust Securities, Series F   New York Stock Exchange

Securities Registered Pursuant to Section 12(g) of the Act:

Class A, 7.75% Cumulative Convertible Preferred Stock

(Title of Class)

7.97% Capital Securities, Series B

(Title of Class)

 


Indicate by check mark if the registrant is a well-known seasoned issuer, as defined in Rule 405 of the Securities Act.    Yes  x    No  ¨

Indicate by check mark if the registrant is not required to file reports pursuant to Section 13 or Section 15(d) of the Act.    Yes  ¨    No  x

Indicate by check mark whether the registrant is a shell company (as defined in Rule 12b-2 of the Act).    Yes  ¨    No  x

Indicate by check mark whether the registrant (1) has filed all reports required to be filed by Section 13 or 15(d) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934 during the preceding 12 months (or for such shorter period that the registrant was required to file such reports), and (2) has been subject to such filing requirements for the past 90 days.    Yes  x    No  ¨

Indicate by check mark if disclosure of delinquent filers pursuant to Item 405 of Regulation S-K is not contained herein, and will not be contained, to the best of registrant’s knowledge, in definitive proxy or information statements incorporated by reference in Part III of this Form 10-K or any amendment to this Form 10-K.  ¨

Indicate by check mark whether the registrant is an accelerated filer (as defined in Rule 12b-2 of the Act).    Yes  x    No  ¨

The aggregate market value of the voting and non-voting common equity held by non-affiliates (persons other than directors and executive officers) computed by reference to the price at which the common equity was last sold as of the last business day of the Registrant’s most recently completed second fiscal quarter (June 30, 2005) was $22,183,508,448.

The number of shares of the Registrant’s Common Stock outstanding on January 31, 2006, was 771,250,214.

Documents Incorporated by Reference

This Annual Report and Form 10-K incorporates into a single document the requirements of the accounting profession and the Securities and Exchange Commission. Only those sections of the Annual Report referenced in the following cross-reference index and the information under the caption “Forward-Looking Statements and Risk Factors That Could Affect Future Results” are incorporated in the Form 10-K.

 


 

115


Table of Contents

The following sections of the Annual Report set forth in the cross-reference index are incorporated in Form 10-K.

CROSS-REFERENCE INDEX

 

           Page(s)

PART I

     

Item 1

   Business    2 - 70

Item 1A

   Risk Factors    126 - 135

Item 1B

   Unresolved Staff Comments    Not applicable

Item 2

   Properties    121

Item 3

   Legal Proceedings    121-122

Item 4

   Submission of Matters to a Vote of Security Holders    121

PART II

     

Item 5

  

Market for the Registrant’s Common Equity, Related Stockholder Matters and Issuer Purchases of Equity Securities

   65

Item 6

  

Selected Financial Data

   1

Item 7

  

Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition
and Results of Operations

   2 - 70

Item 7A

  

Quantitative and Qualitative Disclosures About Market Risk

   55 - 58

Item 8

  

Financial Statements and Supplementary Data

   71 - 113
  

Quarterly Data

   64

Item 9

  

Changes in and Disagreements with Accountants on Accounting
and Financial Disclosure

   121

Item 9A

  

Controls and Procedures

   137

Item 9B

  

Other Information

   Not applicable

PART III

     

Item 10

   Directors and Executive Officers of the Registrant    123, 139 - 140

Item 11

  

Executive Compensation

   *

Item 12

  

Security Ownership of Certain Beneficial Owners
and Management and Related Stockholder Matters

   *

Item 13

  

Certain Relationships and Related Transactions

   *

Item 14

  

Principal Accountant Fees and Services

   *

PART IV

     

Item 15

   Exhibits, Financial Statement Schedules    141 - 146

* Pursuant to Instruction G(3) to Form 10-K, the remainder of the information to be provided in Item 10, 11, 12, 13 and 14 of Form 10-K (other than information pursuant to Items 401(b) and 406 of Regulation S-K) is incorporated herein by reference to the registrant’s definitive proxy statement for its 2006 annual meeting of shareholders to be filed within 120 days of the end of the fiscal year covered by this Form 10-K.

 

116


Table of Contents

CERTAIN REGULATORY CONSIDERATIONS

General

The Company is a bank holding company subject to the regulation and supervision of the Federal Reserve Board under the Bank Holding Company Act of 1956 (“BHC Act”) and has qualified and elected to be treated as a financial holding company (a “FHC”) under the BHC Act. The Company is also subject to regulation by the New York State Banking Department. Under the BHC Act, bank holding companies that are not FHCs are generally limited to engaging in the business of banking, managing or controlling banks, and other activities that the Federal Reserve Board has determined to be so closely related to banking as to be a proper incident thereto.

A bank holding company, such as the Company, each of whose insured depository institution subsidiaries is “well capitalized” (Tier 1 capital ratio of at least 6%, Total capital ratio of at least 10% and a leverage ratio of at least 5%) and “well managed” under applicable law and regulation and which has received at least a “satisfactory” rating in its most recent examination under the Community Reinvestment Act may elect to be a FHC and engage in a broader range of financial activities than those traditionally permissible for U.S. bank holding companies that are not FHCs. Under the BHC Act, a FHC may, without the prior approval of the Federal Reserve Board, engage in any activity, or acquire and retain the shares of any company engaged in any activity, that is either (1) financial in nature or incidental to such financial activity (as determined by the Federal Reserve Board in consultation with the Department of the Treasury) or (2) complementary to a financial activity and does not pose a substantial risk to the safety and soundness of depository institutions or the financial system generally (as solely determined by the Federal Reserve Board). Activities that are financial in nature include insurance, securities underwriting and dealing, and merchant banking. Under the merchant banking provisions of the BHC Act, qualifying FHCs may invest in companies that engage in activities that are not otherwise permissible, subject to certain limitations, including that the FHC makes the investment for a limited duration and does not routinely manage the company.

A FHC that does not continue to meet all the requirements for FHC status will, depending on which requirements it fails to meet, lose the ability to undertake new activities or make acquisitions that are not generally permissible for bank holding companies or to continue such activities.

Both federal and state laws extensively regulate various aspects of the banking business, such as permissible loans, investments and activities, and impose reserve requirements. These regulations are intended primarily for the protection of depositors rather than the Company’s stockholders.

The Company’s subsidiary banks are subject to supervision and examination by applicable federal and state banking agencies. The Bank of New York (the “Bank”), the Company’s principal banking subsidiary, is a New York chartered banking corporation, is a member of the Federal Reserve System and is subject to regulation, supervision and examination by the Federal Reserve and by the New York State Banking Department.

Under Federal Reserve Board policy, the Company is expected to act as a source of financial strength to its banks and to commit resources to support its banks, including in circumstances where it might not do so absent such policy. In addition, any loans by the Company to its banks would be subordinate in right of payment to depositors and to certain other indebtedness of its banks.

Acquisitions

Federal and state laws impose approval requirements for mergers and acquisitions involving commercial banks or bank holding companies. The BHC Act requires the prior approval of the Federal Reserve Board for the direct or indirect acquisition of more than 5% of any class of the voting shares or all or substantially all of the assets of a commercial bank or bank holding company. In reviewing bank acquisition and merger applications, the bank regulatory authorities will consider, among other things, the competitive effect of the transaction, financial and managerial issues including the capital position of the combined organization, convenience and needs factors, including the applicant’s record under the Community Reinvestment Act, and the effectiveness of the subject organizations in combating money laundering activities.

 

117


Table of Contents

Capital Adequacy

The Federal bank regulators have adopted risk-based capital guidelines for bank holding companies and banks. The minimum ratio of qualifying total capital (“Total Capital”) to risk-weighted assets (including certain off-balance sheet items) is 8%. At least half of the Total Capital must consist of common stock, retained earnings, qualifying noncumulative perpetual preferred stock, minority interests in the equity accounts of consolidated subsidiaries and, for bank holding companies, a limited amount of non-cumulative perpetual preferred stock, trust preferred securities and certain other so-called ‘restricted core capital elements’, less most intangibles including goodwill (“Tier 1 Capital”). The remainder (“Tier 2 Capital”) may consist of certain other preferred stock, certain other capital instruments, and limited amounts of subordinated debt and the allowance for loan and lease losses. Restricted core capital elements are currently limited to 25% of Tier 1 Capital and, beginning March 31, 2009, will be limited to 15% of Tier 1 Capital for internationally active banking organizations like the Company and the Bank.

In addition, the Federal Reserve Board has established minimum Leverage Ratio (Tier 1 Capital to average total assets) guidelines for bank holding companies and banks. The Federal Reserve Board’s guidelines provide for a minimum Leverage Ratio of 3% for bank holding companies and banks that meet certain specified criteria, including those having the highest supervisory rating. All other banking organizations will be required to maintain a Leverage Ratio of at least 4%. At December 31, 2005, the Federal Reserve Board has not advised the Company of any specific minimum Leverage Ratio applicable to it.

The guidelines also provide that banking organizations experiencing internal growth or making acquisitions will be expected to maintain strong capital positions substantially above the minimum supervisory levels, without significant reliance on intangible assets.

As discussed above, the Company’s bank subsidiaries must be “well capitalized” for the Company to maintain its FHC status. In addition, as a practical regulatory matter, the Company must maintain capital ratios above well capitalized.

In January 2003, the Financial Accounting Standards Board (the “FASB”) issued FASB Interpretation No. 46, Consolidation of Variable Interest Entities, which it revised in December 2003 (“FIN 46”). One consequence of FIN 46 is that, effective December 31, 2003, the Company deconsolidated the statutory trusts which have issued trust preferred securities. As a result, the junior subordinated debentures held by the trusts are now reported on the Company’s consolidated balance sheet. The Federal Reserve Board has, however, confirmed the continued qualification of trust preferred securities as Tier 1 Capital (subject to the restrictions described above) notwithstanding the change in accounting treatment. See “Accounting Changes and New Accounting Pronouncements” in the Notes to the Consolidated Financial Statements regarding the adoption of FIN 46.

See “Capital Resources” in the “Management Discussion & Analysis” section for a discussion of the BIS proposal to change the risk-based capital guidelines.

Prompt Corrective Action

The Federal Deposit Insurance Act (“FDIA”) among other things, requires federal banking regulators to take prompt corrective action in respect of FDIC-insured depository institutions that do not meet minimum capital requirements. The FDIA specifies five capital tiers: “well capitalized”, “adequately capitalized”, “undercapitalized”, “significantly undercapitalized”, and “critically undercapitalized”. A depository institution’s capital tier will depend upon how its capital levels compare to various relevant capital measures and certain other factors, as established by regulation.

Under applicable regulations, an FDIC-insured bank is deemed to be: (i) well capitalized if it maintains a Leverage Ratio of at least 5%, a Tier 1 Capital Ratio of at least 6% and a Total Capital Ratio of at least 10% and is not subject to an order, written agreement, capital directive, or prompt corrective action directive to meet and maintain a specific level for any capital measure; (ii) adequately capitalized if it maintains a Leverage Ratio of at

 

118


Table of Contents

least 4% (or a Leverage Ratio of at least 3% if it received the highest supervisory rating in its most recent report of examination, subject to appropriate federal banking agency guidelines), a Tier 1 Capital Ratio of 4% and a Total Capital Ratio of at least 8% and is not defined to be well capitalized; (iii) undercapitalized if it has a Leverage Ratio of less than 4% (or a Leverage Ratio that is less than 3% if it received the highest supervisory rating in its most recent report of examination, subject to appropriate federal banking agency guidelines), a Tier 1 Capital Ratio less than 4% or a Total Capital Ratio of less than 8% and it does not meet the definition of a significantly undercapitalized or critically undercapitalized institution; (iv) significantly undercapitalized if it has a Leverage Ratio of less than 3%, a Tier 1 Capital Ratio less than 3% or a Total Capital Ratio of less than 6% and it does not meet the definition of critically undercapitalized; and (v) critically undercapitalized if it maintains a level of tangible equity capital of less than 2% of total assets. A bank may be deemed to be in a capitalization category that is lower than is indicated by its actual capital position if it receives an unsatisfactory examination rating. The FDIA imposes progressively more restrictive constraints on operations, management and capital distributions, depending on the capital category in which an institution is classified.

A depository institution that is not well capitalized is subject to certain limitations on brokered deposits. In addition, as indicated above, if a depository institution is not well capitalized, its parent holding company cannot become, and, subject to a capital restoration plan, cannot remain, a FHC.

The FDIA generally prohibits an FDIC-insured depository institution from making any capital distribution (including payment of dividends) or paying any management fee to its holding company if the depository institution would thereafter be undercapitalized. Undercapitalized depository institutions are subject to restrictions on borrowing from the Federal Reserve and to growth limitations, and are required to submit a capital restoration plan. For a capital restoration plan to be acceptable, any holding company must guarantee the capital plan up to an amount equal to the lesser of 5% of the depository institution’s assets at the time it became undercapitalized and the amount of the capital deficiency at the time it fails to comply with the plan. In the event of the holding company’s bankruptcy, such guarantee would take priority over claims of its general unsecured creditors. If a depository institution fails to submit an acceptable plan, it is treated as if it is significantly undercapitalized.

Significantly undercapitalized depository institutions may be subject to a number of requirements and restrictions, including orders to sell sufficient voting stock to become adequately capitalized, requirements to reduce total assets and cessation of receipt of deposits from correspondent banks. Critically undercapitalized depository institutions are subject to appointment of a receiver or conservator.

A further discussion of the Company’s capital position and capital adequacy is incorporated by reference from “Capital Resources” in the “Management’s Discussion and Analysis” Section.

FDIC Insurance Assessments

The Company is subject to FDIC deposit insurance assessments for the Bank Insurance Fund (“BIF”). For purposes of assessment, the Company is assigned to one of three capital groups: well capitalized, adequately capitalized or undercapitalized. The Company is further assigned to one of three subgroups within its capital group. The assignment to a particular subgroup is based on supervisory evaluations by the primary federal and state supervisors and other information relevant to the Company’s financial condition and the risk posed to the applicable insurance fund.

In the future, the assessment rate applicable to the Company will be determined in part by the risk assessment classification assigned by the FDIC and in part by the BIF assessment adopted by the FDIC. FDIC regulations currently provide that premiums related to deposits assessed by the BIF are to be assessed at a rate between 0 cent and 27 cents per $100 of deposits.

In recent years, the Company’s U.S. bank subsidiaries and other well capitalized and well managed banks have not paid premiums for FDIC insurance due to favorable loss experience and a healthy reserve ratio in the

 

119


Table of Contents

BIF. However, such well capitalized and well managed banks may be required to pay premiums on deposit insurance in the future. The outcome of legislative and regulatory initiatives, the BIF loss experience and other factors will determine the amount of such premiums.

The Deposit Insurance Funds Act of 1996 separated the Financing Corporation (“FICO”) assessment to service the interest on its bond obligations from the BIF and the Savings Association Insurance Fund assessments. The amount assessed on individual institutions by the FICO will be in addition to the amount, if any, paid for deposit insurance according to the FDIC’s risk-related assessment rate schedules. FICO assessment rates may be adjusted quarterly to reflect a change in assessment base for the BIF. The current FICO annual assessment rate is 1.34 cents per $100 of deposits.

Depositor Preference

The FDIA provides for a depositor preference on amounts realized from the liquidation or other resolution of any depository institution insured by the FDIC.

Cross Guarantee Liability of FDIC-Insured Bank Subsidiaries

A financial institution insured by the FDIC that is under common control with a failed or failing FDIC-insured institution can be required to indemnify the FDIC for losses incurred by, or reasonably expected to be incurred by, the FDIC resulting from the insolvency of the failed institution or from providing assistance to the failing institution, even if this causes the affiliated institution also to become insolvent. Any obligation or liability owed by a subsidiary depository institution to its parent company is subordinate to the subsidiary’s cross-guarantee liability with respect to commonly controlled insured depository institutions and to the rights of depositors.

Restrictions on Transfer of Funds

Restrictions on the transfer of funds to the Company and subsidiary bank dividend limitations are discussed in “Company Financial Information” in the Notes to the Consolidated Financial Statements.

Privacy

The Gramm-Leach-Bliley Act (“GLB Act”) modified laws related to financial privacy. The GLB Act financial privacy provisions generally prohibit a financial institution, including the Company, from disclosing nonpublic personal financial information about consumers to unaffiliated third parties unless consumers have the opportunity to “opt out” of the disclosure. A financial institution is also required to provide its privacy policy annually to its customers. A number of state legislatures have adopted privacy laws, including laws prohibiting sharing of customer information without the customer’s prior permission, and other state legislatures are considering similar laws. These laws may make it more difficult for the Company to share customer information with its marketing partners, reduce the effectiveness of marketing programs, and increase the cost of marketing programs.

Anti-Money Laundering Initiatives and the USA PATRIOT Act

A major focus of governmental policy relating to financial institutions in recent years has been aimed at combating money laundering and terrorist financing. The USA PATRIOT Act of 2001 (the “USA PATRIOT Act”) substantially broadened the scope of U.S. anti-money laundering laws and regulations by imposing significant new compliance and due diligence obligations, creating new crimes and penalties and expanding the extra-territorial jurisdiction of the United States. The U.S. Treasury Department has issued a number of implementing regulations which apply to various requirements of the USA PATRIOT Act to financial institutions such as the Company’s bank, broker-dealer and investment adviser subsidiaries and mutual funds and

 

120


Table of Contents

private investment companies advised or sponsored by the Company’s subsidiaries. Those regulations impose obligations on financial institutions to maintain appropriate policies, procedures and controls to detect, prevent and report money laundering and terrorist financing and to verify the identity of their customers. In addition, the bank regulatory agencies are imposing heightened standards, which have resulted in an increased number of regulatory sanctions and law enforcement authorities have been taking a more active role. Because the Bank is a major correspondent bank, a number of these new regulations and standards impose particularly heightened requirements. Failure of a financial institution to maintain and implement adequate programs to combat money laundering and terrorist financing could have serious legal and reputational consequences for the institution.

Community Reinvestment Act

The Community Reinvestment Act requires banks to help serve the credit needs of their communities, including credit to low and moderate income individuals and geographies. Should the Company or its bank subsidiaries fail to serve adequately the community, potential penalties may include regulatory denials to expand branches, relocate, add subsidiaries and affiliates, expand into new financial activities and merge with or purchase other financial institutions.

Legislative and Regulatory Initiatives

Various legislative initiatives are from time to time introduced in Congress, and various regulatory initiatives are introduced, that would apply to the Company. The Company cannot determine the ultimate effect that any such potential legislation or regulations, if adopted, would have upon its financial condition or operations.

S UBMISSION OF MATTERS TO A VOTE OF SECURITY HOLDERS

There were no matters submitted to a vote of security holders of the registrant during the fourth quarter of 2005.

C HANGES IN AND DISAGREEMENTS WITH ACCOUNTANTS ON ACCOUNTING AND FINANCIAL DISCLOSURE

There have been no events which require disclosure under Item 304 of Regulation S-K.

P ROPERTIES

At December 31, 2005 in New York City, the Company owned the forty-nine story building housing its executive headquarters at One Wall Street and an operations center at 101 Barclay Street. See “Capital Resources” in the “Management Discussion & Analysis” section. The Company leases the land at the 101 Barclay Street location under a lease expiring in 2080. In addition, the Company owns and/or leases administrative and operations facilities in New York, New Jersey, Delaware, Florida, Connecticut and the mid-south region of the U.S.; Brussels, Belgium; London, England; Liverpool, England; Manchester, England; Edinburgh, Scotland; Chennai, India. Other real properties owned or leased by the Company, when considered in the aggregate, are not material to its operations.

L EGAL AND REGULATORY PROCEEDINGS

In the ordinary course of business, the Company and its subsidiaries are routinely defendants in or parties to a number of pending and potential legal actions, including actions brought on behalf of various classes of claimants, and regulatory matters. Claims for significant monetary damages are asserted in certain of these actions and proceedings. In regulatory enforcement matters, claims for disgorgement and the imposition of penalties and/or other remedial sanctions are possible. Due to the inherent difficulty of predicting the outcome of such matters, the Company cannot ascertain what the eventual outcome of these matters will be; however, based on current knowledge and after consultation with legal counsel, the Company does not believe that judgments or

 

121


Table of Contents

settlements, if any, arising from pending or potential legal actions or regulatory matters, either individually or in the aggregate, after giving effect to applicable reserves, will have a material adverse effect on the consolidated financial position or liquidity of the Company although they could have a material effect on net income for a given period. The Company intends to defend itself vigorously against all of the claims asserted in these legal actions.

As disclosed in a report filed on Form 8-K on November 8, 2005, the Bank entered into a non-prosecution agreement with the U.S. Attorney’s Offices for the Southern and Eastern Districts of New York (“SDNY” and “EDNY”). The agreement resolves the previously disclosed SDNY investigation involving funds transfer activities to and from Russia from 1996-1999 and the EDNY investigation of a fraudulent scheme conducted by a former customer of one of the Bank’s Long Island branch offices.

The Company is broadly involved in the mutual fund industry, and various governmental and self-regulatory agencies have sought documents and other information from it in connection with investigations relating to that industry. The Company is cooperating with these investigations. One of these investigations, by the U.S. Securities and Exchange Commission (“SEC”), concerns the relationship between: (1) the BNY Hamilton Funds, Inc., a family of mutual funds; (2) the Company, which acts as the investment adviser to the Hamilton Funds and provides certain other services; and (3) a third-party service provider that acts as administrator and principal underwriter of the Hamilton Funds. This investigation principally concerns the appropriateness of certain expenditures made in connection with marketing and distribution of the Hamilton Funds. Another SEC investigation has focused on possible market-timing transactions cleared by Pershing LLC (“Pershing”), a wholly owned subsidiary of the Company, for Mutuals.com and other introducing brokers. The Company has entered into settlement negotiations with the SEC staff concerning the Pershing investigation and believes that these discussions will result in a resolution of this investigation, but there can be no assurance that a settlement will be reached.

Pershing, which was acquired from Credit Suisse First Boston (USA), Inc. (“CSFB”) in May 2003, is defending three putative class action lawsuits filed against CSFB seeking unspecified damages relating to mutual fund market-timing transactions that were cleared through Pershing’s facilities. Because the conduct at issue is alleged to have occurred largely during the period that Pershing was owned by CSFB, the Company had made a claim for indemnification against CSFB relating to these lawsuits under the agreement relating to the acquisition of Pershing. CSFB is disputing this claim for indemnification.

Pershing Trading Company LP, an indirect subsidiary of the Company, has received a request for information from the SEC in connection with its investigation of the trading activities of floor specialists from 1999 to 2004 on two regional exchanges. The investigation involves possible interpositioning and frontrunning activities by certain specialists on these exchanges. Pershing is cooperating with the investigation. Because the conduct under review occurred largely during the period that Pershing was owned by CSFB, the Company has made a claim for indemnification against CSFB relating to this matter. CSFB is disputing this claim for indemnification.

As previously disclosed, the SEC has sought documents and other information from the Company in connection with investigations relating to its issuer services business. The Company continues to cooperate with these investigations. The investigations have focused primarily on (i) the Company’s role as transfer agent on behalf of equity issuers in the United States and the process used by the Company’s stock transfer division to search for lost security holders of its issuer clients; and (ii) the Company’s role as auction agent in connection with auction rate securities issued by various issuers. The Company has entered into settlement negotiations with the SEC staff concerning the transfer agent investigation. The Company has made an offer of settlement to resolve this matter that the staff has agreed to recommend to the SEC. There can be no assurance that the SEC will accept the offer or that a settlement will be reached.

 

122


Table of Contents

EXECUTIVE OFFICERS

Thomas A. Renyi

Mr. Renyi, 59, has served as Chairman and Chief Executive Officer of The Bank of New York Company, Inc. and The Bank of New York since at least 2000.

Gerald L. Hassell

Mr. Hassell, 54, has served as President of The Bank of New York Company, Inc. and The Bank of New York since at least 2000.

Bruce W. Van Saun

Mr. Van Saun, 48, has served as Vice Chairman since November 2005 and Chief Financial Officer of The Bank of New York Company, Inc. and The Bank of New York since at least 2000. He served as Senior Executive Vice President of The Bank of New York Company, Inc. and The Bank of New York from at least 2000 to 2005.

John M. Liftin

Mr. Liftin, 62, has served as Vice Chairman, General Counsel and Secretary of The Bank of New York Company, Inc. and as Vice Chairman and General Counsel of The Bank of New York since April 2005. Mr. Liftin joined the Company from Prudential Financial, Inc., where he served as Senior Vice President and General Counsel from 1998 to 2005.

Thomas J. Mastro

Mr. Mastro, 56, has served as Comptroller of The Bank of New York Company, Inc. since 1999. He has served as Executive Vice President since 2004 and Comptroller since 1999 of The Bank of New York. He served as Senior Vice President of The Bank of New York from at least 1999 to 2004.

Kevin C. Piccoli

Mr. Piccoli, 48, has served as Auditor of The Bank of New York Company, Inc. since 2001. He has served as Executive Vice President since 2004 and Chief Auditor since 2001 of The Bank of New York. He served as Senior Vice President of The Bank of New York from 2001 to 2004. Prior to joining The Bank of New York Company Inc., Mr. Piccoli was Managing Director and Chief Financial Officer of Cantor Fitzgerald LP and Chief Financial Officer of eSpeed, Inc. (a NASDAQ listed, majority owned subsidiary of Cantor Fitzgerald) from 1999 to 2001.

There are no family relationships between the executive officers of the Company. The terms of office of the executive officers of the Company extend until the annual organizational meeting of the Board of Directors.

 

123


Table of Contents

FORWARD LOOKING STATEMENTS AND RISK FACTORS THAT COULD AFFECT

FUTURE RESULTS

General

The information presented with respect to, among other things, earnings and revenue outlook, projected business growth, the outcome of legal, regulatory and investigatory proceedings, the Company’s plans, objectives and strategies, and future loan losses, is forward looking information. Forward looking statements are the Company’s current estimates or expectations of future events or future results.

The Company or its executive officers and directors on behalf of the Company may from time to time make forward looking statements. When used in this report, any press release or oral statements, the words “estimate,” “forecast,” “foresee,” “project,” “anticipate,” “target,” “expect,” “effort,” “intend,” “think,” “continue,” “seek,” “believe,” “plan,” “goal,” “could,” “should,” “may,” “will,” “strategy,” and words of similar meaning are intended to identify forward looking statements in addition to statements specifically identified as forward looking statements.

Forward looking statements, including the Company’s discussions and projections of future results of operations and discussions of future plans contained in Management’s Discussion and Analysis and elsewhere in this Form 10-K, are based on management’s current expectations and assumptions: Variations in management’s projections, methodologies used by management to set adequate reserve levels for expected and contingent liabilities, and evaluation of risk or market forecasts and the actions that management could take in response to these changes are all subject to risks and uncertainties that could cause actual results to differ materially from projected results. Factors that could cause or contribute to such differences include, but are not limited to:

 

    General business and economic conditions;

 

    Monetary and other governmental policies;

 

    Level and volatility of interest rates;

 

    Actions of rating agencies;

 

    Acquisitions and divestitures;

 

    Competition;

 

    Changes in technology;

 

    Dependence on fee based business;

 

    Terrorism and responses;

 

    Legislative and regulatory environment;

 

    Reputational and legal risk;

 

    Changes to tax laws and regulations;

 

    Changes to accounting principles or standards;

 

    Domestic and global economic trends;

 

    Market volatility;

 

    Access to capital markets;

 

    Actual and assumed rates of return on pension assets;

 

    Credit risks inherent in the lending process and the Company’s provision for credit losses;

 

    Inflation;

 

124


Table of Contents
    Rising employee benefit expenses; and

 

    The effectiveness of management’s efforts to control expenses

Readers of this document should not rely solely on forward-looking information and should consider all uncertainties and risks disclosed throughout this document and in the Company’s other reports to the SEC, including but not limited to, those discussed below. Any factor described in this report could by itself, or together with one or more other factors, adversely affect the Company’s business, future prospects, and results of operations or financial condition. There are also other factors that are not described in this report and the Company’s other reports that could cause the Company’s results to differ from the Company’s expectations. The following discussion should be read in conjunction with the Company’s consolidated financial statements and the related notes included elsewhere in this report.

Forward looking statements could be affected by a number of risks potentially impacting its business, financial condition, results of operations and cash flows, some of which by their nature are dynamic and subject to rapid and possibly abrupt changes which the Company is necessarily unable to predict with accuracy. In addition to the risks described in other parts of the report, including the Legal and Regulatory Proceedings and Risk Management sections, these risks include, but are not limited to, those discussed below under “Risk Factors.”

Forward looking statements speak only as of the date they are made. The Company will not update forward looking statements to reflect facts, assumptions, circumstances or events which have changed after a forward looking statement was made except as required by law.

 

125


Table of Contents

Risk Factors

Making or continuing an investment in securities issued by the Company, including its common stock, involves certain risks that you should carefully consider. The risks and uncertainties described below are not the only risks that may have a material adverse effect on the Company. Additional risks and uncertainties also could adversely affect its business and its results. If any of the following risks actually occur, its business, financial condition or results of operations could be negatively affected, the market price for your securities could decline, and you could lose all or a part of your investment. Further, to the extent that any of the information contained in this Annual Report on Form 10-K constitutes forward-looking statements, the risk factors set forth below also are cautionary statements identifying important factors that could cause the Company’s actual results to differ materially from those expressed in any forward-looking statements made by or on behalf of the Company.

Risks Related to the Company’s Business

Global Trends—The Company’s business could be adversely affected if current global trends do not continue or if global business and economic conditions weaken.

The Company’s businesses benefit from certain global trends, such as the growth of financial assets, creation of new securities, financial services industry consolidation, rapid technological change, globalization of investment activities, structural changes to financial markets, shortened settlement cycles, straight-through processing requirements, and increased demand for outsourcing. The Company believes that these long-term trends all tend to increase the demand for the Company’s products and services around the world. If these trends do not continue then the Company’s fee-based revenue growth may be adversely affected.

The Company expects that its business will benefit from worldwide pension reform that creates additional pools of assets that use custody and related services, and investment management services. If the pace of pension reform and resulting programs, including public and private pension plans, slows down or if substantial pension reform does not occur, particularly in markets in which the Company is active, then the Company’s revenue growth may be adversely affected.

In addition, sustained weakness or weakening in business and economic conditions in any or all of the domestic or international financial markets in which the Company conducts its business could have one or more of the following effects:

 

    Decreased demand for investment products or services offered by the Company as a result of negative trends in savings rates or in individuals’ investment preferences.

 

    Decreased demand for custody and related services and investment management services as a result of slowed or halted inflows to pension plans.

 

    Increased credit costs and higher provision for credit losses as a result of lower credit quality of the Company’s clients.

Competition—The Company is subject to intense competition in all aspects of its business, which could negatively affect its ability to maintain or increase its profitability.

Many businesses in which the Company operates are intensely competitive around the world. Other domestic and international banks and financial service companies such as trading firms, broker dealers, investment banks, specialized processing companies, outsourcing companies, data processing companies and asset managers aggressively compete with the Company for fee-based business. The Company also faces competition from both unregulated and regulated financial services organizations such as mutual funds, insurance companies, credit unions, money market funds and investment counseling firms, whose products and services span the local, national and global markets in which the Company conducts operations. The ability of a competitor to offer comparable or improved products or services at a lower price would likely negatively affect the Company’s ability to maintain or increase its profitability.

 

126


Table of Contents

In the traditional banking part of the Company’s business, commercial banks, savings banks, savings and loan associations and credit unions actively compete for deposits, and money market funds and brokerage houses offer deposit-like services. These institutions, as well as consumer and commercial finance companies, national retail chains, receivables factors, insurance companies and pension trusts, are important competitors that offer various types of loans to borrowers. Issuers of commercial paper compete actively for funds and reduce demand for bank loans. Insurance companies, investment counseling firms, brokerage houses and other business firms and individuals offer active competition for personal trust services and investment counseling services.

Pricing pressures as a result of the activities of competitors, customer pricing reviews, and the introduction of new products may result in a reduction in the price the Company can charge for its products and services.

The Company’s competitive environment in traditional banking is also impacted by the growth of alternative delivery channels, in particular the Internet, which facilitates competition by removing geographic barriers to providing certain of its products and services and which further opens the market for competitors. It is likely that competition will increase in the future as a result of ongoing legislative, regulatory and technological changes and the continuing trend of consolidation in the financial services industry. Federal banking law permits affiliation among banks, securities firms and insurance companies, which also is changing the competitive environment in which the Company conducts business.

The Company’s internal strategies and forecasts assume a growing client base and increasing client usage of its services. A decline in the pace at which the Company attracts new clients and a decline of the pace at which existing and new clients use additional services and assign additional assets to the Company for management or custody would adversely affect its future results of operations. A decline in the rate at which Company clients outsource functions, such as their internal accounting activities, would also adversely affect the Company’s results of operations.

The Company’s ability to successfully compete for business depends in part on its ability to develop and market new and innovative services, and to adopt or develop new technologies that differentiate its products or provide cost efficiencies. Rapid technological change in the financial services industry, together with competitive pressures, require the Company to make significant and ongoing investments to bring new services to market in a timely fashion at competitive prices. The Company cannot provide any assurance that its technology spending will achieve gains in competitiveness or profitability, and the costs it incurs in product development could be substantial. Accordingly, the Company could incur substantial development costs without achieving corresponding gains in profitability.

Dependence on fee-based business—The Company is dependent on fee-based business for a substantial majority of its revenue.

The Company’s principal operational focus is on fee-based business, as distinct from commercial banking institutions that earn most of their revenues from traditional interest-generating products and services. The Company has redeployed its assets away from traditional corporate banking in order to further concentrate on fee-based businesses, including cash management, custody, mutual fund services, unit investment trusts, corporate trust, depositary receipts, stock transfer, securities execution and clearance, collateral management, and asset management. As a result, for the year ended December 31, 2005, approximately 72% of its total revenues came from fee-based business with the balance from interest earnings on corporate and retail loans or its investment securities portfolio. Accordingly, the Company’s overall results of operations are dependent on the performance of its fee-based businesses.

The Company’s fee-based revenues could be adversely affected by a slowing in capital market activity, significant declines in market values or negative trends in savings rates or in individual investment preferences.

The Company’s businesses benefit from increases in the volume of financial market transactions worldwide. Corporate actions, cross-border investing, global mergers and acquisitions activity, new debt and equity

 

127


Table of Contents

issuances, and secondary trading volumes all affect the level of the Company’s revenues. Fees for many of the Company’s products and services are based on the volume of transactions processed, the market value of assets managed and administered, securities lending volume and spreads, and fees for other services rendered. Asset-based fees are typically determined on a sliding scale so that, as the value of a client portfolio grows, the Company receives a smaller percentage of the increasing value as fee income. This is particularly important to the Company’s asset management, global funds services and global custody businesses. Significant declines in the values of capital assets, particularly equities, would reduce the market value of some of the assets the Company manages and administers and result in a corresponding decrease in the amount of fees the Company receives and therefore would have an adverse effect on the Company’s results of operations. Similarly, significant declines in the volume of capital markets activity would reduce the number of transactions the Company processes and the amount of securities lending the Company does and therefore would also have an adverse effect on its results of operations.

The Company’s business generally benefits when individuals invest their savings in mutual funds and other collective funds or in defined contribution pension plans. If there is a decline in the savings rates of individuals, or if there is a change in investment preferences that leads to less investment in mutual funds, other collective funds and defined contribution plans, the Company’s revenues could be adversely affected.

The Company’s fee-based revenues could be adversely affected by a stable exchange-rate environment or decreased cross-border investing activity.

The degree of volatility in foreign exchange rates can affect the amount of the Company’s foreign exchange trading revenue. While much of the Company’s foreign exchange revenue is derived from its securities servicing client base, activity levels are generally higher when there is more volatility. Accordingly, the Company benefits from currency volatility and its foreign exchange revenue is likely to decrease during times of decreased currency volatility.

The Company’s future revenue may increase or decrease depending upon the extent of increases or decreases in cross-border or other investments made by the Company’s clients. Economic and political uncertainties resulting from terrorist attacks, military actions or other events, including changes in laws or regulations governing cross-border transactions, such as currency controls, could result in decreased cross-border investment activity. Decreased cross-border investing could lead to decreased demand for investor services provided by the Company.

The Company’s ability to retain existing business and obtain new business is dependent on its consistent execution of the fee-based services it performs.

The Company provides custody, accounting, daily pricing and administration, master trust and master custody, investment management, trustee and recordkeeping, foreign exchange, securities lending, securities execution and clearance, correspondent clearing, stock transfer, cash management, trading and information services to clients worldwide. Assets under custody and assets under management are held by the Company in a custodial or fiduciary capacity and are not included in assets of the Company. If the Company fails to perform these services in a manner consistent with its fiduciary, custodial and other obligations, existing and potential clients may lose confidence in the Company’s ability to properly perform these services and the Company’s business may be adversely affected. In addition, any such failure may result in contingent liabilities that could have an adverse effect on the Company’s financial condition or losses that could have an adverse effect on the Company’s results of operations.

Interest Rate Environment—The Company’s revenues and profits are sensitive to changes in interest rates.

The Company’s net interest income and cash flows are sensitive to interest rate changes, changes in valuations in the debt or equity markets and changes in customer credit quality, over which the Company has no

 

128


Table of Contents

control. The Company’s net interest income is the difference between the interest income earned on the Company’s interest-earning assets, such as loans, and the interest expense incurred on its interest-bearing liabilities, such as deposits.

As a result of changes in interest rates the Company may experience one or more of the following effects:

 

    Changes in net interest income depending on the Company’s balance sheet position at the time of change. See discussion under “Asset/Liability Management” elsewhere in this report.

 

    Reduced credit demand due to sustained higher interest rates.

 

    An increased number of delinquencies, bankruptcies or defaults and more nonperforming assets and net charge offs as a result of abrupt increases in interest rates.

 

    Increased borrowing costs and reduced access to the capital markets caused by unfavorable financial conditions.

 

    Sustained lower interest rates, which may reduce the spread the Company earns on deposits.

 

    A decline in the value of the Company’s fixed income investment portfolio as a result of increasing interest rates.

 

    Decreased fee-based revenues due to a slowing of capital market activity or significant declines in market value.

A more detailed discussion of the interest rate and market risks the Company faces is contained in the Risk Management section of this report.

Capital Adequacy—The Company is subject to capital adequacy guidelines, and if it fails to meet these guidelines its financial condition would be adversely affected.

Under regulatory capital adequacy guidelines and other regulatory requirements, the Company and the Bank must meet guidelines that include quantitative measures of assets, liabilities and certain off-balance sheet items, subject to qualitative judgments by regulators about components, risk weightings and other factors. If the Company or the Bank failed to meet these minimum capital guidelines and other regulatory requirements, their respective financial conditions would be materially and adversely affected. The regulatory accords on international banking institutions to be reached by the Basel Committee on Banking Supervision and implemented by the Federal Reserve may require the Company and the Bank to satisfy additional, more stringent, capital adequacy standards. The Company cannot fully predict the final form of, or the effects of, the regulatory accords or implementing regulations. Failure by the Bank to maintain its status as “well capitalized” and “well managed”, if unremedied over a period of time, would cause the Company to lose its status as a financial holding company. Financial holding companies are permitted to engage in a wide range of financial activities, insurance, merchant banking and real estate investment that are not permissible for other bank holding companies and are also eligible for a streamlined review process for proposed acquisitions. Failure of the Bank or the Company to maintain the status of “well capitalized” could affect the confidence of clients in the Company, thus also compromising its competitive position. See “Certain Regulatory Considerations” and “Capital Resources” elsewhere in this report.

Access to Capital Markets—If the Company’s ability to access the capital markets is diminished, the Company’s business may be adversely affected.

The Company’s business is dependent in part on its ability to successfully access the capital markets on a regular basis. The Company relies on access to both short-term money markets and long-term capital markets as significant sources of liquidity to the extent liquidity requirements are not satisfied by the cash flow from its consolidated operations. Events or circumstances, such as rising interest rates, market disruptions or an adverse change in the Company’s credit rating, or loss of confidence of debt purchasers or counterparties in the Company

 

129


Table of Contents

or in the funds markets generally that limit the Company’s access to capital markets or result in unfavorable capital market conditions, may increase the Company’s cost of borrowing or may adversely affect the Company’s liquidity, impair its ability to execute its business plan and refinance higher cost debt or delay the consummation of acquisitions that the Company would otherwise rely on for future growth.

Acquisitions and Divestitures—The Company’s business strategy includes pursuing opportunistic acquisitions and divestitures, which subject it to related risks.

Historically, an important component of the Company’s overall growth strategy is to make focused acquisitions of complementary businesses, as well as strategic divestitures of portions of its business. Since 1995, the Company has completed more than 90 acquisitions, particularly in the securities servicing and asset management businesses. In addition, the Company enters into strategic joint ventures around the globe. While the level of transactions has been fairly consistent, acquisition activity, by its nature, is not predictable and involves risks such as:

 

    Lower than expected performance or higher than expected costs in connection with acquisitions and integration of acquired businesses;

 

    Potential unavailability of attractive acquisition candidates;

 

    Potential disruption to the Company’s management’s time and attention;

 

    Difficulty and expense of maintaining and integrating expensive technology components of the acquired businesses;

 

    Possible loss of employees and customers of the acquired company;

 

    Difficulty entering new and unfamiliar markets;

 

    Incurring undiscovered liabilities or operational risks associated with acquired company;

 

    Incorrectly valuing acquisition candidates; and

 

    The Company’s ability to realize the growth opportunities of acquired businesses and management’s ability to achieve efficiency goals.

Similarly, selling or agreeing to sell portions of the Company’s business may subject it to risks. The Company may not be able to successfully complete any divestitures on satisfactory terms, if at all, and proposed sales that are complex or time consuming could divert management resources. If the Company is unable to divest operations identified by management to be divestiture candidates its profitability and financial ratios could be adversely affected. The Company cannot provide any assurance that its overall business will benefit from any given divestiture. Divestitures may result in reductions in revenues and net income. The Company may also be subject to claims from buyers or third parties as a result of certain divestitures that the Company makes, even after those divestitures have been consummated.

The Company is subject to extensive government regulation and supervision.

The Company operates in a highly regulated environment, being subject to a comprehensive statutory regulatory regime as well as oversight by governmental agencies. In the United States the Company and its subsidiaries are subject to regulation by the Board of Governors of the Federal Reserve System (“Federal Reserve”), the New York State Banking Department and the Federal Deposit Insurance Corporation, as well as certain self-regulatory organizations (including securities exchanges). In the United Kingdom, it is subject to regulation by the Financial Services Authority. Banking regulations are primarily intended to protect depositors’ funds, federal deposit insurance funds and the banking system as a whole, not shareholders. These regulations affect the Company’s lending practices, capital structure, scope of activities, investment practices, dividend policy and growth, among other things. Failure to comply with laws, regulations or policies could result in sanctions by regulatory agencies, civil money penalties and/or reputational damage, which could have a material

 

130


Table of Contents

adverse effect on the Company’s business, financial condition and results of operations. Although the Company has policies and procedures designed to prevent any such violations, there can be no assurance that such violations will not occur. Laws, regulations or policies, including accounting standards and interpretations, currently affecting the Company and its subsidiaries may change at any time. Regulatory authorities may also change their interpretation of these statutes and regulations. Therefore, the Company’s business may be adversely affected by future changes in laws, regulations, policies or interpretations or regulatory approaches to compliance and enforcement. See “Certain Regulatory Considerations” elsewhere in this report.

Monetary and Other Governmental Policies—The Company’s business is influenced by monetary and other governmental policies.

The monetary, tax and other policies of the government and its agencies, including the Federal Reserve have a significant impact on interest rates and overall financial market performance. Heightened regulatory scrutiny and increased sanctions, changes or potential changes in domestic and international legislation and regulation as well as domestic or international regulatory investigations impose compliance, legal, review and response costs that may impact the Company’s profitability and may allow additional competition, facilitate consolidation of competitors, or attract new competitors into the Company’s businesses. The cost of geographically diversifying and maintaining the Company’s facilities to comply with regulatory mandates necessarily results in additional costs. See “Certain Regulatory Considerations” elsewhere in this report.

Operational Risk—The Company is exposed to operational risk as a result of providing certain services, which could adversely affect the Company’s results of operations.

The Company is exposed to operational risk as a result of providing certain securities servicing, global payment services, private client services and asset management and traditional banking and trust services. Operational risk is the risk of loss resulting from inadequate or failed internal processes, human factors and systems or external events. The Company continually assesses and monitors operational risk in its business and provides for disaster and business recovery planning including geographical diversification of its facilities; however, the occurrence of various events including unforeseeable and unpreventable events such as hurricanes or other natural disasters could still damage the Company’s physical facilities or its computer systems or software, cause delay or disruptions to operational functions, impair the Company’s clients, vendors and counterparties and negatively impact the Company’s results of operations.

The Company’s controls and procedures may fail or be circumvented.

Management regularly reviews and updates the Company’s internal controls, disclosure controls and procedures, and corporate governance policies and procedures. Any system of controls, however well designed and operated, is based in part on certain assumptions and can provide only reasonable, not absolute, assurances that the objectives of the system are met. Any failure or circumvention of the Company’s controls and procedures or failure to comply with regulations related to controls and procedures could have a material adverse effect on the Company’s business, results of operations and financial condition.

The Company’s information systems may experience an interruption or breach in security.

The Company relies heavily on communications and information systems to conduct its business. Any failure, interruption or breach in security of these systems could result in failures or disruptions in the Company’s customer relationship management, general ledger, deposit, loan and other systems. While the Company has policies and procedures designed to prevent or limit the effect of the failure, interruption or security breach of its information systems, there can be no assurance that any such failures, interruptions or security breaches will not occur or, if they do occur, that they will be adequately addressed. The occurrence of any failures, interruptions or security breaches of the Company’s information systems could damage the Company’s reputation, result in a loss of customer business, subject the Company to additional regulatory scrutiny, or expose the Company to civil

 

131


Table of Contents

litigation and possible financial liability, any of which could have a material adverse effect on the Company’s financial condition and results of operations. See the section captioned “Certain Regulatory Considerations,” elsewhere in this report.

Technology—The Company depends on technology and its intellectual property; if third parties misappropriate the Company’s intellectual property, the Company’s business may be adversely affected.

The Company is dependent on technology because many of the Company’s products and services depend on processing large volumes of data. The Company’s technology platforms must therefore provide global capabilities and scale. Rapid technological changes require significant and ongoing investments in technology to develop competitive new products and services or adopt new technologies. Technological advances which result in lower transaction costs may adversely impact the Company’s revenues.

Developments in the securities processing industry, including shortened settlement cycles and straight-through-processing, will necessitate ongoing changes to the Company’s business and operations and will likely require additional investment in technology. The Company’s financial performance depends in part on its ability to develop and market new and innovative services, to adopt or develop new technologies that differentiate its products or provide cost efficiencies and to deliver these products and services to the market at a competitive price.

The Company uses trademark, trade secret, copyright and other proprietary rights and procedures to protect its intellectual property and technology resources. Despite the Company’s efforts, it cannot be certain that the steps it takes to prevent unauthorized use of its proprietary rights are sufficient to prevent misappropriation of its technology, particularly in foreign countries where laws or law enforcement practices may not protect its proprietary rights as fully as in the United States. In addition, the Company cannot be sure that courts will adequately enforce contractual arrangements it has entered into to protect its proprietary technologies. If any of the Company’s proprietary information were misappropriated by or otherwise disclosed to the Company’s competitors, its competitive position could be adversely affected. The Company may incur substantial costs to defend ownership of its intellectual property or to replace misappropriated proprietary technology. If a third party were to assert a claim of infringement of its proprietary rights, obtained through patents or otherwise, against the Company with respect to one or more of its methods of doing business or conducting its operations, the Company would be required to spend significant amounts to defend such claims, develop alternative methods of operations or obtain a license from the third party.

Acts of Terrorism—Acts of terrorism may have a continuing negative impact on the Company’s business.

Acts of terrorism could have a significant impact on the Company’s business and operations. While the Company has in place business continuity and disaster recovery plans, acts of terrorism could still damage the Company’s facilities and disrupt or delay normal operations, and have a similar impact on the Company’s clients, suppliers, and counterparties. Acts of terrorism could also negatively impact the purchase of the Company’s products and services to the extent they resulted in reduced capital markets activity, lower asset price levels, or disruptions in general economic activity in the United States or abroad, or in financial market settlement functions. The war in Iraq, the national and global efforts to combat terrorism and other potential military activities and outbreaks of hostilities have affected and may further adversely affect economic growth, and may have other adverse effects on the Company in ways that the Company is necessarily unable to predict.

The Company’s expenses have increased as a result of its responses to and new requirements to which the Company is subject as a result of the September 11, 2001 terrorist attacks. Among these responses have been actions taken to enhance the Company’s capabilities, disperse its operations and establish redundancies to avoid future disruptions in processing in the event of terrorist attacks or natural catastrophes. The Company has made substantial capital outlays for physical plant and computers and communications equipment, and will incur future costs to maintain such facilities. These and other costs are not by their nature intended to enhance profitability, and the Company cannot predict whether further new requirements will be imposed upon it or whether such new investments will be deemed prudent in the future, and, in either case, cause it to incur significant expenses unrelated to the enhancement of its operations and financial performance.

 

132


Table of Contents

Reputational and Legal Risk—The Company’s business may be negatively affected by adverse publicity, regulatory actions or litigation with respect to the Company, other well-known companies and the financial services industry generally.

Adverse publicity and damage to the Company’s reputation arising from its failure or perceived failure to comply with legal and regulatory requirements, financial reporting irregularities involving other large and well known companies, increasing regulatory scrutiny of “know your customer” anti-money laundering and anti-terrorist financing procedures and their effectiveness, regulatory investigations of the mutual fund industry, including mutual funds advised by the Company, and litigation that arises from the failure or perceived failure of the Company to comply with legal and regulatory requirements, could result in increased regulatory supervision, affect the Company’s ability to attract and retain customers or maintain access to the capital markets, result in suits, enforcement actions, fines and penalties or have adverse effects on the Company in ways that are not predictable.

Uncertainty surrounding recently enacted legislation and regulatory changes under consideration in the securities industry, as well as investigations by various federal and state regulatory agencies, the Department of Justice and state attorneys general, and any related litigation, could have an adverse effect on investment activity generally and on the Company.

The Company’s subsidiaries are subject to claims and litigation pertaining to fiduciary responsibility.

From time to time, customers of the Company’s subsidiaries may make claims and take legal action pertaining to performance of fiduciary responsibilities. Whether customer claims and legal action related to the subsidiary’s performance of its fiduciary responsibilities are founded or unfounded, if such claims and legal actions are not resolved in a manner favorable to the subsidiary they may result in financial liability and/or adversely affect the market perception of the Company and its products and services as well as impact customer demand for those products and services. Any financial liability or reputation damage could have a material adverse effect on the Company’s business, which, in turn, could have a material adverse effect on the Company’s financial condition and results of operations.

New lines of business or new products and services may subject the Company to additional risks.

From time to time, the Company may implement new lines of business or offer new products and services within existing lines of business. There are substantial risks and uncertainties associated with these efforts, particularly in instances where the markets are not fully developed. In developing and marketing new lines of business and/or new products and services the Company may invest significant time and resources. Initial timetables for the introduction and development of new lines of business and/or new products or services may not be achieved and price and profitability targets may not prove feasible. External factors, such as compliance with regulations, competitive alternatives, and shifting market preferences, may also impact the successful implementation of a new line of business or a new product or service. Furthermore, any new line of business and/or new product or service could have a significant impact on the effectiveness of the Company’s system of internal controls. Failure to successfully manage these risks in the development and implementation of new lines of business or new products or services could have a material adverse effect on the Company’s business, results of operations and financial condition.

The Company may not be able to attract and retain skilled people.

The Company’s success depends, in large part, on its ability to attract and retain key people. Competition for the best people in most activities engaged in by the Company can be intense and the Company may not be able to hire people or to retain them. The unexpected loss of services of one or more of the Company’s key personnel could have a material adverse impact on the Company’s business because of their skills, knowledge of the Company’s market, years of industry experience and the difficulty of promptly finding qualified replacement personnel.

 

133


Table of Contents

Tax Laws and Regulations—Tax law changes or challenges by federal or state authorities to the Company’s tax positions with respect to historical transactions by federal or state authorities may adversely affect the Company’s net income, effective tax rate and the Company’s overall results of operations and financial condition.

The U.S. Treasury and Internal Revenue Service (“IRS”) have taken increasingly aggressive positions against certain corporate investment programs that either reduce or defer taxes. The IRS has challenged certain types of structured leasing investments referred to as LILOs, in which the Company engaged prior to mid-1999 and SILOs in which the Company engaged prior to 2004. See “Commitments and Contingent Liabilities” in the Notes to the Consolidated Financial Statements.

The Company has also entered into investments that produce synthetic fuel from coal byproducts. Section 29 of the Internal Revenue Code provides a tax credit for these types of transactions. The amount of the credit is dependent on the amount of synthetic fuel produced by these investments. Synthetic fuel production can be impacted by mine, workforce, transportation, and weather conditions among other factors. The tax credits available under Section 29 of the Internal Revenue Code for the production and sale of synthetic fuel produced in any given year are phased out if the reference price of a barrel of oil for that year falls within a specified, inflation-adjusted price range.

The Company estimates that the 2006 phase-out would begin if, for the entire calendar year of 2006, reference prices correspond to popularly published spot prices of approximately $59 for a barrel of oil and the credit would fully phase-out at popularly published spot prices of $73 for a barrel of oil. Tax legislation is currently pending before Congress which could mitigate the effect of the phase-out. If the legislation is not enacted, the Company anticipates a substantial phase-out for 2006.

The Company believes it has adequate tax reserves to cover its LILO exposure and any other potential tax exposures the IRS is likely to raise. Probabilities and outcomes are reviewed as events unfold, and adjustments to the reserves are made when necessary, but the reserves may prove inadequate because the Company necessarily cannot accurately predict the outcome of any challenge, settlement or litigation or to what extent it will negatively affect the Company or its business.

Going forward, there may be fewer opportunities to participate in lease investing, tax credit programs and similar transactions that have benefited the Company in the past. This may adversely impact the Company’s net interest income and effective tax rate. In addition, changes in tax legislation or the interpretation of existing tax laws worldwide could have a material impact on the Company’s results of operations.

Accounting Principles—Changes in accounting standards could have a material impact on the Company’s financial statements.

From time to time, the Financial Accounting Standards Board, the SEC, and bank regulators change the financial accounting and reporting standards governing the preparation of the Company’s financial statements. These changes are very difficult to predict and can materially impact how the Company records and reports its financial condition and results of operations and other financial data, although, in certain instances, these changes may not have an economic impact on the Company’s business. In some cases, the Company could be required to apply a new or revised standard retroactively, resulting in the Company restating prior period financial statements.

Loan Reserves—The Company could incur income statement charges if its loan reserves are inadequate.

The Company has credit exposure to the airline, automotive, and telecommunications industries, as well as to many other industries. The Company cannot provide any assurance as to whether charge-offs related to these

 

134


Table of Contents

sectors or to different credit risks may occur in the future. Though credit risk is inherent to lending activities, the Company’s revenues and profitability are adversely affected when its borrowers default in whole or in part on their loan obligations to it. The Company relies on its business experience to estimate future defaults, which it uses to create loan loss reserves against its loan portfolio. It cannot provide any assurance that these reserves, based on management estimates, will not be required to be augmented due to an unexpectedly high level of defaults. If loan reserves are not sufficient, the Company would be required to record a larger loan reserve against current earnings.

Holding Company—The Company is a holding company, and as a result is dependent on dividends from its subsidiaries, including the Bank, to meet its obligations, including its obligations with respect to its debt securities, and to provide funds for payment of dividends to its shareholders.

The Company is a non-operating holding company, whose principal asset and source of income is its investment in the Bank. The Company is a legal entity separate and distinct from the Bank and its other subsidiaries and, therefore, it relies primarily on dividends from these subsidiaries to meet its obligations, including its obligations with respect to its debt securities, and to provide funds for payment of dividends to its shareholders, to the extent declared by its board of directors. There are various legal limitations on the extent to which the Bank and the other subsidiaries can finance or otherwise supply funds to the Company (by dividend or otherwise) and certain of its affiliates. Although the Company maintains cash positions for liquidity at the holding company level, if the Bank or other of the Company’s subsidiaries were unable to supply the Company with cash over time, it could be unable to meet its obligations, including its obligations with respect to its debt securities, or declare or pay dividends in respect of its capital stock. See “Certain Regulatory Considerations” elsewhere in this report.

Because the Company is a holding company, its rights and the rights of its creditors, including the holders of its debt securities, to a share of the assets of any subsidiary upon the liquidation or recapitalization of the subsidiary will be subject to the prior claims of the subsidiary’s creditors (including, in the case of the Bank and The Bank of New York (Delaware), their depositors), except to the extent that the Company may itself be a creditor with recognized claims against the subsidiary. The rights of holders of the Company’s debt securities to benefit from those distributions will also be junior to those prior claims. Consequently, the debt securities of the Company will be effectively subordinated to all existing and future liabilities of the Company’s subsidiaries. A holder of Company debt securities should look only to the Company’s assets for payments in respect of those debt securities.

Anti-Takeover Provisions—Regulatory requirements, state corporation law and provisions of the Company’s certificate of incorporation and bylaws could delay, deter or prevent a takeover attempt that shareholders might perceive to be in their best interests.

Provisions of the Company’s articles of incorporation and by-laws, federal banking laws and the New York State Business Corporation Law could make it more difficult for a third party to acquire the Company, even if doing so would be perceived as beneficial to the Company’s shareholders. The combination of these provisions may hinder or prevent companies or persons from acquiring control of the Company without the consent of its board of directors, even in the event that a potential acquiror were to offer a premium over the then-prevailing price of its common stock, thus potentially adversely affecting the market price of its common stock.

 

135


Table of Contents

WEBSITE INFORMATION

The Company makes available on its website: www.bankofny.com

 

    All of its SEC filings, including annual report on Form 10-K, quarterly reports on Form 10-Q, current reports on Form 8-K and all amendments to these reports, SEC Forms 3, 4 and 5 and its proxy statement as soon as reasonably practicable after such material is electronically filed with or furnished to the SEC,

 

    Its earnings releases and management conference calls and presentations, and

 

    Its corporate governance guidelines and the charters of the Audit and Examining, Compensation and Organization and Nominating and Governance Committees of its Board of Directors.

The corporate governance guidelines and committee charters are available in print to any shareholder who requests them. Requests should be sent to The Bank of New York Company, Inc., Corporate Communications, One Wall Street, NY, NY 10286.

CODE OF ETHICS

The Company has adopted a code of ethics which it refers to as its Code of Conduct. The Code of Conduct applies to all employees of the Company and its subsidiaries, including its Chief Executive Officer (principal executive officer), Chief Financial Officer (principal financial officer) and Comptroller, as well as to directors of the Company. The Code of Conduct is posted on the Company’s website http://www.bankofny.com and is also available in print, without charge, to any shareholder who requests it. Requests should be sent to The Bank of New York Company, Inc., Corporate Communications, One Wall Street, NY, NY 10286. The Company intends to disclose on its website any amendments to or waiver of the Code of Conduct relating to executive officers (including the Specified Officers) or its directors.

 

136


Table of Contents

C ONTROLS AND PROCEDURES

Disclosure Controls and Procedures

The Company’s Disclosure Committee has responsibility for ensuring that there is an adequate and effective process for establishing, maintaining, and evaluating disclosure controls and procedures for the Company in connection with its external disclosures.

An evaluation was carried out under the supervision and with the participation of the Company’s management, including the Chief Executive Officer and Chief Financial Officer, of the effectiveness of the Company’s disclosure controls and procedures as defined in Exchange Act Rule 13a-15(e). Based on that evaluation, the Chief Executive Officer and Chief Financial Officer concluded that the Company’s disclosure controls and procedures were effective as of the end of the period covered by this annual report.

Management Report on Internal Controls Over Financial Reporting

The Company’s management is responsible for establishing and maintaining adequate internal control over financial reporting that is designed to provide reasonable assurance regarding the reliability of financial reporting and the preparation of financial statements in accordance with accounting principles generally accepted in the United States (“GAAP”).

The Company’s internal control over financial reporting includes those policies and procedures that:

 

    Pertain to the maintenance of records that, in reasonable detail, accurately and fairly reflect the transactions and dispositions of the assets of the Company;

 

    Provide reasonable assurance that transactions are recorded as necessary to permit preparation of financial statements in accordance with GAAP, and that the Company’s receipts and expenditures are being made only in accordance with authorizations of the Company’s management and directors; and

 

    Provide reasonable assurance regarding the prevention or timely detection of unauthorized acquisition, use or disposition of the Company’s assets that could have a material effect on the Company’s financial statements.

Any system of internal control, no matter how well designed, has inherent limitations, including the possibility that a control can be circumvented or overridden and misstatements due to error or fraud may occur and not be detected. Also, because of changes in conditions, internal control effectiveness may vary over time. Accordingly, projections of any evaluation of effectiveness to future periods are subject to the risk that controls may become inadequate because of changed conditions, or that the degree of compliance with the policies or procedures may deteriorate.

Management assessed the effectiveness of the Company’s internal control over financial reporting as of December 31, 2005. In making this assessment, the Company’s management used the criteria set forth by the Committee of Sponsoring Organizations of the Treadway Commission in Internal Control - Integrated Framework. Based on this assessment, management believes that, as of December 31, 2005, the Company’s internal control over financial reporting is effective.

In November 2005, the Company moved its production data center to an out-of-region location in the mid-South region of the United States, centralizing the Company’s production sites. This was done in response to guidelines promulgated by the Federal Reserve Bank of New York, the Company’s primary regulator, stating that certain institutions important to the national financial infrastructure should provide geographical separation between production and recovery sites. The new data center allows the Company to consolidate the Company’s three primary production data centers into a single location, and in conjunction with a major site over 700 miles away, provides redundancy appropriate for the institution.

The Company’s independent registered public accounting firm, Ernst & Young LLP, has issued an audit report on management’s assessment of the Company’s internal control over financial reporting, which is included herein.

 

137


Table of Contents

AUDITOR’S ATTESTATION REPORT

Report of Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm

To The Board of Directors and Shareholders of The Bank of New York Company, Inc.

We have audited management’s assessment, included in the accompanying Management Report on Internal Controls Over Financial Reporting, that The Bank of New York Company, Inc. (the “Company”) maintained effective internal control over financial reporting as of December 31, 2005, based on criteria established in Internal Control—Integrated Framework issued by the Committee of Sponsoring Organizations of the Treadway Commission (the COSO criteria). The Company’s management is responsible for maintaining effective internal control over financial reporting and for its assessment of the effectiveness of internal control over financial reporting. Our responsibility is to express an opinion on management’s assessment and an opinion on the effectiveness of the company’s internal control over financial reporting based on our audit.

We conducted our audit in accordance with the standards of the Public Company Accounting Oversight Board (United States). Those standards require that we plan and perform the audit to obtain reasonable assurance about whether effective internal control over financial reporting was maintained in all material respects. Our audit included obtaining an understanding of internal control over financial reporting, evaluating management’s assessment, testing and evaluating the design and operating effectiveness of internal control, and performing such other procedures as we considered necessary in the circumstances. We believe that our audit provides a reasonable basis for our opinion.

A company’s internal control over financial reporting is a process designed to provide reasonable assurance regarding the reliability of financial reporting and the preparation of financial statements for external purposes in accordance with generally accepted accounting principles. Because management’s assessment and our audit were conducted to also meet the reporting requirements of Section 112 of the Federal Deposit Insurance Corporation Improvement Act (FDICIA), management’s assessment and our audit of The Bank of New York Company Inc.’s internal control over financial reporting included controls over the preparation of financial statements in accordance with the instructions for the preparation of Consolidated Financial Statements for Bank Holding Companies (Form FRY-9C). A company’s internal control over financial reporting includes those policies and procedures that (1) pertain to the maintenance of records that, in reasonable detail, accurately and fairly reflect the transactions and dispositions of the assets of the company; (2) provide reasonable assurance that transactions are recorded as necessary to permit preparation of financial statements in accordance with generally accepted accounting principles, and that receipts and expenditures of the company are being made only in accordance with authorizations of management and directors of the company; and (3) provide reasonable assurance regarding prevention or timely detection of unauthorized acquisition, use, or disposition of the company’s assets that could have a material effect on the financial statements.

Because of its inherent limitations, internal control over financial reporting may not prevent or detect misstatements. Also, projections of any evaluation of effectiveness to future periods are subject to the risk that controls may become inadequate because of changes in conditions, or that the degree of compliance with the policies or procedures may deteriorate.

In our opinion, management’s assessment that The Bank of New York Company, Inc. maintained effective internal control over financial reporting as of December 31, 2005, is fairly stated, in all material respects, based on the COSO criteria. Also, in our opinion, The Bank of New York Company, Inc. maintained, in all material respects, effective internal control over financial reporting as of December 31, 2005, based on the COSO criteria.

We also have audited, in accordance with the standards of the Public Company Accounting Oversight Board (United States), the consolidated balance sheets of The Bank of New York Company, Inc. as of December 31, 2005 and 2004, and the related consolidated statements of income, changes in shareholders’ equity, and cash flows for each of the three years in the period ended December 31, 2005 and our reported dated February 22, 2006 expressed an unqualified opinion thereon.

/s/    ERNST & YOUNG LLP        

New York, New York

February 22, 2006

 

138


Table of Contents

SIGNATURES

Pursuant to the requirements of Section 13 or 15(d) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, the registrant has duly caused this report to be signed on its behalf by the undersigned, hereunto duly authorized in New York, New York, on the 24th day of February, 2006.

 

The Bank of New York Company, Inc.

By:

 

/s/    THOMAS J. MASTRO        

 

Thomas J. Mastro

Comptroller

Pursuant to the requirements of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, this report has been duly signed below by the following persons on behalf of the registrant and in the capacities and on the dates indicated.

 

Signature

  

Title

 

Date

/S/    THOMAS A. RENYI        

Thomas A. Renyi

  

Chairman of the Board,
Chief Executive Officer
(Principal Executive Officer), and Director

  February 24, 2006

/S/    GERALD L. HASSELL        

Gerald L. Hassell

  

President and Director

  February 24, 2006

/S/    BRUCE W. VAN SAUN        

Bruce W. Van Saun

  

Vice Chairman and
Chief Financial Officer
(Principal Financial Officer)

  February 24, 2006

/S/    THOMAS J. MASTRO        

Thomas J. Mastro

  

Comptroller
(Principal Accounting Officer)

  February 24, 2006

/S/    FRANK J. BIONDI, JR.        

Frank J. Biondi, Jr.

  

Director

  February 24, 2006

/S/    NICHOLAS M. DONOFRIO        

Nicholas M. Donofrio

  

Director

  February 24, 2006

/S/    RICHARD J. KOGAN        

Richard J. Kogan

  

Director

  February 24, 2006

/S/    MICHAEL J. KOWALSKI        

Michael J. Kowalski

  

Director

  February 24, 2006

/S/    JOHN A. LUKE, JR.        

John A. Luke, Jr.

  

Director

  February 24, 2006

/S/    JOHN C. MALONE        

John C. Malone

  

Director

  February 24, 2006

/S/    PAUL MYNERS        

Paul Myners

  

Director

  February 24, 2006

/S/    CATHERINE A. REIN        

Catherine A. Rein

  

Director

  February 24, 2006

 

139


Table of Contents

Signature

  

Title

 

Date

/S/    WILLIAM C. RICHARDSON        

William C. Richardson

  

Director

  February 24, 2006

/S/    BRIAN L. ROBERTS        

Brian L. Roberts

  

Director

  February 24, 2006

/S/    SAMUEL C. SCOTT III        

Samuel C. Scott III

  

Director

  February 24, 2006

/S/    RICHARD C. VAUGHAN        

Richard C. Vaughan

  

Director

  February 24, 2006

 

140


Table of Contents

E XHIBITS AND FINANCIAL STATEMENT SCHEDULES

 

Financial Statement Filed

   Pages

The Bank of New York Company, Inc.
Consolidated Financial Statements

   71 - 74

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements

   75 - 113

Report of Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm

   114

Financial statement schedules are omitted since the required information is either not applicable, not deemed material, or is shown in the respective financial statements or in the notes thereto.

The exhibits filed as part of the 2005 Form 10-K are accessible at no cost on the Company’s Website at www.bankofny.com or through the United States Securities and Exchange Commission’s Website at www.sec.gov. Printed copies of the exhibits may be obtained by shareholders of record for $0.15 per page by writing to Patricia Bicket, Secretary, The Bank of New York, One Wall Street, New York, NY 10286.

The following Exhibit Index lists the Exhibits to the Annual Report on Form 10-K.

 

Exhibit No.

    
3(a)    The By-Laws of The Bank of New York Company, Inc. as amended through April 12, 2005 incorporated by reference to Exhibit 3(ii) to the Company’s Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q for the quarter ended March 31, 2005.
  (b)    Restated Certificate of Incorporation of The Bank of New York Company, Inc. dated May 8, 2001, incorporated by reference to Exhibit 4 to the Company’s Registration Statement on Form S-3 filed June 7, 2001 (File No. 333-62516, 333-62516-01, 333-62516-02, 333-62516-03 and 333-62516-04).
4(a)    None of the outstanding instruments defining the rights of holders of long-term debt of the Company represent long-term debt in excess of 10% of the total assets of the Company. The Company hereby agrees to furnish to the Commission, upon request, a copy of any of such instrument.
*10(a)    Trust Agreement dated November 16, 1993 (“Trust Agreement”) related to certain executive compensation plans and agreements, incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10(m) to the Company’s Annual Report on Form 10-K for the year ended December 31, 1993.
*(b)    Amendment Number 1 dated May 13, 1994 to the Trust Agreement related to executive compensation agreements incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10(b) to the Company’s Annual Report on Form 10-K for the year ended December 31, 2003.
*(c)    Amendment Number 2 dated April 11, 1995 to the Trust Agreement related to executive compensation agreements incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10(c) to the Company’s Annual Report on Form 10-K for the year ended December 31, 2003.
*(d)    Amendment dated October 11, 1994 to Trust Agreement related to certain executive compensation plans and agreements, incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10(r) to the Company’s Annual Report on Form 10-K for the year ended December 31, 1994.
*(e)    Amendment Number 4 dated January 31, 1996 to the Trust Agreement related to executive compensation agreements incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10(e) to the Company’s Annual Report on Form 10-K for the year ended December 31, 2003.
*(f)    Amendment Number 5 dated January 14, 1997 to the Trust Agreement related to executive compensation agreements, incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10(d) to the Company’s Annual Report on Form 10-K for the year ended December 31, 1996.

 

141


Table of Contents

Exhibit No.

    
*(g)    Amendment Number 6 dated January 31, 1997 to the Trust Agreement related to executive compensation agreements, incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10(c) to the Company’s Annual Report on Form 10-K for the year ended December 31, 1996.
*(h)    Amendment Number 7 dated May 9, 1997 to the Trust Agreement related to executive compensation agreements incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10(h) to the Company’s Annual Report on Form 10-K for the year ended December 31, 2003.
*(i)    Amendment Number 8 dated July 8, 1997 to the Trust Agreement related to executive compensation agreements incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10(i) to the Company’s Annual Report on Form 10-K for the year ended December 31, 2003.
*(j)    Amendment Number 9 dated October 1, 1997 to the Trust Agreement related to executive compensation agreements, incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10(a) to the Company’s Annual Report on Form 10-K for the year ended December 31, 1997.
*(k)    Amendment Number 10 dated September 11, 1998 to the Trust Agreement related to executive compensation agreements, incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10(oo) to the Company’s Annual Report on Form 10-K for the year ended December 31, 1998.
*(l)    Amendment Number 11 dated December 23, 1999 to the Trust Agreement related to executive compensation, incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10(gg) to the Company’s Annual Report on Form 10-K for the year ended December 31, 1999.
*(m)    Amendment Number 12 dated July 11, 2000 to the Trust Agreement related to executive compensation agreements, incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10(f) to the Company’s Annual Report on Form 10-Q for quarter ended September 30, 2000.
*(n)    Amendment Number 13 dated January 22, 2001 to the Trust Agreement related to executive compensation agreements incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10(jjj) to the Company’s Annual Report on Form 10-K for the year ended December 31, 2000.
*(o)    Amendment Number 14 dated June 28, 2002 to the Trust Agreement related to executive compensation agreements incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10(o) to the Company’s Annual Report on Form 10-K for the year ended December 31, 2003.
*(p)    Amendment Number 15 dated June 30, 2003 to the Trust Agreement related to executive compensation agreements incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10(p) to the Company’s Annual Report on Form 10-K for the year ended December 31, 2003.
*(q)    Amendment Number 16 dated September 15, 2003 to the Trust Agreement related to executive compensation agreements incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10(q) to the Company’s Annual Report on Form 10-K for the year ended December 31, 2003.
*(r)    Amendment Number 17 dated June 10, 2004 to the Trust Agreement related to executive compensation agreements incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10(r) to the Company’s Annual Report on Form 10-K for the year ended December 31, 2004.
*(s)    Amendment Number 18 dated June 29, 2005 to the Trust Agreement related to executive compensation agreements.
*(t)    Compensation Agreement dated April 17, 1997, incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10(g) to the Company’s Annual Report on Form 10-K for the year ended December 31, 1997.
*(u)    The Bank of New York Company, Inc. Excess Contribution Plan as amended through July 10, 1990, incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10(b) to the Company’s Annual Report on Form 10-K for the year ended December 31, 1990.

 

142


Table of Contents
Exhibit No.      
* (v)   Amendments dated February 23, 1994 and November 9, 1993 to The Bank of New York Company, Inc. Excess Contribution Plan, incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10(c) to the Company’s Annual Report on Form 10-K for the year ended December 31, 1993.
* (w)   Amendment to The Bank of New York Company, Inc. Excess Contribution Plan dated November 14, 1995, incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10(l) to the Company’s Annual Report on Form 10-K for the year ended December 31, 1997.
* (x)   Amendment to The Bank of New York Company, Inc. Excess Contribution Plan dated November 12, 2002 incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10(v) to the Company’s Annual Report on Form 10-K for the year ended December 31, 2003.
* (y)   The Bank of New York Company, Inc. Excess Benefit Plan as amended through December 8, 1992, incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10(d) to the Company’s Annual Report on Form 10-K for the year ended December 31, 1993.
* (z)   Amendment dated May 10, 1994 to The Bank of New York Company, Inc. Excess Benefit Plan, incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10(g) to the Company’s Annual Report on Form 10-K for the year ended December 31, 1994.
* (aa)   Amendment dated November 14, 1995 to The Bank of New York Company, Inc. Excess Benefit Plan, incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10(i) to the Company’s Annual Report on Form 10-K for the year ended December 31, 1995.
* (bb)   Amendment dated December 10, 1996 to The Bank of New York Company, Inc. Excess Benefit Plan, incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10(kk) to the Company’s Annual Report on Form 10-K for the year ended December 31, 1999.
* (cc)   2004 Management Incentive Compensation Plan of The Bank of New York Company, Inc. as Amended and Restated, incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10(a) to the Company’s Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q for the quarter ended March 31, 2004.
* (dd)   The Bank of New York Company, Inc. 2003 Long-Term Incentive Plan, incorporated by reference to Exhibit B to the Company’s Definitive Proxy Statement dated March 31, 2003.
* (ee)   Amendment dated December 28, 2005 to the 2003 Long-Term Incentive Plan of The Bank of New York Company, Inc.,
* (ff)   1988 Long-Term Incentive Plan as amended through December 8, 1992, incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10(f) to the Company’s Annual Report on Form 10-K for the year ended December 31, 1992.
* (gg)   Amendment dated October 11, 1994 to the 1988 Long-Term Incentive Plan of The Bank of New York Company, Inc., incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10(j) to the Company’s Annual Report on Form 10-K for the year ended December 31, 1994.
* (hh)   The Bank of New York Company, Inc. 1993 Long-Term Incentive Plan, incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10(m) to the Company’s Annual Report on Form 10-K for the year ended December 31, 1992.
* (ii)   Amendment dated October 11, 1994 to the 1993 Long-Term Incentive Plan of The Bank of New York Company, Inc., incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10(l) to the Company’s Annual Report on Form 10-K for the year ended December 31, 1994.
* (jj)   Amendment dated December 10, 1996 to the 1993 Long-Term Incentive Plan of The Bank of New York Company, Inc., incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10(g) to the Company’s Annual Report on Form 10-K for the year ended December 31, 1996.

 

143


Table of Contents
Exhibit No.     
*(kk)    Amendment dated January 14, 1997 to the 1993 Long-Term Incentive Plan of The Bank of New York Company, Inc., incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10(h) to the Company’s Annual Report on Form 10-K for the year ended December 31, 1996.
*(ll)    Amendment dated March 11, 1997 to the 1993 Long-Term Incentive Plan of The Bank of New York Company, Inc., incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10(i) to the Company’s Annual Report on Form 10-K for the year ended December 31, 1996.
*(mm)    Amendment dated July 14, 1998 to the 1993 Long-Term Incentive Plan of The Bank of New York Company, Inc. incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10(z) to the Company’s Annual Report on Form 10-K for the year ended December 31, 1998.
*(nn)    Amendment dated July 11, 2000 to The Bank of New York Company, Inc. 1993 Long-Term Incentive Plan, incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10(a) to the Company’s Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q for the quarter ended September 30, 2000.
*(oo)    The Bank of New York Company, Inc. 1999 Long-Term Incentive Plan, incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10(aa) to the Company’s Annual Report on Form 10-K for the year ended December 31, 1998.
*(pp)    Amendment dated July 11, 2000 to The Bank of New York Company, Inc. 1999 Long-Term Incentive Plan, incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10(b) to the Company’s Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q for the quarter ended September 30, 2000.
*(qq)    Amendment dated December 28, 2005 to the 1999 Long-Term Incentive Plan of The Bank of New York Company, Inc.
*(rr)    The Bank of New York Company, Inc. Supplemental Executive Retirement Plan, incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10(n) to the Company’s Annual Report on Form 10-K for the year ended December 31, 1992.
*(ss)    Amendment dated March 9, 1993 to The Bank of New York Company, Inc. Supplemental Executive Retirement Plan, incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10(k) to the Company’s Annual Report on Form 10-K for the year ended December 31, 1993.
*(tt)    Amendment effective October 11, 1994 to The Bank of New York Company, Inc. Supplemental Executive Retirement Plan, incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10(o) to the Company’s Annual Report on Form 10-K for the year ended December 31, 1994.
*(uu)    Amendment dated June 11, 1996 to The Bank of New York Company, Inc. Supplemental Executive Retirement Plan, incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10(a) to the Company’s Annual Report on Form 10-K for the year ended December 31, 1996.
*(vv)    Amendment dated November 12, 1996 to The Bank of New York Company, Inc. Supplemental Executive Retirement Plan, incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10(b) to the Company’s Annual Report on Form 10-K for the year ended December 31, 1996.
*(ww)    Amendment dated July 11, 2000 to The Bank of New York Company, Inc. Supplemental Executive Retirement Plan, incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10(e) to the Company’s Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q for the quarter ended September 30, 2000.
*(xx)    Amendment dated February 13, 2001 to The Bank of New York Company, Inc. Supplemental Executive Retirement Plan incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10(ggg) to the Company’s Annual Report on Form 10-K for the year ended December 31, 2000.
*(yy)    Amendment dated December 13, 2005 to The Bank of New York Company, Inc. Supplemental Executive Retirement Plan.

 

144


Table of Contents

Exhibit No.

    
    *(zz)    Deferred Compensation Plan for Non-Employee Directors of The Bank of New York Company, Inc., incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10(s) to the Company’s Annual Report on Form 10-K for the year ended December 31, 1993.
    *(aaa)    Amendment dated November 8, 1994 to Deferred Compensation Plan for Non-Employee Directors of The Bank of New York Company, Inc., incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10(z) to the Company’s Annual Report on Form 10-K for the year ended December 31, 1994.
    *(bbb)    Amendment dated February 11, 1997 to the Directors’ Deferred Compensation Plan for The Bank of New York Company, Inc., incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10(j) to the Company’s Annual Report on Form 10-K for the year ended December 31, 1996.
    *(ccc)    Amendment to Deferred Compensation Plan for Non-Employee Directors of The Bank of New York Company, Inc., incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10(d) to the Company’s Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q for the quarter ended September 30, 2000.
    *(ddd)    Amendment dated November 12, 2002 to Deferred Compensation Plan for Non-Employee Directors of The Bank of New York Company, Inc., incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10(yy) to the Company’s Annual Report on Form 10-K for the year ended December 31, 2003.
    *(eee)    Employee Severance Agreement dated July 11, 2000, incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10(g) to the Company’s Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q for the quarter ended September 30, 2000.
    *(fff)    Employee Severance Agreement dated July 11, 2000, incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10(h) to the Company’s Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q for the quarter ended September 30, 2000.
    *(ggg)    Employee Severance Agreement dated July 11, 2000, incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10(j) to the Company’s Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q for the quarter ended September 30, 2000.
    *(hhh)    Employee Severance Agreement dated July 8, 2003 for an executive officer of the Company, incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10 to the Company’s Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q for the quarter ended September 30, 2003.
    *(iii)    Employee Severance Agreement dated July 1, 2005, incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10(i) to the Company’s Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q for the quarter ended for June 30, 2005.
    *(jjj)    Form of Remuneration Agreement dated October 11, 1994 between the Company and three of the five most highly compensated officers of the Company, incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10(v) to the Company’s Annual Report on Form 10-K for the year ended December 31, 1994.
    *(kkk)    Description of Remuneration Agreement dated December 13, 2000 between the Company and an executive officer of the Company incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10(iii) to the Company’s Annual Report on Form 10-K for the year ended December 31, 2000.
    *(lll)    Form of Stock Option Agreement under the Company’s 2003 Long-Term Incentive Plan incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.2 to the Company’s Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q for the quarter ended September 2004.
    *(mmm)    Form of Performance Share Agreement under the Registrant’s 2003 Long-Term Incentive Plan incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.3 to the Company’s Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q for the quarter ended September 2004.
    *(nnn)    Form of Restricted Stock Agreement under the Company’s 2003 Long-Term Incentive Plan incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.4 to the Company’s Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q for the quarter ended September 2004.
      (ooo)    Lease agreement dated July 16, 2004 between Suntrust Equity Funding, LLC and Tennessee Processing Center LLC.

 

145


Table of Contents

Exhibit No.

    
(ppp)    Master agreement dated July 16, 2004 between The Bank of New York Company, Inc., Tennessee Processing Center LLC, and Suntrust Equity Funding, LLC.
(qqq)    Real Estate Lease Dated February 27, 2006 between 4101 Austin Boulevard Corp. and Fructibail Invest.
(rrr)    Real Estate Lease Waiver Agreement dated February 27, 2006 between 4101 Austin Boulevard Corp. and Fructibail Invest.
(sss)    Real Estate Sublease dated February 27, 2006 between The Bank of New York and Fructibail Invest.
(ttt)    Real Estate Sublease Waiver Agreement dated February 27, 2006 between The Bank of New York and Fructibail Invest.
(uuu)    Supplemental Agreement dated February 27, 2006 by and among Fructibail Invest, 4101 Austin Boulevard Corp. and the Bank of New York.
(vvv)    Guarantee of The Bank of New York Company, Inc. dated February 27, 2006.
   12    Statement – Re: Computation of Earnings to Fixed Charges Ratios
   21    Subsidiaries of the Registrant
     23.1    Consent of Ernst & Young LLP
      31(a)    Certification of the Chairman and Chief Executive Officer pursuant to Section 302 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002.
      31(b)    Certification of the Chief Financial Officer pursuant to Section 302 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002.
      32(a)    Certification of the Chairman and Chief Executive Officer pursuant to Section 906 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002.
      32(b)    Certification of the Chief Financial Officer pursuant to Section 906 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002.

* Constitutes a Management Contract or Compensatory Plan or Arrangement

 

146